Handbook of Mechanical Refrigeration by MacIntire
Handbook of Mechanical Refrigeration by MacIntire
Handbook of Mechanical Refrigeration by MacIntire
OF
MECHANICAL REFRIGERATION
HANDBOOK
OF
MECHANICAL REFRIGERATION
H? Jf
MACINTIRE
NEW YORK
JOHN WILEY
&
SONS,
Inc.
rp
Copyright] 1928
By H.
J.
Macintire
Xi\fb0 2.1
Printed in U. S. A.
6/32
PRESS OF
PREFACE
include
thermodynamic material
is
more
detailed study
dynamics;
and
oil
engines,
on thermo-
also,
is
Much
teaching purposes.
This
is
for
treated perhaps
plete
and
of practical value.
household refrigerating machine and the so-caUed ice cream cabinet has
materially assisted in the development of the automatic machine, while
the
more or
the use of some safer refrigerant such as methyl chloride and the hydrocarbons.
We
refrigeration.
The development
raw water ice manufacture has stimulated the study of water
treatment and air agitation while the increasing cost of power and labor
has necessitated the use of the Diesel oil engine, the electric motor and
labor-saving devices in the tank room.
Material, therefore, on these
will
of the
matters also
will
ia52A
PREFACE
VI
Wherever
possible, illustrative
As
a rule such illustrative problems are very similar one to another, and
vary only in the physical constants used. In some special cases these
constants are not
of distillates
known
accurately
which vary
(as, for
ago Professor Denton was forced to find out experunentally for himself
certain properties of ammonia before he could work up his tests; and
the early refrigerating engineers experimented on the specific heat of
etc.,
before calculating
such information
embody
it
is
in this treatise.
An attempt
has been
made
all
material not
it
G.
Thermodynamics," by Professor
whom
thanks are also due for many helpful sugThe manufacturers of compressors and refrigerating equip-
Goodenough, to
gestions.
In
proof.
With a book
The author
solicits
it is
practi-
information
H.
Urbana, Illinois
J.
Macintire
CONTENTS
CHAPTER
I.
PAGE
1-19
Introduction
III.
The Compressor
The Absorption Refrigerating Machine
IV.
105-155
179-220
II.
V.
VT.
VII.
VIII.
IX.
X.
XI.
XII.
XIX.
XX.
XXI.
XXII.
XXIII.
252-276
277-299
300-326
327-353
Piping
354-373
Making
Cold Storage
XVII.
221-251
,
XIV.
XVIII.
156-178
Ice
XVI.
82-104
Refrigerants
XIII.
XV.
20-81
374^28
429-506
507-544
....
545-566
567-581
582-598
599-631
632-675
676-695
Electric Motors
696-707
708-716
Index
717
HANDBOOK OF REFRIGERATION
CHAPTER
INTRODUCTION
Mechanical Refrigeration
is
one of the
many
applications of the
it is
is
and a
work as
taken up very
and the
formuliE used.
briefly,
and an explanation
will
be
Energy.
steam
like
it
its
is
energy
is
Temperature.
Temperature
is
an indication
when heated
air
INTRODUCTION
2
latter,
is
cal engineers;
The
is
is
used in Great
This point
is
is
is
no vibration
considered to be 459.7
custom
in the
United States
inch.
is
is
The heat
in
a body
lack of hotness) or
may be sensible
may be latent
heat (indicated by
heat, a
it
its
hotness or
other kind.
or external
is
C/2
is
heat energy
stated as follows:
1Q2
where 1Q2
if
This
or both.
may
is
= U2 -
Ui+AW
is
the
TT^
is
initial
and
the work
volume, temperature,
etc.,
may be represented
independent of the path bj'^ which
is
CHANGES OF STATE
the stated condition was obtained.
plete cycle,
The
on
First
It follows
from
this that in
Law
of
Thermodynamics.
change
a comis
zero.
and others have proved that mechanical and heat energy have a certain
relationship; that is, when work is expended in producing heat, the heat
produced is proportional to the work perfonned. This can be expressed
by the
relation:
Q =
where
AW
engineering in foot-pounds
(ft. -lb.).
The quantity
AW
.vould then be
in B.t.u.
1.0
KW.
hr.
1.0 B.t.u.
Specific Heat.
The
3414.5 B.t.u.
777.6
ft.-lb.
that the projected area under such a " curve " represents the external
the isobar
temper-
is
INTRODUCTION
but
is
exerted
by the
gas, v is the
and n is the exponent of the volume, this being usually about 1.4 for
air and about 1.28 for ammonia and carbon dioxide.
The external
work in any of these cases is the projected area on the volume axes of
the p-v plane.
It is
equation
= U2 - Ui
1Q2
+ AW
and these
will
work.
The
is
available for,
be reversible or irreversible.
the isothermal are examples of the former type, whereas all practical
By the term " reversibihty " is meant
processes are irreversible.
all the events must be taken in the reverse order and that at the
end of the process all conditions, both externally and internally, must
be restored to their original state.
The Second. Law of Thermod3mamics and the Carnot Cycle. The
second law of thermodynamics can Ije stated in a number of ways.
From experience, it can be said that
1. An irreversible change causes a loss of availability.
2. A reversible change causes no change in a^'ailability.
3. No increase in available energy in a sj^stem can take place as a
result of a self-imposed change in the body.
The Carnot cycle is one composed of two isothermals and two frictionless adiabatics.
If Ti is the absolute temperature of the source and
T2 is the absolute temperature of the refrigerator, both in absolute
degrees, then it may be proved that the efficiency of the Carnot cycle is:
that
^^T^-T.
Q1-Q2 _
Tx
where Qi
is
AW
Qi
AW =
Qi
Q2
is
the
is
of the refrigerator
is
The
E =
(SO
^
if
+ 4G0) - -
10
4G0)
(80
0.1 007
The temperature
80 deg. F. Find the
10,000 B.t.u. per minute is to be taken
is
Qi
is
is
=
90
0.1667
540
460)
10,000
,
Qi
and
therefore
Qi
12,000 B.t.u.
from which
AW
= 2000
B.t.u. per
-^
2000
minute
42.44
47.1 hp.
building.
is,
as before,
E=
Ti
T2
70-0
=
+ 70
0.132
460
Ti
But
Qi
sa3's
that Qi
Q2
is
0.132
130,000 B.t.u.;
therefore,
100,000
0.132,
Q-2
86,800 B.t.u.
AW
-- 2.546
5.19 hp.
Q2
100,000
from which
and
and
13,200
INTRODUCTION
6
Entropy.
In
The diagram on
the
j)-v
it is
plane
desirable
is
useful
able energy.
frictionless adiabatic is
constant entropy.
&2
where
>S2
Si
is
Si
is
expressed by:
m
'/?-/
rp
is
is
is
During a
,S2
Whereas
.Si
= Q
-^
Q = ^(^2 -
and
Si)
Fig. 1&
if
dQ = Mcidt
then
So
where
c is
^ Mc^'j'^y, =
Si
ilf c loge
Y'
a constant.
Thermal
Potential.
thermal potential.
product
quantity
now
thermodynamic problems
This
is
defined as the
sum
is
one which
of the energy
is
called
and the
A'pD, or
As U, p and
= U
-h
Apv
= du
Differentiating:
Apdv
Avdp = dq
Avdp
PERFECT GASES
(a)
the pressure
If
is
(or
equal to
is
and
of I at the l^eginning
In
(6)
compression
ence
the differ-
is
value
the
in
-^ Volume V
of I
and the
end of compression.
at the beginning
(c)
a throttling
l])uring
in
process
process
(the
passing
through
pansion valve)
remains constant.
of /
The PI Diagram.
The entropy diagram is
useful
the
understanding
in
manner
but
it
is
of heat flow,
not workable to
extent
the
of
another
accurately
in
Figs.
and
168,
Entropy
of engineering problems.
Perfect
Gases.
relationship
The
existing
be-
pv
by the equation
MBT
i^ Thermal Potential
or
pv
pm
Ti
Fig.
a constant
1.
Theoretical
Vapors.
INTRODUCTION
where
is
V is
is
B is
Specific
is
Heat
of Gases.
The
The
a substance
specific heat of
of
air.
by unity one
feet.
(cp)
is
is
The usual
(c).
The
rativ)
fc
is
it is
where
U;
Ui
Mc,{t2
L'2
Ui
^1)
= change
('j
This formula
may
be written
U2-
Ui
ti)
of temperature.
also,
P2V2
PlVi
1
Q =
AW
AW
where
c is
V2
and
v\
^ AMBTi
loge
Apm loge -
During the
U^-U^=-AW
Q =
and, from
in
terms of
j)
and
v is
is
performed at the
for an
The equation
given by pv^
a constant, where
^.
process
PlVi
is
given by
P2V2
1
The
relation
can be shown by
INTRODUCTION
10
in the aftercooler.
The area
EFGD
is
=
is
n
n
'(PltU
"
PsVb)
111
expressed by
The
is
represented by
11
compressor
both must be increased in
Clearance does not increase the power requirements
proportion.
theoretically but it does practically because of the effect of friction.
The formula for the volumetric efficiency is given in Chapter II.
In the formula for the refrigerating effect it is seen that the heat
absorbed is directly proportional to the weight M. This weight can be
increased per cubic foot of piston displacement by increasing the density
of the gas during the suction stroke, and this is the characteristic of the
so-called dense air machine.
Vapors. Practically all refrigerating machines at the present time
use volatile liquids, and it is necessary to understand the thermodynamics of liquids and vapors in order to have a clear understanding
In each of the diagrams mentioned,
of the action of the machine.
diagrams, there is a Liquid line on the left
the p-v, the P-I and the
and a dry, saturated line on the right (Fig. 1). The top of the dome
made with these two lines is called the critical temperature. The
region between the liquid and the dry, saturated lines is called the
saturated region while the superheated region lies on the extreme right
where the vapor begins to show characteristics of a perfect gas.
During the absorption of heat by the liquid the temperature will
The heat of the liquid
rise and the volume will increase very slightly.
(if the specific heat is taken as a constant) is given for one pound of the
effect of clearance is to decrease the capacity of the
IS
substance by:
lQ'2
and
if
is
= cX
{t2
not constant
dq
cdt
ti)
VAPORS
where (h
fi)
is
11
of the heat.
If
the vakie of
c is
be employed, namely,
Q = fcdt
If,
at
of evaporation takes
If after
the liquid
is
entirely evaporated,
is
is
entirely evaporated
(if
the pressure
is
of
(r).
absorbed
maintained
is
still
keep-
= CpX
(t2
/i)
the specific heat were constant, but as the value varies, then, as
if
Q =
icpdt
There
is
content.
As
m'o
then
i'o
where uq and
vq are
measurement
-p
Vq
'
.U
then
^ o
144
of heat content.
ft.
43.08'
= 144X10.41 =
^^g
43 pg
r,f.,,oT,.
0.0448
B.t.u.
significance of
in forcing
lb.
= Ayvo
and
59
at this point,
The
INTRODUCTION
12
The value of
i is
i' -\-
xr
i"
(1.0
a;)r
sideration.
may
be found
thermal potential of the liquid and of the dry saturated vapor, the
and the entropy of the liquid and of saturated gas. If the
superheated region is evaluated, the specific volume, the value of / and
latent heat
the entropy are given for the different pressures and amounts of
superheat.
The
liquids
Refrigerating
is
shown
in
Cycle.
Figs,
The
la,
refrigerating
and
\h
Ic.
cycle
Point
for
volatile
represents the
that the corresponding boiling temperature will be suitable for the con-
is
by
is
given
If
the
6 to be just on the
enters the condenser and is cooled and liquefied through the absorption
On the
diagram
of heat by the condensing water along the line 46 i-
IS
74
?3
The
is
the value
efficiently as possible to
erant
13
h, the work of compression is
the
condenser
water is u ^i- The tables
lost
to
and the heat
may
is
an amount
13
use of atmospheric air or, in neady every case, by the use of well or
making
The
continuously.
it
same
refrigerant
fore, depends on the temperature and the amount of the cooling water
showered over the condenser. The function of the condenser is to
liquefy the refrigerant, but it is very important that the pressure of
liquefaction be as low as possible as well as the temperature of the
liquid at the expansion valve.
This can be seen very well from the
diagram.
IS
The
pound, where
{3
ature
is
seen to be
is
73
1-2
B.t.u. per
The lower
sion valve.
effect
1-2
12,
by the use
of cooling
a water-cooled aftercooler.
nt2
(/i
+460)(^)
"
460
recourse
is
made
keep from
become
At one time it was
generally understood that improved operation could be obtained by
the use of a liquid refrigerant injection into the suction of the comSuch a
pressor and such a process has the term ivet compression.
means of operation is still used in extreme conditions but the control is
difficult and few engineers advocate wet compression at the present
overheating the cylinder the temperature of the discharge
will
The Ton
of Refrigeration.
The
American ton
of refrigeration
is
the cooling rate of 200 B.t.u. per minute or 12,000 B.t.u. per hour.
condenser of 86 degrees.
is
The
3.96
60
This would be
than the American unit. The American ton of refrigeration got its
origin from the consideration of the melting effect of 2000 lb. of ice in
INTRODUCTION
14
24 hr. with the latent heat of fusion, taken in round numbers, as 144
B.t.u. per pound.
The Coefl&cient of Performance. According to the laws of thermodynamics the work performed in compressing different refrigerants for
the same heat absorbed from the refrigerator is the same (this being
way
another
much
This variation
2o
-.
?9
r.
is
For
efficient
of the coefficient of
performance
^3
but in practice
10,
-.
^3
l2
200
4.713
42.44
t3
12
^3
sidered,
in
the
formula.
may
up
to 2.0 or
be
less
than
1.0
operating conditions.
Refrigeration.
Refrigeration, as
will
Fig.
of Ice.
expensive.
TABLE
15
is
of
hmited and
various mix-
INTRODUCTION
16
The
balanced.
refrigerating coils
cooled, for example, air, liquids, etc., in order that the required "
duty "
shall
gg
Charging ^Liquid
valve
T^ W^fl
MARKET
Ammonia
receiver compressor
Ice freezing
MACHINE ROOM
tank
Air for agitating
can water'
Compressor suction
Compressor discharge
Liquid receiver
Expansion valve
Liquid
Ammonia
ammonia
charging connection
compressor
Pump
out connections
Fig.
4.
Typical Refrigeration
Plants.
square foot per 1.0 degree F. difference of temperature per hour and
represented by the symbol
k.
This value k
is
of
is
extreme importance
in mechanical refrigeration.
The
heat, an
of
of
17
t:
o c
INTRODUCTION
18
refrigeration.
Again the value of the coefficient of heat transfer (k) is
an important consideration and in each case the total heat transfer
may be stated from the formula:
Q = A
A =
where
t2
XkX
(t2
ti)
=
Q =
t\
some
slight gain in
economy when
As an
the liquid am-
monia and 5
valve
F.
deg.
z'l
io
or
86
t 5
a-srs
evaporating temperature.
or
a;
138.9 - 48.3
^^^ ^
565.0
In the expansion
__
= 0.1605
From
S 5
( r\
X,[j^^
0.2875-0.1092
^^^^
^.,,_^
0.1470
of the
ammonia, boiled
expansion value
ti
before and
t2
after the
is
Q =
i"2
i'l
is evident that any scheme which will decrease the value of i\ (the
thermal potential of the liquid before it enters the expansion valve)
will result in a greater value of the net available refrigeration per pound
of refrigerant, but in general the operation must be done by the condensing water. However if colder water than that used for liquefaction
It
in the condenser
tion as,
if
is
available
any vapor
is
it
must be used
present sub-cooling
shown
in
Chapter IV.
successful
method
19
is
to
make
method given in
Chapter II whereby the liquid is cooled at an intermediate pressure and
the gas evolved at the intermediate pressure is compressed by a special
use of the dual compression or the stage compression
compressor.
a heat engine.
not be one that will increase the efficiency of the cycle, but
it will
one that for the kind of operation, or the type of load or service
be
will
give best results as regards the pressures exerted in the cycle, the piston
Some of the
life.
by reasons of convenience,
from
first
lower (the refrigerating) pressure and the higher (the condenser) pres-
Chapter
II;
the absorption machine. Chapter III; condensers,
Chapter IV; the low-pressure side and its applications to
various industries; as for example that of ice making. Chapter XIII;
cold storage. Chapter XIV; and miscellaneous applications, Chapter
XV. Subjects of lesser general importance, though valuable to the
engineer, such as heat transfer, Chapter VI; automatic refrigeration,
Chapter V; brine. Chapter VIII; water-supply systems, Chapter IX;
operation and erection, Chapter X, etc., are discussed as indicated.
sure,
fittings, etc..
CHAPTER
II
THE COMPRESSOR
CuUen
in 1755, using
Nehrhch
Fig.
6.
Vapor Compression
Machine
of
Refrigerating
years,
Jacob Perkins.
in
1869.
The
air
and John De
The
la
Vergne.
but
20
21
O O
Fig.
7.
Apeldoorn Compressor.
Slow-speed
Horizontal
Double-acting
Compressor.^
The
The frames
The
frame.
cylinder,
^A number
liquid
made
of
cast separately
from the
of the
of mixtures of
is
of
is
are usually
either of a close-grained
and
made
is
and the
relative
eliminate
amounts
all leaks.
of accuracy,
it is
possible to
THE COMPRESSOR
22
cylinder heads, the idea being that greater valve area as well as greater
strength
is
possible
by
this
arrangement.
is
one
in
box
with
type
shoes
and
of
is
adjustable
and bottom,
top
at
The
made of
semi-steel.
connecting rod
is
of
by means
adjusted
The crankshaft
piece
of
is
one-
turned
forging,
steel
of
(Fig. 8).
and ground.
The stuffing
box is of the lantern type,
using now, as a rule,
metalKc packing;
and
lantern,
first
finally,
The lantern
nected by means of
packing.
to the suction
there
is
in
then the
line
is
soft
con-
piping
so
that
way only
this
exerted on
suction pressure
8 to 18
Fig.
8.
Compressor Details;
the
Main
Bearing,
valve
is
the poppet, or
is
made
to
quite heavy)
cushion
the
by means
of
mush-
successful.
vary
(Fig. 9).
in.
The
may
makes from
the
of
the
dash pots
(Fig.
closing
valves,
valve
10).
but
(which
On
an attempt
is
usually
account of the
sturdy design and workable valves the compressors of the Linde type
have had a very successful life, the design not having been changed
to any great extent since the first construction in about the year 1873.
tight,
is
and
it
23
can be reground on
limited, however, to
its
from 75 to
100 r.p.m., and therefore where higher speeds are required a lighter
must be
The Horizontal High-speed Compressor.
used.
r.p.m.,
up
the
to 250 r.p.m.
developed
make
a mistake to say, however, that the moderatecheaper per ton of refrigeration, as the stresses
necessary to use higher-priced material than would
It is
speed compressor
'/:'
is
it
is
\^ &A^J\J^
M/Q^^
)f
'y /'
Fig.
eH^ /
y y Jiv^;W/V\/VV-AAy
9. Metallic Rod
Packing.
is
24
THE COMPRESSOR
c2
a
04
25
type.
the
posing
valves
the
is
frequently
chrome- vanadium steel, and
very
best,
the valve
rise of
is
very
Typical
slight.
Figs. 13
and
In the
in-
shown
in
14.
ma-
horizontal
placed on
are always
bottom
easy
the
in order to permit
relief
ammonia
should
liquid
enter the
cylin-
suction
gas.
in
smaller
valves.
the
preference
to
number of large
The suction and
discharge
valves
are Fig.
11a.
Compressor
for
the
position
>'
of
the
Details;
Crosshead
The
-'-
Back cylinder
head
Fig. 115.
and
Rod.
Compressor Details;
Valves.
ports are
THE COMPRESSOR
26
made generous
Fig. 12.
c 5"
180
r.
p.
m.
50.5 tons
refrig.
70.0
b.
hp.
155*G
19.6*G
Fig. 13.
than the net cross section of the valve opening. Since designers act
with the understanding that a nominal amount of clearance varying
27
economical opera-
there an attempt to
is
effects of slugs of
in
given to lubrication.
is
frequent use;
and the De
ammonia
first,
There are
la
type for the engine crank mechanism (the Ingersoll-Rand, the Arctic
When
the
in the
tion
to
test)
oil
means
pump
in
of
in
6.51 sq.in.
each Cylinder
Total opening
Total opening
box by
special mechanical
each Cylinder
3"
9.20 sq.
lift
in.
|"
lift
the stuffing
180 R.P.M.
66.9 tons
refrig.
80.0 B. Hp.
lubricator.
155*G
As
so
pumped
is
and
inder
Suction Valves
Discharge Valves
inder.
practically impossible
it is
wet
control
to
compression
as to
all
compression,
thus
necessi-
tating
is
of
last
(for
use
slight
third
except
the
of
at
stroke,
the
Poppet Type of
and
its function is to prevent overheating of the metal, and in consequence to improve at the same time
the " real " volumetric efficiency.
The
compressor
is
of
two types,
compressor
(1)
The
vertical single-acting
(2)
the
THE COMPRESSOR
28
Discharge valve
Suction valve
Size
29
valve in the piston of the ring plate or the balanced light weight
poppet type, the latter opening and closing by the inertia of the valve
during reciprocation, and the discharge passing through a form of poppet
valve in the false head held on
14).
The water
and at times
insulated.
jacket
in the
is
head as
On account
Fig. 17.
its
seat
by means
of
heavy springs
last third of
(Fig.
well, the
Number
32,000
72,000
of
Machine
112,000
2j
3i
4i
4i
200
152,000
5
9i
16
240,000
8
15
13
170
150
140
22
130
25^
100
36^
170
220
13|
191
3C
75
48J
made very small, as little as eV in. The piston rods and stuffing
box are subjected to suction pressure only.
The Semi-enclosed Compressor. The semi-enclosed vertical singleacting compressor (Fig. 26) has its two cranks 180 degrees apart, and
is
(if
engine driven) has the connecting rod of the steam engine connected
same time
as the
maximum
maximum
THE COMPRESSOR
30
but the stuffing box, being subjected to suction pressure only, need not
be as long as is required for the double-acting machine. This stuffingbox packing has hard usage, and as it is very hard to keep the
operating conditions constant, and as the packing
frozen from time to time
when
ammonia
liquid
likely to
is
is
hkely to become
Ihe
but the fran:e and the remainder of the machine are usually of ordinary
material.
Oil strainer
Fig. 18.
18"
sizes,
The
20".
enclosed
to automatic operation
and
pump
suction
crankcase compressor
to decreased loss of
sizes,
The
Oil
It
separator and
oil storage
monia.
Oil
is
3"
up
to
ammonia
is
found in
am-
the fact that the packing and the rod are kept at nearly constant temperature and that the rod has rotation and not translation.
scored rod
The
machine work
compressor.
is
practically the
The
cylinder
is
same as
of semi-steel
horizontal
CLEARANCE
31
The
surface sand.
piston
is
known
remove any
side thrust
it
due to the
9"
9"
The
up
sizes
The discharge
three or
to the
size,
more
may
l^e
number.
in
Unusual care
is
necessary
type of compressor.
It is subjected
The machine
and the crankcase must be excellent, and heat
heavy
to very
work
forces.
in the cjdinder
treatment
usually
is
necessary in
to
much
The York
lb.
tensile
strength,
hmit of 40,000
and
lb.
an
Fig. 19.
elastic
rods.
Clearance.
The
the
new
effective
is
very nearly
all
in the
returned
THE COMPRESSOR
32
in the
Water
overflow
Water overflow
Fig. 20.
metric efficiency which is caused by the clearance, but to the real volumetric efficiency. This is in reality a quantity obtained by dividing
2
efficiency
may
V,
Vj,
Vc
and
=m
let
Pi
Fi
The volumetric
= Fp
+ mVp
efficiency
is
mV,
= F
-\-
m m
LPU
the
ratio
T'l
-^Vp = \-\-m
where
'1/
1.3,
33
The
the suction gas due to the effects of the cylinder walls, piston, valves,
the best
ft.
com-
and gas
steam
has
practice
800
ft.
engine
permitted
per minute.
The
<V,
Volume
Fig. 21.
Indicator Card.
walls.
The
number
is
needs to have a light weight valve and one that has a liberal net opening
for the passage of the gas.
increases, the
amount
As the number
of the valve
lift
of revolutions per
minute
ring-plate
and the
Company
in their
THE COMPRESSOR
34
...I
__.;.__._
Jacket.
The
effect of the
35
1400
1300
1200
1100
1000
900
800
THE COMPRESSOR
36
much
methyl
air
dioxide or
for
cooKng.
tests on the
water jackets are those
of Walter Fisher.^
These tests
effect of
show the
relative
effect
on the
real
volumetric
from about
1.5 to 4.0 per cent by having the
water jacket.
efficiency is increased
Lubrication.
in design
enclosed
Fig. 25.
Lubrication;
closed Compressor of 25
Tons and
vertical
compressor the
Less.
the
oil filter
The
lubricated only
oil
in the crankcase
Walther
Fisher
Kiiltemaschinen
Der
is
(Fig. 25)
and
this
means
is still
Einfluss
des
Kuhlwassermantels
an
Kompressions-
LUBRICATION
The
splash
and
are
it is
method
of hibrication
the cheapest of
two objections to
an
all
methods used
its use.
may
inefficient
is
The
37
first
objection
is
There
may
lubrication
Fig. 26.
Lubrication;
tion,
oil
the Vertical,
There is also the possibility of pumping oil during normal operabut this danger is lessened by care in the design of the rings in
the piston.
The
pump
made
of
the
oil filter
THE COMPRESSOR
38
Fig. 27.
Lubrication;
bj'
Ammonia Compressor.
having no
pump
pump and by
suction
to
lift
the
Figure 27 shows a
itself.
method
more
elabo-
of lubrication, such
would be found
compressors, one
nozzle de\dce
for
in the larger
which
has
spraying the
be
clearer, to
used
at
regular
of the nozzle,
to every impor-
Figure 26 shows
tant bearing.
28. The
Eccentric
Driven
Number
pressor.
of
Cylinders.
The
two
in
number
39
shown by
Fig. 18.
by adding
cylinders, but in
the enclosed design onl}^ and not the open frame semi-enclosed type of
vertical compressor the latter being distinctively an
American design. There is another advantage in the use of multiple
cyUnders from the viewpoint of balance. With one or two cylinders
no amount of counterbalance will entirely balance the effect of reciprocation whereas the three- or four-cylinder machine- (Figs. 18, 19, 28) may
be entirely balanced except for a moment which will need to be carried
by the bed plate or the foundation. It would seem then that if the
compressor speed is to be increased decidedly, there will be an advantage
in the use of three cylinders on the same crankshaft.
Theoretical Displacement of the Compressor. The theoretical displacement of the compressor may be found in the following manner:
single-acting
The
is {I'z
i\) (Fig.
The
1).
per minute
= -20V X
P.D.
where Vs"
V"'3,
is
at the pressure 3.
If
ammonia
(or refrigerant)
(expressed as a decimal)
is
Es,
ment becomes
P.D.
^,^^
l'"3
E,
is,
PD =_^oo_
There
is
no
reliable
method
formula ^^
of
_r:3_
where {U
h)
is
the
THE COMPRESSOR
40
The temperature
thermodynamic equation
for
I)
n-l
W=
cycle
is:
-pivi
1
where n
dioxide,
If v\ is
taken in the
pound
of the refrigerant,
The
compression.
power
can then
(i.hp.)
i.hp.
where
h"
^77
I 3
ii
is
^ X
^1
^^7^7^
33,000
(:4
3)
4.713h77
\?
77I
1/
lb. of refrigerant.
Figures 31 and 32 give values for the horse power per ton of refrigeration for
dioxide compressors.
41
is
carbonic refrigeration
is
making gains
1200
1100
1000.
900
700
600
in the
THE COMPRESSOR
42
that the refrigerant
refrigeration
is
per pound in
when a hot liquid
It
valve in
It
liquid.
mean that no
means only that
the same manner that
is
{x) of
sion valve even under these extreme conditions is less than 0.5, as
seen on referring to the P-I diagram for CO2 (Fig. 164).
There
is
machines.
is
The
1200 lb. or more on the high-pressure side and from 30C to 600 lb. per
square inch on the low-pressure side. Losses of gas to the atmosphere
have been excessive, and leaks past the valves, piston rings, etc., have
been very high even with new machines. It appears then that a successful carbon dioxide compressor and system must be properly designed,
and the materials entering into its construction and the icorkmanship
Fortunately autogenous welding has become so
common and rehable, especially for small pipe work, that fittings can
be eliminated to a large extent, and the gas losses can be reduced accord-
must be
ingly.
satisfactory.
This
is
becoming true
in the
condenser (Fig. 66), the low-pressure piping and to some extent the
high-pressure part of the system.
Design.
Carbonic
compressor cylinders
and valve
cages.
made
are
As a
of semi-steel
for the
cyhnder
end cyhnder head and the stuffing box are made of a single casting,
thereb}^ permitting better alignment, and eliminating one joint and
The head cylinder cover is held
the source of another probable leak.
remainder of the construction
The
bolts.
through
or
studs
by
in place
is
very
much
ammonia
For example,
the piston rods, connecting rods and crankshaft are of forged steel, the
The crosshead is of
piston rod being hardened and ground to size.
semi-steel
is
of steel
made
is
not high in temperature and water jackets for the cylinder are never
used, but on account of the very heavy discharge pressure, and the
desire to keep the so-called hoop tension in the cylinder as low as practical
is
Except
pressor
is
being from 3^ to 4,
ammonia compresmarine and some small enclosed machines the comof the horizontal, double-acting type, using metallic packing
sors.
tlie ratio
43
found
ratio usually
in similar
for
much
capacity as
is
as
it
would
much by
in the case of
due to
the case of
valves
nmy
friction
lb.
In consequence a drop
would not be as serious as would an equal drop in
ammonia with
a suction
dium
steel,
pressure of 15
and the
lift is
frequently
is
limited to as
little
made
gage.
lb.
may
The
be ring
chrome vana-
as j^ in.
to 1000 lb.
the piston
The
a true surface
piston diameter
is
per inch of diameter less than the nominal diameter of the piston, but
in no case is the difference between the cylinder diameter and the
diameter of the piston to be less than 0.0007 in. per inch of diameter,
nor more than 0.0015 in. per inch of diameter. It is made round and
parallel within the limits of 0.001 in.
The piston rod is round within
in. and parallel within the limits of 0.003 in.
The
between the piston head and the ends of the cylinder is
about ^ in. The entire system is designed to ])e tight under a pressure of
3000 11). per square inch of water and 13501b. air pressure under water.
total clearance
The stuffiing box is still designed to use leather cups and other soft
packing combined with brass boxes and washers or other forms of
distance pieces, but this design is giving way to metalhc packing. When
the soft packing
is
Metallic packing
is
is
usually
centrally located
THE COMPRESSOR
44
There
in the machine.
is less
"x" is quite large even for a nominal range between the sucand the condenser pressures. The result is that whereas the power
requirement would be the same for all refrigerants if the liquid is cooled
value of
tion
down
first
conditions,
and
if
Hodgdon showed^
(i.hp. plus
Willcox and
CO2
at the
expansion valve, 2.0 with 65 degrees, 2.39 with 75 degrees, 2.85 with
85 degrees and 3.44 b.hp. with 95 degree ''liquid" at the expansion
give an idea of the volumetric efficiency, the cubic feet of piston dis-
placement per minute per ton, and the brake horse power per ton of
Fear of ammonia is so great with certain individuals
refrigeration.
that carbonic compressors are becoming more popular in America and
without doubt improved design will make them even more so. Installadie
Gesammte
Zeitschrift
Willcox and Hodgdon, Cold Storage and Ice Association, Jan. 27, 1914.
fiir
are being
made even
in Florida
1200
^1100
- 1000
900
fe_800
700
600
in
such latitudes.
is
States,
45
though the
of a temperature that
THE COMPRESSOR
46
sizes,
The carbon
considerable ease and in Great Britain they have been built in two
stages for that purpose.
According to G. W.
Daniels,*^ a battery of 4
J&'-J^^a;
Fig. 34.
successful.
compressors and Fig. 36 gives results of tests on a small marine type carbonic compressor.
The
dioxide as a refrigerant has not been used to any extent in the United
etc.,
6
A. Borsig, Quire
and
Co.,
Gesellschaft
G.
W.
fiir
A.
J.
Rayment,
1925.
47
handling.
-m
.fTi.
Fig. 35.
The sulphur
displacement of the
some
volume
the valve
larger
type.
is
German
Because of the
likely to
As sulphur dioxide
is
corrosive
amount
the tendency
is
to restrict the
and
in
possible,
is
of evaporator surface as
is
present
much
as
not popular
AS (dumb-bell)
is
THE COMPRESSOR
48
abandoned
in
and
it is
more than
likely that
be
it will
pressure refrigerant.
All
of these
for
self-lubrication,
and
50,000
vantages of sulphur
dioxide, although
is
it
can be
ed,
easily
remedied.
pressor.
tary compressor
ultimate
the
of
many
as
it
is
goal
engineers
will
permit
and therefore
direct
connection
to
a
cheap type of elecThe
tric
motor.
piston displacement
per ton of refrigeration need not cause
displacement
easily cared
is
for in
be chosen
may
that
is
M.
E., 1918.
so great as for
machine
seldom as
is
49
follows
Refrigerant evaporation temperature,
degrees
20-ton
19.9
2.7
-9.6
1.1
1.3
l.G
2.0
2.3
2.8
3.3
4.4
4.3
5.8
11.0
30
ammonia compressor
(horse
per ton)
i*g-ton
compressor
^^'i^iams
(horse
22
V77777777777777777777T/77V7777r77777p7f77777777r',
Scoop
for supplying
Layer of liquid
SOj
"
Layer of
to float valve
oil
SOj
maintained
by centrifugal force
Pressure regulating
valve for stopping
and
starting
Bearing journal
Bearing journal
this
submerged
in oil
Suction passage
Oil outlet to
maintain
circulation
Fig. 37.
The
Centrifugal Compressor.
is
If
is
used,
HF
THE COMPRESSOR
50
J Water
stud
Rotor
feather key
Water
Inlet-
^1-^
Spacing pin
Rotor
i Pipe
outlet
tap-
"HCiycerinel
^ strainer
Chem.
I
irsuction
strainer
Shaft
^ Stuffing! Stuffing
g'^"'
lantern gl.i ^^
S k-T-^ U
Packing
glade
Fig. 38.
Size
Tons
1<-Y-^L
strip
Cylinder
k-W-^n,
I
I
Bearing
spacer
Company
51
jdujoo io ojjey
.1
less
like
THE COMPRESSOR
52
and
Referring to Fig. 39
sum
the
public buildings.^
of the velocity
hi
will
it
and
= -^
^g
static heads, is
hp
U2V2 cos a2
Only a part of the velocity head is available for the production of static
and the usual method of change from velocity to static heads
is by means of diffuser blades of gradually increasing cross-sectional
pressure,
area.
The
is
Oil inlet
Grooves
on face of
piston
Pressure
Piping
Baffle
Plate
Ridges on
Dry Pipe
Gudgeon
f
Delivery
Pipe
Sieve
Nozzle
Tongue
Fig. 40.
The curves
in Fig. 39
taken from an
give
article
})e
The number
655
ft.
53
of
THE COMPRESSOR
54
many
is also high.
The
shown in Fig. 41.
The Water Vapor Refrigerating Machine. The water vapor refrigerating machine (the Westinghouse-Leblanc) has been proposed but
has not been developed to any extent in the United States. It is
a " safety " refrigerating system but it needs a high vacuum and is
small machines,
down
air cooling
to 50 or 40 deg.
obtained by means
F.
are best
ejector nozzles.
In the ejector type of water vapor refrigerating machine the underlying principle
by the
is
The
another mass.
relation:
mM
mv^
MV^
If
(m
+ M)2
then
mM
tn
(m
where
V
y=
y
/1
MY'
0.222
0.25
0.187
V =
0.160
0.139
amount
of
(Dual Compression)
is
an attempt
required in a plant.
regards power input
it is
pressure
result of
this is that the other load is carried at a condition of greater piston displacement and greater power consumed than would be required under
^1
One
if
desired.
THE MULTIPLE EFFECT COMPRESSOR
more advantageous operating
ordinary suction stroke
coils (the
is
55
conditions.
operated mechanically (rig. 46) so as to admit gas from the other coils
^To
Condensers-
Evaporator'
From
Atmospheres
Condenser^
Receiver
J^^
To condenser
-r
^-X^
Evaporator
H. P. side
^^
From evaporator
Windhausen Compressor
To condenser
Condenser
>^Evaporator
From
receiver
-Atmosphere
Condenser
-Receiver
.-Evaporator
Voorhees Compressor
Fig. 43.
Dual
234
(2 pressure)
R. P.
M.
Compression.
is
only
in the
it
is
United States.
is
As
of considerable value
particularly in
THE COMPRESSOR
56
and
this gas
may
For general
The
pressure 30 and 45
condenser
lb. abs.,
pressure
is
185
lb.
abs.,
suction
ft.,
the beginning of the compression, no clearance in the cylinder and adiabatic compression.
It is
pressure in the
first case,
Cooling
water
outlet
Cooling
water inlet
^ COj condenser
Regulator
Fig. 44.
is
increase in the
under 30
lb.
power requirements
suction
The
refrigerating effect
is,
i"3oib.
i'i85ib.
G11.4
145.2
46G.2 B.t.u.
i"46ib.
i'lsoib.
(ilG.9
145.2
471.7 B.t.u.
The weight
of
ammonia
in 10 cu.
ft.
is
The weight
of
ammonia
in 10 cu.
ft.
is
1.08 lb.
1.59 lb.
6.3
of the
stroke,
57
not making any allowance for the wire drawing which would be expected during the
passage of the gas from the evaporating coils to the cylinder, and the difference in
As the compressor is operated in both condithe temperatures of the two vapors.
same speed and the piston displacement in each case is identical, the
may be used to compare the power input. In the single
case the refrigerating effect is the product of 1.08 X 466.2 = 503 B.t.u. and the
tions at the
mean
effective pressure
mean
effective pressure
tion
is
90
is
(1.08
466.2)
is
+ (0.51 X 471.7)
lb.
The
regular compression
743.7
is
is
503
as 90.0
1.47
67.7
1.33.
This shows that a gain in the capacity of about 47 per cent is accomplished by the
u.se of the multiple effect compression device, incidental with an increase of 33 per cent
in
This
power.
the
is
hardly to be expected
full theoretical
If
the best.
59.7
lb.
CO2.
ft.,
0.188
the tem-
perature of the clearance gas as 142 deg. F. and the specific volume of this gas as
3.48
= 36 lb. The total weight of gas
0.096 then the weight of the clearance gas is
becomes 36
317
353
lb.
suction.
Taking the
specific
volume
volume
cu.
ft.
81.0
is
theoretically or 0.95
the ports
is
25.9
^rrrz
170.5
X
lb.
pound the
317
27.3
0.152
53.7 cu.
of gas entering
25.9 cu.
per mmute.
ft.
cu.
ft.
cylinder
low pressure,
= 90
is
tons refrigeration.
When
The
The weight
ft.
is used to cool the liquid the problem is not so straightnecessary to assume an intermediate evaporating temperature, and then calculate the volume obtained which must be enough for the
forward.
In this case
it is
THE COMPRESSOR
58
cylinder dimensions.
pressure
is
obtained.
refrigerating
that time progress in stage compression has been very rapid, and
its
As a
advantage
if
result
it is
lb.
To
gage.
when the
is
large enough,
suction pressure
is
is
of
and as
lowered
is
high.
Norman
Selfe
who
first
12
1'
" Thomas
59
to that of the other coils so that the standard compressor could handle
all of
it all
its
ammonia
is
from that of
different
air
because
Ordinary compression
M,
E.
P.
Fig. 45.
ammonia
75
H5 =
90
per sq.
lb.
M,
in.
E. P.
is
for
= 67.7
lb.
per sq.
in.
Dual Compression.
tures carried in part of the cycle are frequently 100 degrees below the
temperature of the atmosphere. Also, unlike air compression, the
pressure range varies very decidedly with the seasons for in the winter
time the pressure ratio may be as small as
summer
may
be
compressor
is
12.0.
The
air
pressures
summer and
In the
winter.
refrigerating
pansion valves.
same discharge
cycle there
is
an
This gas
is
formed by the
ammonia
Mechanically
~ operated
depending on the
initial
and the
amount
final tern-
46.-Dual Compression
Mechanically Operated Valve,
Fig.
In stage
ammonia compression
it
has been
the usual custom to use two 'pressure-reducing valves, and to permit the
gas evolved during the first pressure drop to be separated from the
Uquid and to pass immediately into the suction line to the high-pressure
cyHnder.
negligible
amount
permitting
it
for this
of value as a refrigerating
THE COMPRESSOR
60
the amount
of
gas
be handled
to
Ammonia
discharge
Low pressure
suction
High pressure
"~
is
the
as
large
pressure
suction
ume
Sleeve valve
(the
16.66
is
the
ammonia
the
first
points
gas
If this
figure.
to
then
coils
during
gasified
pressure reduction
the
is
allowed
low-pressure
low-pressure
is
in the
pump
would be
in
the expense of
in
useful refrigera-
little
^i^^ ^O offset
FiG. 47.-The West Sleeve Type [mechanithe process.
cally operated] Ammonia Compressor.
amount
of the
work done
in the cyUnder.
ing on the
method
The
low-pressure cylinder.
air
compressor
it is
deahng
as
it
does with
ammonia compression,
is
25 deg. F. which
cooling.
In
fact,
if
cooling
down
is
con-
to 25 degrees
is
way
that
it
question for
ammonia
the intercooler
is
compression.
to cool
down
61
intercooler pressure,
THE COMPRESSOR
62
250
Assumption.
_
200
expansion valve.
value.
150
100
+70
1-
Deg.
128.8
F.
lb.
50
+25
Deg.
F.
53.73
-25 Deg.
lb.
15.98
lb.
Entropy
Fig. 49.
Case
Cool to
Cool to
70 Deg. F
+ 25 Deg. with
Water
F. with
Problem
Liquid
NH3
and
to
+ 25 Deg
Case
Case
Cool to
Deg. F,
ro
with
Simple
Compres-
Water
F. with
NH3
Weight
of liquid
disch. gas, lb
Weight
evaporated in cooling
liquid evaporated in
first
of liquid passing to
sion, lb
0.0725
0.04275
0.0916
0.0916
0.0916
0.8359
0.8657
0.9084
0.7588
445.50
7860
461.0
44,450
39,800
84,250
46,020
39,800
85,820
9233
0.9008
0.9233
0.9008
0.9165
0.9008
0.8110
0.9165
9008
92,450
94,250
3.81
1.238
102,100
125,000
107,500
3.690
1.277
3.00
1.568
3.49
1.352
0.178
0.0916
0.822
484.2
0.822
482.7
0.822
482.7
48,300
44,450
92,750
101,400
53,150
44,450
97,600
for
refrigeration, lb
h.p.
l.p.cyl. ft., lb
cyl. ft. -lb
ft.-lb.
Coefficient of performance
Hp. per ton of refrigeration
Comparative
Gas
second expan-
ing
Cooled to
70 Deg. F.
with Water
exp. valve,
Work done
Work done
Liquid
Intercool-
l.p.
lb.
Weight
Case
No
Efficiencies of
3.75
1.257
Simple and
Compound Compression.
Case E
ton of refrigeration
is
is
concerned.
is
63
Referring to Cases A,
B and C
it
will
2*2bS.
16*abs.
85#abs.
vn.'
THE COMPRESSOR
64
The
cycle in Case E.
ammonia
to 25 degrees.
Oil
separator-
Brine
cooler
Low pressure
compressor
precooler
Liquid
^/precooler
y^\X\<\\iA
receiver
First inter
cooler
Brine
cooler""
J^^High pressure
compressor
Low pressure
compressor
Low pressure _
steam cylinder
Fig. 51.
.High pressure
steam cylinder
A Carbondale
65
THE COMPRESSOR
66
12
210
COMPRESSOR DETAILS
TABLE
67
.2\A
>\
S>|2
Dumbbell Type 2e
Key way
"~1
1 16
in.
by
in.
by
4J in.
140
Weight crated
200
in shaft.
Weight
R.p.m
lb.
lb.
380
50
59
68
77
86
95
4200
3560
3290
3050
2610
2410
1940
4000
3400
3170
2890
2500
2340
1820
3800
3250
3010
2770
2380
2220
1740
3640
3090
2850
2610
2260
2100
1660
3450
2930
2690
2490
2140
1980
1580
3250
2730
2530
2340
2020
1860
1460
13
57
12
11
10^
53
49
45
10
41
38
28.5
26.5
24.5
16.5
22.5
11.5
20.5
13.5
10.5
19
13
12.5
..53
.55
..58
.60
at Overflow-
18
With brine
at 27 deg.
15
.48
5-2
=16
*^
2 -916
Machine
-23-
when
^
I
711"
'3^'
I
^,
'
Keyway
by 7^
in.
Weight
390
1b.
"height crated
490 1b
in shaft
I in.
by
in.
r";r^74~H I'iZ^rr'
-2lf,+42|-H<-12f-4-10H
Condensing Water Temperature
at Overflow
R.p,n
28C
.50
59
68
77
10,500
8,910
8,220
7,620
6,530
6,040
4,850
10,000
8,510
7,920
7,230
6,240
5,840
4,550
9500
8120
7520
6930
5940
5540
4350
9100
7720
7120
6530
5640
5250
4160
8610
7320
6730
6240
5340
4950
3960
8120
6830
6340
5840
5040
4650
3860
30
114
57
38
27
107
54
36
27
26
100
50
33
25
24
93
47
23
85
43
28
22
1.02
1.14
1.26
95
33
120
60
at 27
deg.
31
24
1
38
1.50
THE COMPRESSOR
68
TABLE 2 Continued
Chabacteristics of No. 4 Audiffren-Singrun Refrigerating Machine
>68t*
3-38
3TJ-
Keyway
in shaft
Weight
Weight crated
^^
R.p.m
in.
by
J in.
by 8|
in.
850
lb.
1085
lb.
190
COMPRESSOR DETAILS
TABLE
Transmission Data for Belt-driven V.
3
S.
A.
70
THE COMPRESSOR
TABLE
Motor Engine Horse Power for
V. S. A.
Enclosed Compressors
COMPRESSOR DETAILS
TABLE
71
^Continued
u
3
72
THE COMPRESSOR
TABLE
COMPRESSOR DETAILS
TABLE
Capacities of V.
Cylinder
S.
A. Enclosed
Type Machines
73
THE COMPRESSOR
74
J ^<
-B-
TABLE
JL
D->1EI
Number
Enclosed Machine, with Oil Separator, Ammonia Condenser, Receiver and Connections
of
Machine
00
Shipping measurement
Number
4000
8000
tons
cwts.
cu.
ft.
16,000
1
tons
2f
250
250
200
11
16
35
COMPRESSOR DETAILS
TABLE
Cylinder
Size
75
THE COMPRESSOR
76
TABLE
^^^
-A-approx
Cylinder
Size
COMPRESSOR DETAILS
TABLE
77
10
78
THE COMPRESSOR
'
COMPRESSOR DETAILS
Vs
-9
J,
C
CO
Q
>
79
THE COMPRESSOR
80
COMPRESSOR DETAILS
,-;
81
CHAPTER
III
of the
tion in the refrigerating coils) of absorbing this gas into solution again
in order to
that
of
vacuum
it
Much
in
later,
1878,
Edmund
Carre
in
of
is
the old
Carre
perfected.
In
ammonia
the
ammonia and
steam coils submerged in the
condensed in an ordinary ammonia
is
appHed^ by means
of
to
some temperature
in the
which
is
shown
in Fig. 58)
whereby
this
a counter current flow exchange of heat with the stronger and colder
This operation permitted the stronger
solution from the absorber.
*
Described by Dr. John Hopkinson in 1882 before the Society of Arts. Such an
made about 12 tons of ice per 24 hours in 650-lb. blocks.
In the household refrigerating machine, gas or electric resistance coils provide
ice plant
*
return
to
83
to
a temperature
The ab-
as low
as
possible.
vised
Wood
in 1876 included
sorption
invented by Reece
traj^s
from the
separate
to
vapors
the
leaving
of
water vapor
which
is
present in the
ammonia
15 per
to
vapor
the
well as
as
ing)
by the
on
action
boiling in the
The analyzer
tor.
really
part
omitted
of
but
generator,
in
it
is
the
is
some de-
At present a
signs.
rectijier (or
is
of
genera-
dehydrator)
condense out as
much
water vapor as
can safely be attempted
of the
by
in
these gases
cooling
sort
cooled
of
water-
pre-cooler
preliminary
or
condenser
monia
is
in the
A liquid pump,
moving
am-
taken away.
part
the only
of
the
fe
84
85
machine, returns the strong aqua to the generator, the complete cycle
being shown in Fig. 59.
The absorption machine has never been very popular in the United
much more so than in Great Britain)
although in special work it has certain advantages over the compression type: for example, those plants having a large amount of exhaust
States for general refrigeration (but
for
,
gas
Ammonia
from expansion coils
-^
The
use
machine
low
of
the
absorption
Perforated pipe
temperatures
is
now no
Tt \
respect
it
Fig. 57.
and then
and also because of the decreased voluby the cylinder walls and ports. As stage
for
result that, as
The
The
as
is
much
the
at
values of the
in Bulletin
machine^
ammonia
86
depending in amount on
amount
to be boiled out of
inlet
it
The
might
be,
is
not as
is
at
7U^
.ooo.
o6\
ooo,
V004
ooo
Vooy
::i
oo
,ooo
i!
Fig. 58.
least reasonable.
The heat
The Exchanger.
by the steam
supplied
in the
steam
coils
To break up
ammonia and
the water.
2.
To
these variables
9 =
T =
0.70356(1
Vx +
x')
0.05(1.347
= mol
given by G. A. Goodenough
T ~
z
is
ammonia
2.9x
ammonia
1.77x2)
concentration of ammonia.
as,
<
<
<
87
88
140
130
Temperature
Flo. 60.
in
150
160
degrees fahrenheit
To
To
89
heat the entering strong aqua from the absorber and the
finally,
To
"*
where x
problem
is
345(1
x)
400x2
The
will
method
following
of calculation.
Problem. A strong aqueous solution enters the generator at 160 deg. F. and a
concentration of 35 per cent, and the temperature of the solution in the generator
The weak aqua leaving the generator has a concentration of 30
is 215 degrees.
per cent and the pressure in the generator is 145 lb. per square inch.
to the amount of 7.4 per cent is boiled off with the ammonia.
where
=
=
Xi
X2
l).r2
Water vapor
weak
and therefore
1-2-2
n =
xi
Heat
q
345(1
x)
lb.
Heat necessary
=c.
305
1.0
0.35
xi
- 0.30
=
- 0.30
= 345 ^
400x2
ammonia
= -
0.675
to vaporize the
0.3252
190.8 B.t.u.
to 76.8 deg.
ammonia
(at
145
lb.)
501.9 B.t.u.
e.
Heat required
/.
400
176.6 B.t.u.
Heat necessary
l)oiled out.
d.
14.0 lb.
128.4
Heat necessary
of disassociation
per 1.0
h.
88.3 B.t.u.
1.132
0.074
(215
969.9
160)
14.0
= 871
B.t.u.
lb. of
71.8 B.t.u.
Goodenough, Principles
off at
192 deg. F.
of
Thermodynamics.
is
90
TABLE
16
in Tons of Refrigeration
and Cooling Water per ton of Refrigeration under varying temperatures and pressures.
Also Standard and Minimum
steam pressure on Generator and factors for determining required ice making surfaces of Con., W. L. Coolers, Exch. and Rect. from given refrigerating cajiacity.
Square
TABLE
1(5 Continued
91
...
92
TABLE 16 Continued
Temperature
of Water, Degrees.
60
55
Type
Condensers:
Good water
90
85
Ton
15.0
Ice
Ref.
Atmospheric
16.5
9.7
18.0
10.3
Ice
Ref.
Ice
30.0
Ref. 17.6
Good water
Horizontal tabular
Where have
Good water
less
room
Multitube
Weak
80
75
Double pipe
Bad water
70
65
Ice
Ref.
17.0
10.0
18.5
10.9
Ice
Ref.
5.0
2.9
5.5
3.3
liquor cooler:
Good water
Double pipe
Bad water
6.5
3.8
7.0
4.1
7.5
4.4
8.3
4.9
9.3
Atmospheric
11.0
6.5
Ice
Ref.
Good water
Multitube
Where
6.0
3.5
less
space
Ice
Ref.
Ice
5.5
Double pipe
6.0
6.4
7.2
6.8
7.6
8.0
8.5
Note
Horizontal
multipass
brine cooler.
-5
+ 10
Surface per
11
12
Ton
-10
For
Refrigeration
14
Double pipe =
Double pipe =
-15
15
9.2 sq.
5.3 sq.
ton
ft.
per
ice.
16
ft.
ft.
per ton
per ton
ice.
ref.
Exchanger.
Multitube
Multitube
=
=
10.56 sq.
5.86 sq.
ft.
ft.
per ton
per ton
ice.
ref.
sq. ft.
sq. ft.
per ton
per ton
ice.
ref.
Same
as for Exchanger.
Rectifier.
Multitube
Multitube
=
=
6.6
3.9
sq. ft.
sq. ft.
per ton
per ton
ice.
ref.
Same
as for Exchanger.
TABLE
mContinued
Ammonia Pumps
Capacity, Tons
93
94
Experiment Station]
Problem. The use of the tables and diagrams can be brought out best by a
study of the operation of an ammonia absorption refrigerating machine. In order
to avoid indefinite generalities a particular case will be taken.
In this problem the ammonia solution enters the generator with a concentration
of 35 per cent, and leaves after the boiling off of the ammonia with a reduced concentration of 25 per cent.
The condenser pressure is 150 lb. per square inch absolute,
which will be taken as the generator pressure likewise. The average concentration
in the generator may be considered as 30 per cent.
The given generator pressure
will be reached v.'hen the solution has been heated to 217.4 deg. F. (Fig. 60) by the
steam admitted to the heating coils. Under these conditions the vapors leaving
the generator will show a water content of 7.4 per cent, corresponding to a partial
pressure of 11.10 lb. for the water vapor and 138.9 lb. for the ammonia.
On passing through the rectifier the vapors undergo partial condensation by
cooling.
The usual practice is to cool the vapors to a temperature approximately
20 degrees above the condensation point of anhydrous ammonia at the pressure in
In the present case the vapors will be cooled to a temperature of 98.81 degrees
use.
as will be seen by reference to the tables of the Bureau of Standards.^ This corresponds to a concentration of ammonia in the solution phase of 71.3 per cent, and
(for a temperature of 98.8 deg. F. and a concentration of annnonia of 71.3 per cent)
a concentration of water in the vapor phase of 0.160 per cent.
In other words, in
their passage through the rectifier the vapors have been robbed of part of their contained water, the partial pressure of which has been reduced to 0.25 lb., w^hile that of
the ammonia has been increased to 149.75 lb.
To do this some of the ammonia vapor evolved in the generator has been sacriIt is impossible to return any of the original water in the vapor to the genficed.
erator without returning such an amount of ammonia that the concentration of the
solution formed will be in equilibrium with the vapors remaining after the condensation.
Likewise it is impossible to cause this condensation without a cooling of the
solution, unless the vapor pressure be materially increased.
Solution of Problem.
Consideration of the case of 2000 pounds of vapor mixture
per cent
7.4
148.0
lb.
1852.0
lb.
Ammonia
Weight
Weight
of water returned
of
ammonia
Total
to receivers.
Total
Partial pressure of water vapor
Partial pressure of
ammonia
per cent
71.3
144.8
lb.
359.7
lb.
504.5
lb.
lb.
1493.10
lb.
1495.50
lb.
0.25
149.75
lb.
lb.
95
ammonia
latter.
to the generator,
it
follows that the back pressure in the cooling coils will be deter-
by the vapor pressure of a 35 per cent ammonia soluwhatever temperature the absorber may be kept during the operation of the
mined
tion at
machine.
further experimental
This rule may be applied in order to calculate from the data furnished in the table
for a temperature of 32 deg. F. the solution with which a given vapor phase will be
The quantity calculated in this manner as the amount
in equilibrium at 6 deg. F.
to be either subtracted from or added to the values there tabulated may be taken
as 3.17 per cent.
ammonia
solution at 32 deg. F.
is
in equilibrium
with a
this
same
vapor
of
will
The
39.0.
ammonia
tables of the
Bureau
of Standards
On
hand the tables of the Bureau of Standards give the value of 35.09
anhydrous ammonia at 6 deg. F. This is the pressure attained by a 35
per cent ammonia solution at 105.9 deg. F. and at this pressure the solution phase is
identical in composition with that furnished by the expansion valve.
No evaporation of water will therefore occur in the freezing coils.
In order that the machine
may work properly the average temperature of the absorber must be kept below
11).
the other
for
We may
The
pressure
is
is
20.5
is
now
by the difference between the water content of the liquid phase as supplied by the
valve and that of the vapor, or 0.095 per cent.
Of the 2.39 lb. of water passing
96
and the
ammonia.
tion,
lb. will
rest will
Performance.
accumulate in the coils to form 4.19 lb. of 66.1 per cent soluevaporate off into the vapor phase together with the residual
lb. of
ammonia
TABLE
efifect
17a
processes.
calculation here
97
pressure drop through the freezing coils will affect these calculations
unfavorably by further increasing the amount which will form of this liquid phase.
Furthermore, it is evident now that this condensation does not form water but a
ammonia
concentrated
Herein
lies
that these machines can have condensation occurring in the coils and yet not suffer
ammonia
solutions, the
temperature.
To
save space the author has appended Table 176 as a means of contrasting the
The
results
table
is
self-explanatory.
It is
evident that in order to secure identical refrigerating effects, the quantity of vapor
by the generator must be much greater in the second case than in the first,
and a much larger amount of ammonia must be returned to the generator from the
furnished
On
rectifier.
it is
tliis
imum
accumulation
temperature to wliich the absorber can be raised without prohibiting the proper
is not altered.
is
mined
b}^
concentrated
ammonia
must be
deter-
solution boils at a
ammonia. In those localities in which the chmate is such that the cooling
water around the absorber does not keep its temperature very low, it would greatly
increase the working efficiency of the machine to supply only the more concentrated
trated
ammonia
to the coils;
keeping the
rectifier at this
The
lems.
From
it
for
..
98
TABLE
176
Per 100
Per
Items
of
Ton
Vapor
Tons
of
Refrigeration per
Per 100
Per Ton
of
Vapor
24 Hours
of
vapor leaving
2000
148,0
1852.0
2000
148.0
1852.0
115,200
8,500
106,700
88.81
71.30
84.50
504.5
144.8
359.7
20,530
5,890
14,630
946.0
146.6
799.4
54,490
8,440
46,050
from receivers
0.160
Optimum
Optimum
24 Hours
98.81
(per cent)
Maximum
Maximum
of
Refrigeration per
rectifier
(degrees F.)
Water content
81,300
6,020
75,280
Tons
1495.5
2.39
1493.1
60,800
97.2
60,700
0.065
1054.0
0.69
1053
.
60,740
40
60,700
105.60
35.09
105.60
35.09
51.30
10.72
79.50
20.34
20.50
20.50
Pressure
of absorber at 80 deg. F.
(pounds per square inch)
Composition of equilibrium solution at
66.10
Water content
of
vapor at 6 deg. F.
(per cent)
in
Weightofaccumulatingsolution (pounds)
Weight of water
Weight
of
of
ammonia
0.065
0.095
0.00
4.19
1.42
2,77
170.3
57,7
112.6
14,9130
0,97
1490.30
60,621,3
39.5
60,581.8
0.0
0.0
0,0
0.0
0,0
0,0
(pounds)
Weight
Weight
0.065
coils
per cent)
Weight
66.10
of
water
of
ammonia
1054,0
0.69
1053.3
60,740.0
40,0
60,700.0
fc-
r->
99
100
"
9
00
CO
Ph
THE ABSORBER
101
total
Fig.
Separator
iV^^a^t
2.39
lb.
gas of which
lb. is
HjO
Rectifier
150
lb.
Absorber
/777777777^7777^n7777777777J77777^^p777777777V7.
Strong aqua
-Water
in
80F-35?f
Fig. 61.
water vapor above aqua ammonia. These values and the chart are
taken from Bulletin No. 146 of the Engineering Experiment Station of
of
the University of
The Absorber.
Illinois.
The
is
the
into
process
in
the
absorber
divided
is
the
condensation of
evaporator,
the liquid
The
and
c,
gas
the
absorption
the
Weak
6,
liquor inlet
Rubber gland
from the
the
ammonia by
Rubber gasket
of
ring
of
weak aqua.
Fig. 62.
-Mixing Device
in
Absorber.
is
deter-
102
(the temperature of
of liquefaction
ammonia corresponding
to the pressure)
strong aqua.
heated
up
anhydrous
must be conceived
to be
be solved:
Problem. The strong aqua leaving the absorber has a concentration of 35 per
and a temperature of 80 deg. F. The weak aqua has a concentration of 30
The heat absorbed
per cent and enters the absorber at a temperature of 120 deg. F.
by the cooUng water is required and the number of pounds of water per minute,
assuming a temperature rise of 10 deg. F.
The number of pounds of weak aqua circulated (Table 15) in order to absorb 1.0
cent,
lb.
of
ammonia
gas
is
7i
xi
X2
- 0.30
- 0.30
1.0
1.0
0.35
X2
1.0
13.0 lb.
where
lb.
practice to
a mixture existed.
The
The
b.
1.17)
(0.70
Mc{ti
h)
13.0
1.053
Q =
c.
606.5
132.0
ammonia
1.0)
1.053
(120
80)
345(1
345
x)
0.675
ammonia.
547.6 B.t.u.
474.5 B.t.u.
This
is
expressed by
Total
The amount
1.0 of
etc.
Q =
=
is
Q =
1212.9 B.t.u.
1212.9
--
10
121.3 lb.
14.56 gallons
If a standard condenser pressure was carried in the condenser the ammonia required
per ton of refrigeration would be at 20.5 lb. and 86 deg. F. condensing temperature
200
-h
(606.5
138.9)
0.428
0.428
lb.
in the absorber
6.23 gallons
would be
pressure
is
is
Circulation
is
by the conditions
this
no leakage
ammonia will be
coil;
that required
of operation.
system
The
for success.
feature of
While
is
The outstanding
the system
The Munters-Platen
an attempt to eUminate the strong aqua
exerted throughout the entire system and no
pump.
103
is
ingenious
it
total pressure
of hydrogen.
Rectifier
Condenser
Evaporator
Hydrogen
iv---V'^-'i
"3
Weak liquid
"
Ammonia gas
Ammonia and hydrogen
t^'^.':V- :'::<
ammonia
it is
the
not clear
undoubtedly
circumstances, to the gas-fired machine. ^
*
The
be.
It
equal to pi
liquid
exchanger
will
weak
Temperature
Fig.
Platen system
i|i;
'jji\
may
how
successful the
will
be taken as p
lb.
Munters-
is
Pz
=
=
ammonia
July
1,
Then
1926).
increases,
amount
104
The
tion
machine
The
intermittent absorp-
is
pump and
power in the machine. It is
automatic as regards the water control and the heating element, which
is gas fired always because of the cost, and a part of the machine acts
both as a generator and an absorber. Quite naturally refrigeration
cannot be continuous. However, several large installations have been
made, as for example in milk cooling after pasteurization.
feature of the design
is
Drain from
brine coolers
Condenser
''
Drain from
purge
''oil
tial
Pump^
separator
out line
From safety
valves"^
features of the
absorber
the
is
thorough mixing of
weak
This
aqua.
Check valve
Ammonia
,r^
suction line
^ Purge
Steam
/^
outlety^
Press/
gage
M
A
aqua
condition
the
in
to
this
meet
ammonia gas
Drain
Drain
To sewer^ glass
Fig. 64.
the
Water .*<j4
inlet^
Ammonia
press gage
socket
weak aqua
the
of
to
atmosphere
50 lb.
Thermometer
at
inlet,)
Water
complished in Fig.
62 by the device
Distiller to
inlet-
ac-
is
Purge Drum
Absorption Machine.
for
pipe perforated.
series of
The gas
Purging.
ammonia
is
necessary.
absorber generator.
the purge gas
is
Some
in
is
As an absorber, water
ammonia
in
cooled,
the
is
a special
ammonia
in
is
CHAPTER
IV
sary to
Fittings.
it is
neces-
The accepted
are not more than 200 lb. per square inch as a rule.
fonn of flanged joint is that kind employing the tongue and groove,
using generally a rubber or lead gasket, although asbestos and other
material are sometimes used.
Fittings may be designed with screV
ends up to 3 to 5 in., with oval, square and round flanges, depending
on the size of the pipe.
There are two methods of making up pipe and fittings,^ the first
method being the litharge and glycerine, and the second being the
solder joint in the case of black iron and steel pipe.
As a rule the
latter is confined to condensers and (possibly) to brine coolers that are
made up at the factory, and where the necessary equipment is at hand
The
process
is
using a
bright pipe
Solder must
cover all threads
In the larger
be
filled
Fig.
Solder
Recess.
is
1"
105
FITTINGS
106
AND CONDENSERS
case
the
solder
becomes
plastic.
and
over, in
is
ing the
making up
joint
is
of the threaded
be caused by
dirt.
by means
of
gasoline,
It is
result
much
is
work
that
heavier
M ]ii^L]&
4
for similar
and the
must
L_
mmm
Pm
would
'x
be.
casting
replaced
lar,
The drop-forged
steel fitting is
AMMONIA FITTINGS
cause of
its
lack of porosity,
its
107
is
can
it
dioxide refrigeration.
service under
give good
flange
although
these
conditions.
the
is
with
the
flat-
never attempted,
Fairbanks design
is
corrode
(if
water
is
Fig.
67.
present in
Safety
made
Fig. 68.
-Welded Headers.
welded throughout
(Fig. 66)
apparently welding
will
fittings
and
supersede
with the double pipe and the atmospheric type of condenser for ammonia, both of which are plentifully supplied with fittings and valves.
AND CONDENSERS
FITTINGS
108
Manifolds
made up
may be
rolled, or
of steel
is
forged,
van stone
j/
This
m;^77n
60
'-
-H
B-(3"to 12"
incl.)
A-(3 tol2
incl.)
t-
C- (4" maximum)
-^
minimum
t-
^-(4 maximum)
minimum
F-(4 maximum)
D- (8" maximum)
Mode
of
preparing"^
Finished
weld
Tl
twvv^
'.':i
H- (2 maximum)
G-(2 maximum)
I-(l"
maximum)
Ht^
dimensions d and
shall
_ Nominal
=
pipe size
8
Fig.
Nominal pipe
i"
+ f*
69. Methods
size
of
Flame Welding.
the method whereby the gases in two tanks, one of acetylene (C2H2)
and the other of oxygen, are mixed in a nozzle and the mixture is controlled by separate valves.
The weld is made by fusing the material
is
to be welded
is
and
for certain
in the
proper reinforcement
work the
welded heads
109
as for example
of liquid receivers.
entirely successful,
its place,
away
being done
is
with, wherever
convenient, by the use of the proper sized lap welded pipe manufactured
in the steel mill,
Valves.
type.
and pipe up to 90
When
in.
are.
diameter
may
obtainable.
is
4-^
4MvvX^^1^*
^'^
A=it.
'2'
'
.\\\\\\N\\\\\\k\i
Plates
position for
longitudinal weld
IVT^NUt-
Max. = t+
in
5%,^^''''^^^
_Minjmurn__
i;
2jtimes"t"
Completed weld
D
70. Methods
Fig.
hard or soft
seats.
The advantage
is
of
Flame Welding.
metal seat
dove-
seating and therefore causing a leak, but the soft seat has to be renewed
at regular intervals.
when
it is full
is
so designed as to
opened
designs
These have a
2
of
regulating
(expansion)
may
vessels,
is
open
may
be repacked while
valves
struction Code.
make a
are
fine
A. S.
M.
numerous.
adjustments,
E. Boiler Con-
FITTINGS
110
AND CONDENSERS
When
made
tight
ring or
steel.
When such close adjustments are not required a modified globe
valve of hard
or angle valve
may
be used.
foot of liquid
ammonia
per minute
is suffi-
150
lb.
and with a
difference of pressure of
On
Fig. 71.
Section of an Expan
expansion
cock
the
suction
use
of
pressure
An
isometric sketch of
Figure 80
fittings.
ammonia
83, 84
not required.
the
is
sion Valve.
large accessories.
is
the
of
the
purifier.
some
is
one
Figures
of the standard
low-pressure
suction
Fig.
72. Expansion
Valve.
Fig.
73. Elbow.
Fig. 74.
common
Flange.
York fitting. Tables 32 to 35, inclusive, give Frick practice. Tables 36 and
37 show Arctic, whereas Tables 20 and 21 give the dimensions of Crane
flanges.
It will
flanges for
ammonia
the width or the depth of the groove, and even the thickness of the
metal, size and spacing of the bolts, the distance between faces, etc.
111
Crane
of
present
dimensions for
fitting
any
The
ammonia
standardization.
Fig. 75.
Fig. 76.
and the
size
of
gaskets
means
of
an
gland.
In
the smaller
sized
pipe
joint has
annular
flanges
the
been made by
up the
Fig.
77. Section
of
the
joint.
hard
However
fiber
has
FITTINGS
112
AND CONDENSERS
gasket.
^ by
1:^
and
common
more
drop -forged
of
dioxide
more
or,
make
to
use
for
carbon
generally
speak-
fittings
for
3000
lb.
CONDENSERS
Historical.
In the early days of refrigeration the condenser was
nothing else than a round or a flat coil of pipe made up with suitable
ammonia
Ammonia.
leaks,
engineer
felt
heavy
cost.
The
refrigerating
were the
the shell
and
result,
coil
and
later
condenser was
developed.
resulting experience
available
As time
materials
elapsed,
80. Strainer.
more
still
this
was modified
for
CONDENSERS
tion
by welding throughout.
Finally
113
came the
shell
Fig. 81.
Ammonia
At
first
Distiller.
This condenser
was designed for vertical and horizontal shells, but the vertical
preferred and very nearly the only one used in the larger sizes.
Fig. 82.
is
in the
FITTINGS
114
AND CONDENSERS
pipe condenser appears to be too complicated,
with valves
plied
and certain
at times,
sive
is
exces-
of the de-
to arrange so that
amount
as
if
of the load.
It
seems at
and
of pipes
when one
first
made up
must be inefficient
fittings
considers that
it
is,
in all
engineering.
On
of condensers
Fig. S3.
made
great
Jnlet
first
2" flange
^1^
fem.
cost
Shell of tank
'Weld
difficulty.
The
conden-
ser
for the
purpose
is
service,
and
have been economical in the use of
water.
They can be erected so that
the leakage loss is very small and
repairs (if such are required) can be
Accumulator.
without
Outlet
2" fem. fig.
Baffle
plate support
of
heat
E.
H. coupling
welded
project
cases,
gas
2"x6"E.H. nipple
welded in
may be as high
250
deg. F. or even
as
300 deg. F. and the
denser
in for
Baffle plate
welded
coupling
in for
Fig
drain
Oil
l^^eparator.
CONDENSERS
per
ton
Some
minute.
per
receivers, particularly in
minor object
of
the
designs
case
function
as
partly
liquid
of
and
the condenser
115
The main
object
Liquid inlet
welding sleeve
jWelding
-14'^-H
sleeve"-
Liquid outlet
/
[
welding sleeve
I Welding
']
sleeve
Length of pipe
4
Aj XTScr.
tee
pipe^^^^^J^^^'*^
Detail
Fig. 85.
Liquid Receiver.
is
for
AND CONDENSERS
FITTINGS
116
refrigeration.
It consists of
The
the pipe
The
coils.
coils
is still
efficient in
coil or
refrigerant
is
joints
When more
below the
than one
to increase the velocity of the water flow past the surface of the pipe
Discharge
Cold storage
suction header
Long suction
line
thru tunnel
Fig. 86.
coils
by the use
of
In the old designs the rate of heat transfer between the refrigerant and
the water
but the
is
is
is difficulty
if
dirty or
used.
The
is
atmospheric condenser
made up
is
the
water
delivered to the outside of the upper pipe with the sacceeding pipes
CONDENSERS
117
k H-Dia.-->|
C-Dia. B.C.
E Cored hole
Size
Type
'
FITTINGS
118
AND CONDENSERS
may
by the
air
cooling
is
rh
-H
Gas
Left
Right hand
hand
IT
^outlet'
outlet
I'
-H- Ex.
hy.'
pipe
-A-4--^
To
Fig. 88.
Carbonic
CONDENSERS
119
a
o
d
o
FITTINGS
120
AND CONDENSERS
condenser, bringing in the gas at the bottom and making the upper
In order to remove the Hquid he drained off the conpipe a dead end.
lUinois
all
amount of
water was used.
amount
of water used
pipes
filled
lower pipe.
The
upper nine
pipes.
maximum
ture of the
nine pipes.
ammonia
ft.
long.
CONDENSERS
121
would seem to point out certain fallacies. If the temammonia remains constant throughout the condenser
where liquefaction occurs there is no material advantage in having a
counterflow as the mean temperature between the water and the ammonia will be identical in either case. However, there are designs which
If the superheat is
utilize the surface more effectively than others.
removed in two or three pipes there is no advantage in making the
condenser more complex in order to get rid of the superheat. In other
These
tests
perature of the
In general
it
refrigerant, air or
obtained
if
in-
layer of inert
same thing
made highly effective by the increased velocity of the gas flow occaby the resulting decrease in the cross-sectional area of the pipe.
This velocity is paid for by an increase in the pressure of discharge of
the ammonia from the compressor.
Tests by Ophuls and Greene and
is
sioned
by Shipley^ have indicated that the best condenser is that which drains
the condensate most promptly and which has as direct a path from the
condenser to the receiver for the Uquid as
The
it
is
practical to obtain.
condenser of the atmospheric, the double pipe or the sheU and tube
design
FITTINGS
122
AND CONDENSERS
slowness of the removal of the liquid, and in the resulting non-effectiveness of a portion of the surface.
Common
The
Atmospheric Condenser.
The
common
condenser
least
shown
It usually
Fig. 90.
at
atmospheric
is
in
has
pipes at
three
has
of
the con-
the
coldest
practically
the
water,
entire
load of condensation
is
a heavy
a higher
suction pressure or when relatively large quantities of warm water are
showered over the condenser. The liquid produced passes from one pipe
There is small likelito another and finally drains off at the low point.
hood of liquid sub-cooling because the temperature of the liquid leaving
Fig. 90.
condenser has
load
the
due to
pipes subject to
last
with
metal contact
warm
rela-
water.
The
lovv^er
tively
condensation pipes
non-effective,
due
presence of liquid
is
partly
to
the
ammonia
surface
as
is
the lower
not very
pipe
much
Fig.
In
all
likehhood
18,
six
pipes in the
is
from 8 to 10
ammonia
sq. ft.
is
concerned.
The
surface
is
CONDENSERS
123
in Fig. 92.
so that the
^Sprinkler trough
Fig. 92.
Air valve
where the greatest load on the condenser occurs. Two and sometimes three tap offs are provided for the removal of the liquid. Tests
this is
indicate
Fig. 93.
Distributing Troughs.
accounted for in the resistance to the flow of the gas through the
From 6 to 10 sq. ft. of surface are provided per ton
of refrigeration as a rule.
The Flooded Atmospheric Condenser. The flooded atmospheric con-
easily
an ejector
nozzle, as
shown
AND CONDENSERS
FITTINGS
124
is
carried in
more or
less large
plugs up to the
upper pipe, on arrival at the upper part of the condenser the Uquid
separates from the gas and the two flow independent of one another
except for the contact at the top of the liquid surface. The velocity of
the gas in 2-in. pipe
ditions about 8
pipe.
ft.
is
of the gas
Detail
Fig. 94.
flooded condensers
it is
performing equally.
minimum head
any apparent
'X'
when placed
This condenser,
pressure,
in parallel
and
also, is
this pressure
all
with other
the condensers
may
cause.
The atmospheric
condenser needs to
air,
freely.
Where
compressor room some other form or design must be used. For such
conditions as in theatres, office buildings, hotels, etc., the double-pipe
condenser needs to be used and (up to within the
last
The
inner pipe.
The water
is
is
and
counter-
inside the
CONDENSERS
125
number of passes corresponding to the numHaving a fixed path the water velocity
stand.
can be varied at
will,
something which
is
The
Fi(i. 95.
amount
of water
the
pumped through
incident-
friction
FITTINGS
126
AND CONDENSERS
and
fittings
takes place in the lower two pipes incidental with the coldest water.
effect
some
accumulate in the lower pipes. Subcooling is therefore not an inherent advantage of the douVjlc-pipe condenser, but indicates faulty piping or something not as it should be in a
This condenser is frequently
correctly designed and erected apparatus.
other cause
a favorite for
makes the
it
liquid
is
is
excellent in its
there
is
manner
The tubes
are laid
free
chance
fittings,
although there
is
maintain tightness.
distributors,
CONDENSERS
127
-58
-54^
51f
484"
Dia- bolt
J"
Tube sheet
Dia. flared
'i'?l-^,,*
dia.
ends
--*i
'S'^U^
^Vn^
-45ri.D.- --]lp^'!yC
Weld
inside
and outside.
Fig.
96.The
Shell
FITTINGS
128
h-f-1
AND CONDENSERS
-T-f
I
I
I
"^-^
I
i'r
CO
W
^
'
"moo
V
Y
'
Slot Distributer
Fig. 97.
Slot Distributer
Cast Iron
Cast iron
Slot Distributer
Cast Iron
(7 Pass)
thin film.
129
the hquefaction takes place in the upper part of the condenser and the
two
transfer
is
of
liquid films
and there
large
is
a prompt freeing
the
of
Water baffle
sur-
The
may
it
in
shock
negligible.
is
Arranged
no diffi-
in batteries there is
culty in
denser take
its
of the load.
proper share
safety valve
The
rupture of the
shell
shell.
is
from 12 to 15
sq. ft. of
transfer surface
refrigeration,
per
but
heat
ton of
tests
by
Fig.
amount is excessive.
Heat Removed by Condenser.
is
99. The
Shell
equal to the refrigerating effect plus the heat equivalent of the work
This
may
be expressed per
4.713
lA
Er
tZ
ts
1-2
42.44
200
200
^4
is
i:i
ij
i)-]
Where
is equal to the increase of the total heat per pound of
ammonia during the compression, i^ ^2 is the refrigerating effect per
pound of ammonia and E,- is the real volumetric efficiency of the compressor.
With an expansion valve ii = io (Fig. 1).
t's
FITTINGS
130
Water Requirements
AND CONDENSERS
The Condenser.
of
Amount
of
condenser
200('A^) X
8.33
(1-2
(^2
h) represents the
8.33
^i)
rise in
{to
(i-
h)
densing water.
Heat removed
theoretically
_
^
^latent
0"
where
r
The
if
Xr
200
/
{13
= H
n)
(Fig 1)
ii
is
used,
0.
Vaftercooler
Qs
{superheat
c.
200
{h
200
/
(is
where
ta,
tb,
and
tc
{u
difference
ii)
ii)
i&)
^7)
is
_Qiti-\-Qata-^ Qs
ts
The
(ti
Effect of Inert
Gases
respectively.
in the Condenser,
it
In
steam condenser
of air in the
of heat transfer
as
the
amount
heat transfer.
sum
CONDENSERS
131
and that the partial pressures exerted by each gas or vapor are those
which would be caused by each occupying the volume by themselves.
In other words,
where pi
P2
=
=
pi
p2
ammonia
Fig. 100.
AND CONDENSERS
FITTINGS
132
ammonia condenser
air in
(air),
where
M=
MBT
pv
B =
gas constant
T=
V =
volume
in cubic feet of
lb.
per
The
ammonia
pressure of the
partial
is
a pressure of 10
lb.
vv
-Bf-
^^
12
42.9
53.3
10
X 144 _
X 530 "
is
20
""^^^
^^-
As the refrigerating system is a closed one and the pressure is normally always greater than atmospheric pressure there is not much reason
However there is always some air
for air to get into the condenser.
remaining in the system on charging, or whenever repairs are made to
any part
of the plant
when it is operated
The action of the
compressor
up
as
it
of the air
The
method
old
will increase.
of purging
denser was to open the purge valve and permit some of the gas to escape
to the atmosphere.
necessary, for
to get rid of
of purging
if
it,
is
air
INERT GASES
E- cored
ifji
hole
D-rad
gy
CO*
CO2 Flange
4-Bolt Type
Size
133
AND CONDENSERS
FITTINGS
134
is
monia
will
is lost,
but
if
is
ammonia
is
Diameter,
and 2
12
12
5 and 6
20
16
20
20
30 to 50
60 to 100
125 to 200
20
24
24
8 to
25
am-
0.216
19
Ammonia Accumulators
Receivers
Length
Inches
12
0.11 lb. of
Oil Separators
'eet
1
^^ =
lost.
Ammonia
Tons Ice
Making
If
4.04
TABLE
Receivers High-pressure
coils.
deg. F. then
the temperature
be the amount of
ammonia
Weight,
Pounds
lb.
CONDENSERS
h-0-
-J
^::;..-o:v-::.j
135
136
FITTINGS
AND CONDENSERS
TABLE
21
Crane Co.
Male
Female
CONDENSERS
TABLE
Dimensions of
23
Tongue
^In
:
.
Groove
All
Size,
P.T.
137
I
I
FITTINGS
138
AND CONDENSERS
bC
XXXXXXXXXXX
XXXXXXXXXXX
fe
COOGOCOOOGOOOOOOOC^lN
XXXXXXXXXXX
-o
^
(a
-llNHN-HlNrtlMrtlNrHlNrHlNHO
a*
_|rtioo_to_tou:iooH'i'H|cert|tiH|)rt|aOrt|o
I--* lO CO t^ GO
"l-HCO
-^l-i
(N
CO Tf
O IM
rH
i-H
t'lt'Ioot-loor-IooH(Ot-|oot*|oo
nltonltctnltDknltOinlto
H|r-(|aOH[QOH[aOH|aOnKn]^H|aOHlGOH|H|go
(MCQ-^'^llOlOCDt^OOOCO
'"^
CCCO^TfiiOtO
l-H 1-^
^1-*
>n|ooH|aOrt[-f^l-*nl-*t^ t-|oo
t-05^fC
rH rH
Wl^COlOOflOO-^lN
rtlNWl^WlSOt-loO
rH|^
1-H
HOO
|Q0FH|(NFH|Win|00r^Meol'*H'^|H
l-lTHr-(rH,-(rHl-H,-((M(N(M
rHrtrHT-(rHT-(i-((M(N(NC<l
o
<
*^
fci
1h
lHlO[QOWlaOiH|Hw|-*HliHt-|rt|F^nH
1-H
|XU5|00rt|rH|<O
|
I rH
I
M|-#nl'*nlaort|IN
111-*
rH|-M|Nra|-
T}<-*IOCDCDI>00 050<M-*
T-l
1 I
I
>nlcOH[)in|aOrH|gotn|aDr^lr^[)THlaoH<lOH|aOH|ao
05
(MCCCOTtiT}Hio<:Ot>GOO<M
rH 1
t^t^OOOSOiOi-tiMTjicOQO
OJ
CONDENSERS
TABLE
25
All
Size
139
140
AND CONDENSERS
FITTINGS
TABLE
General Dimensions of
"
26
York "
Oval Flange
[*--<i>j
d=dia. of
bd
Tees
CONDENSERS
TABLE
Principal Dimensions of
27
Oval Flange
All
Size
141
142
FITTINGS
AND CONDENSERS
TABLE 28
Principal Dimensions of "York" Ammonia Valves
Screw Valves
CONDENSERS
TABLE
143
29
H= Size
of bolt
>UVJ
L.
ii
Size
PITTINGS
144
AND CONDENSERS
TABLE
General Dimensions of
"
30
Size
CONDENSERS
TABLE
31
Size
145
146
FITTINGS
AND CONDENSERS
TABLE
32
< -B
C.
I.
Screw
CONDENSERS
TABLE 32 Continued
C.
< G
Ammonia Ells
Size,
I.
Screw
147
148
FITTINGS
AND CONDENSERS
TABLE
34
for lees
Square
&
crosses only
Boss
^w.4_d.
Size,
Flange
CONDENSERS
TABLE
36
All
Pipe
Size
Dimensions Given
in Inches
149
150
FITTINGS
AND CONDENSERS
TABLE
37
CONDENSERS
K-
OS
CQ
a
I?
o
Eh
r/3
^B
>1
151
152
FITTINGS
AND CONDENSERS
TABLE
39
Carbondale Condensers
Refrigera-
CONDENSERS
S
bO
153
FITTINGS
154
bX)
a
-^
H
Q
O
O
5
o
s
P3
tc
CO
O
H
<;
O
<
0)
a
a
'3
1
AND CONDENSERS
IIt
I(
IIiI
CONDENSERS
156
CiOO
C<)
T-*
tO^O
rHiMTf
Tj<cD05
005CJ
t^
GOIMO
GOOlO
T-t
ooo
Tft>od
CD05(N
005CSI
05G0O
iooo
ooo
C0>Ol>
-<lJcDOO
rl<t>.od
CO CO CO
(M rH lo
i> o
1-iT-ICO
fOiOCO
o lo lo
o o CD
i-ii-l(M
C0-^0
CO CO
00 00 r-
^H (M
-"^
<* CO 05
(MOO
(M
t>-
OO
CO O lO
GO >0 O
rH (N CO
-^COt^
lOcdo
lO
CO
CD CO
OOC^IO
^H
(N CO 0
CO lO CD
-"ti
jsi
O O 0
CO I>
(M CO lO
CD 0> (M
lOiOO
OOCOOO
(M
Tf 00 05
t-
T-H
OO
03
Tt<
-"tl
OO
CD t-
rHi
CD
CD 00
O
,[.-Hi
-^oo
CO
r-<
1-t
lO
oo
00 <N *
OO
O CO
O CD O
r-1
l>
il ,1
lO CD 05
OOO OOO
lOO
T-H
00 CO -^
. tH
00
(M t^ i
l-H.i:^
oo o~
05
-TtH
l>
1 I
OO
(N 00 00
i-l(N CO
COCDI>
lCl>.Oi
ooo
(Mloo
(N CO CO
l>.
00 00 lO
CO l>
1 (M lO
COOiOl
CO
CO
*
O tH
O
i-H
o
tH (M *
lo "0 o
lo lo
<M CO CO
OOO
TJH
t^ Oi
oo
t- (N *
CD OC O
00
.-H 1-H
CD 05
lOiOiO
^(MO
i-HC^-*
UOOOO
OO
C<)
r-H
^H
Tti
OO
(N-*t>
oocoic
lOiOO
(N
C^ CO CO
t>. 1-H
rH rH
COO
10 CO
CDOOi-H
7^
CO 05 C^
^ 00 O
(N 05 CO
(^
CO 00
O
,I,
.-H
.t.
oo
CO O (M
rH T
00 (M *
.I rH
Oi CO CD
C^ 05 C^
C^
CO
O lO 00
OO
,-1 .-H ,-<
.-I
05
<-H
00 ic 00
(N CO CO
lO
TfH
CO
CO
1-H
.-I ;^)
t--(_
^^
OOO OOO
(,-H
t^ C^
,(.1^
OOO ooo
i T
CD Oi
^r-<,-l
rH
OO
Oi * CD
rHi-H
^^
O lO
.-KNC^
OOO OOO
lO 00
O
,-H^^rH
.-H
Oi-^LO
oi-^co
CD
1-Hi-HCM
1-H
rH
i-H i-H
COC>CO
rH (M C^
iO<Mit^
1-H
(M (M
CO
OOO OOO
CD 05
O
rHrHi-H
oo o
ooo
J>
(M CO 0
CD05.-H
O0(Nt}<
05 CO CD
05CO0i
OOO
*!
(N
rHi-H
COiOt>
oo
OOCOCD
I-H 1-H
03
!>. t-(
-^OOO
1-H
C3
OO
OiCiO
I^H
to
CO
CDoi^
I
0(NCO
T-H
Eh
o t> o
i-H
ooo ooo
r-
lO
OO
(N
-"l*
(N lO
l-HrHQ]
O IC
OO
rHC<)C<l
eOlNrti
OOOO
(M
ooo OOO
rH tH (M
lO CO 05
(N
rH IM (M
1-H
.-HOOO
<N 05 CO
CD
t>-0<N
OiiOOO
OiC0
TjHC^IO
OOOO
OOO OOO
(NIN-*
U300O
t^lM-*
05CO>0
OiTjHl--.'
CO a>
05 !M CO
1-H
rHCOlO
o 00
*
00 CO
.-HCOI>
t^ ic 00
rH Ttl 00
lOOlO
lOiOiO
ICIOIO
rH rH
TJH
r-HrH
,-HrH(N
rHiHC^l
oj r^H
+e
&
bC
lOOO
^M
lOLOiO
1-H
(M CO
H (M CO
rH (M CO
rH (M CO
CHAPTER V
THE AUTOMATIC REFRIGERATING MACHINE
The
larger
refrigerating
full
way
room and that there be a regulator for the water (if water cooling is
used) and for the suction pressure, in addition to various other safeguards. Under these conditions the only need for an operating engineer
is to prevent clogging of valves, to maintain satisfactory lubrication and
watch against leaks or such troubles as might interfere with the
Development of such automatic
machines results in an immediate expansion in distribution, not only to
the small retail trader of meats and provisions, the florist and caterer,
but to the soda fountain and small ice cream retailer and to household
trade.
Automatic refrigeration has made the 2, 1 and the fractional
tonnage compressor practical.
The Direct Expansion System. The very small compressor is
to
designed so that
it
Such a compressor
may
is
always
electric
will
There would be
is
prac-
THE THERMOSTAT
c.
157
is air
cooled.
evaporator
coils
machine
is
of the compressor.
is
the
of
down
'^^..
-:P>
The
may be of the
102 and 103) which dethe variable expansion and contraction of
The Thermostat.
metal type
dissimilar
pends on
thermostat
(Figs.
it is
exposed or
it
may
be designed
of
ture.
Two
a.
The
102).
different designs
flat strips
is
twisting
moment
of the rod
b.
bi-metallic
fall
is
of the temperature.
left of
If
the motor
compressor
is
satisfactorily.
158
be placed in the cold room or the brine and a flexible tube connection
be made with the bellows. The mercoid control shown in the
illustrations can be adjusted to make and break contact with a differential temperature of from 3 to 4 deg. F. The action of the sylphon is
to tilt the mercury tube. The tube contains mercury and an inert gas
may
Fig. 103.
to
stifle
Monogram
Full-line Voltage
The normal
Thermostat.
current
is
10 amperes
is
the mercury tube have been tested to over one-half a million operations
without signs of
failure.
is
Valve.
As
In the
it is
of the
side of the
diaphragm
is
159
subject to the
reduced pressure of the refrigerant, while the other side has the pressure
_rl/>^
yrrrrrrrrTWm|-T
,'
1'
i|
Pipe thread
-<
j
Fig.
iri
1
'
,^j
|_jlIj'ili!iliJ
X7"
Fig. 105.
exerted
by a
of the tension
making
it
160
disc are
made
of
the diaphragm is
monel metal and
steel,
made
of
the body
the
of
valve
of
The
Cash valve
and
(Fig.
109)
^1
just
described.
It
is
trap
made an
integral
be placed adjacent
the
to
it
in order to prevent
lodging on
The
Brunswick
valve
(Fig.
sliding action
free itself of
it
etc.,
is
from
Kroeschell
obtains a
which tends to
any scale, and
Ill)
besides
designed
for
thereby tend-
ing to prevent
the flooding
the valve
of
the
evaporating
coils
the compressor.
The
likely to stick
WATER CONTROL
move
made with
continually oscillating) to
lever
and
engagement
is
axially.
amount
of
161
It is
cam
the
Water
Control.
The
Adjusting
screw
Lock nut
Fig. 107.
type (Fig.
14)
makes use
amount
Another
exit
periods of shutdown.
162
may
pass
greater or lesser
amount
depending on the
pass,
of water to
tem-
initial
on the condenser.
regulator valve
(the
(the
Monogram
valve).
in
water
of
Fig. 115
116
Fig.
In each of
spring
which
means
is
of
for
set
heli-
some
Fig.
pressure
American
Radiator
pansion Valve.
increases
until
it
gets
The amount
of water
will increase
with an increase
the capacity
of pressure until
of the valve
reached.
is
Some
An
by a
water
supply,
guarded
not
condenser
be
safe-
against
rehef valve,
is
can
usual
refrigerating
in
automatic
machines,
even
tem.
better
method
to
E.x-
of
Fiq.
WATER CONTROL
163
Hydraulic bellows
and tube
Fig. 110.
164
control
is
to
for
stop
small
the
machines
compressor
working amount.
In
machines we may
have a condenser pressure
circuit breaker, which has
to be controlled manually.
Figure
117 shows one
type of water pressure failure
switch.
The water pressure
is exerted
on one side of
rubber
the
diaphragm, the
other side of which has the
able
larger
pressure
Outlet
Fig.
of
light
The
Brunswick-Kroeschell
111.
Valve.
Consideration up to the
present has been given only
to those plants
where there
ing
the
plant,
it
is
down
coil
stem
valve
motion is communicated by
means of a toggle joint to
the electric connection, which
can be of the knife-edge
spring.
until
the
conditions
are satisfied.
The thermo-
each room,
can not be attached to the
compressor but only to the
static control to
Fig. 112.
WATER CONTROL
165
^^Adjustment
screw
Water pressure
balancing chamber
Water
Fig. 113.
inlet
Water
Fig. 114.
Fig. 115.
outlet
Water Regulator.
166
will
need to be obtained, not from the temperature of the rooms, but from
the drop of the suction pressure in consequence of stopping the hquid
feed to
all the
evaporator
coils.
Monogram
The thermostat
energizes
the relay and through the relay the magnet operates the toggle joint.
Fig. 116.
Monogram
Water Regu-
Fig.
117.
Water
Pressure
Failure
Switch.
lator.
is
liquid valve
will
stop as
vaporized.
operation
be obtained
when
all
lb.
the coils
coils in
operation
if
the expansion
gage.
WATER CONTROL
at which time the compressor will function only to
V.
1
1
11
1 1 1
mM M
mi u H
M,
iii^Viiii\Ui>i\iiHi\ii\rtmi\ni\iii\ui>iii\i\niii\i\iuW>(\iirt
L i
pump down
the low
pressure system.
(o
167
>
<
H HI
I
1 1
1 1
< 1
I >i
^
3^
-J
1.
coils
illustrated.
Somewhat
different
is
the Hilger
No-freeze (Fig. 123) back valve. In essentials the hquid, after leaving
168
the automatic expansion valve, passes through the upper part of the
The suction gas on its return has to pass through
way^
is
Under voltage
release coil
m
iyjjjBell
I
Ringing
Alarm
circuit
To current
*"
^zzz;
Fig. 119.
supply
first
Where
is
Where
thermostat switch.
a plurahty of
which
there
coils,
requires
will
need
each of
control,
to
thermostatically
be
controlled
to
erating machine
automatic.
is
essentially
It is inconceiv-
extensively
cabinets,
for the
tors,
small
could
any other
lesser
boxes,
and
extent,
perhaps,
the
constant
attention
It
appropriate, therefore, to
169
170
In
all
FiG. 121a.
Fig. 1216.
Fig. 121.
eration
is
and
its
Fig. 122.
171
Pressure-actuated Switch.
Fig. 134.
Suction
Fig.
Fig.
172
and
all.
is frequently found
At times the ice delivery service has not
and some localities have not been able to secure ice at
unreliable.
this,
The
storage
has been found to be unsatisfactory
for
without
in
many
may
cases.
refrigerators
Fig. 126.
In general,
it
obtained lower than 35 and are more often greater than 40 deg.
The mechanically
times
'
it
The Transactions N.
Jr., in
which
it
M. Greene
250 ice-cooled refrigerators which
less
of
At
same
than 45 deg. F.
The
173
good
compartment
at all
results.
Fig. 127.
Kelvinator Compressor.
have to be used for the entire 12 months. There are a number of automatic features in the household refrigerating machine; the thermostat,
the excess pressure cut-out, and the suction pressure control.
condenser
If
the
more
failure of the
machines provide
Most concerns
174
month.
Fig. 128.
Universal Compressor.
The
usual refrig-
erants are ammonia, sulphur dioxide, ethyl and methyl chloride, butane,
isolutane, propane, etc.
Carbon dioxide
its
is
excessive pressure.
By means
of
the automatic suction pressure control and the use of a suitable thermostat,
set at 35 to 40 deg.
F.,
will,
and
is
usually
of the absorption
175
Compressed gas
Electric
motor
to
condenser
Condenser
coils,
Discharge
valve
@1
__
(Q)
(o
(o
Compressor
<
Evaporator
immersed
Fig. 129.
in
freezing solution
4-ton capacity, and some water-cooled condensers. The air-cooled condenser has a higher temperature of liquefaction of the refrigerant with
is
an added load to
176
^ton
size.
In the
Dome
coik^v
charging
^^'^^
/Eccentric shaft
ft.
Motor control
Sylphon bellows
Flapper valve
Water control
Sylphon bellows
Cylinder head
SOa liquid
in sump
Piston
Switch
weight
Liquid
SOj
line
Water
lines
Liquid
SOj
strainer
Eccentrics
Oil in^
crank case
Thermostat
line,
Oil in
bellows
to brine tank
gear case
Switch
Stuffing box
clamp
N_j^
Thermostat "^^ct. ,;,, K
Stuffing box spring
charging valve
Fig. 130.
Float Valve
Fig. 131.
may
valve
float
relatively small
is
is
is
177
the diaphragm
of the refrigerant
why
the reason
valve can be used and in the sulphur dioxide compressor this kind of
expansion valve works out best as regards the lubrication of the compressor. The diaphragm type of compressor can be set for any pressure,
A-Compressor
j j
T B- Condenser
0-Liquid
P-Vapor
line
line
f f
t
E--Expansion valve
i i
K-High
'T
'T
pressure cut-off
I
'
'
C-Receiver
D-Bnne
H-Thermostatic control
tank
Direct Expansion
System
Flooded System
Fig. 132.
Float
on Low Side
M-Condenser
'
I
N-Suction
shut-off valve
Flooded System
Float on High Side
valve
The thermostat
is
If
the condenser
number
of ways.
is
178
such a manner that the temperature of the exit water will vary the
amount of the water flowing to suit the conditions of the plant, or the
water control may be attached directly to the compressor. Still another
method
is
pressure.
to use a
diaphragm type
of valve, operated
by the conc'enser
pressors, several of
common
oil will
so as to be very self-contained.
built.
use.
The automatic
controls need to be so
well designed that they will function for a period of time without adjust-
ment
or repair.
work
in well.
the generator
is
is
may
liquid after boiling in the expansion coils returns to the generator again
in order to re-enter solution.
CHAPTER
VI
HEAT TRANSFER
Refrigeration, like other branches of heat engineering,
is
vitally
through the building material and from the consideration of the flow
of heat through the various parts of the refrigerating cycle. At times
the refrigerating load
is
thought.
and so the
insula-
is
is all
important in
the condenser, brine cooler, or other evaporating surfaces of the lowpressure side, and in the generator, rectifier, exchanger, absorber,
of the absorption machine.
The problem
in
many
cases
is
also
etc.,
com-
plicated
surface and
Some
up
briefly.
place in
of
convection.
it is
be taken
Theory
and
is
small,
Every
Radiation.
definite absorbing
The amount
of heat
it)
in English units,
RA{T'^2
by
T'^l)
where
T2 and Ti are the surface temperatures in degrees absolute of
the bodies in question,
is
i2 is
a constant.
179
HEAT TRANSFER
180
In refrigeration, as radiation by
neglected in most cases.
the thermometer
may
when exposed
to direct
Convection
losses
It is
The
nearly
to ^
in.
fluid
is
It varies,
with
air,
is
from
not of
Qconvectlon
NV
^A(t2
EngUsh
by
ti)
where
is
F~"
is
some power
section,
(to
^i) is
surrounding
air.
Conduction.
Conduction is the means whereby heat is conveyed
through molecular vibration, under which conception there is established a temperature gradient in the material.
It is well established
homogeneous, and nominal temperatures are being employed that the heat flow becomes:
experimentally that
if
the material
is
AfC\t2
tlj
Where
is
is
^i) is
CONDUCTION
181
and
the
Qeonvectlon
"T
R[it
^jconvectlon ^^ '^l\J'
460)
and
Irradiation
and convection
hour becomes:
(ti
+ NV-\t -
460)]
U)
becomes
'lj>
is
exposed to nominal
becomes
^radiation
^convection ^^
toj
ri,2\f'2
and
C
vt/conductlon
^^
'2y
TnV'l
where
T =
C =
As Q at any part
of the wall
must be equal
to that of
of
the section,
Q =
ki{t
1 =
^_Z_ii _L
h)
= ^{h -
t2)
k2{t2
to)
U{t
to).
Therefore,
_i_
^1
t2
^2
,
^0
to
J_
and
U =
7p
ki
It is clear
in the
etc.
k2^ C
formula
TJ
kl^ k2^
Cl
pff,
C2~^ Cs
This equation
this
Willard and Lichty, Bulletin No. 102 of the Engineering Experiment Station,
University of
Illinois.
HEAT TRANSFER
182
of not
for insulation
is
also
the heat transfer per square foot per hour for 20, 40, 60, 80 and 100
material.
and
are included.
A:2
Fig. 133.
although
Ai
it
is
workmen
justified,
each inside,
it is
summer months
are given in
maximum
temperature
not the
air
that should be taken for the calculation of the heat leakage, but the
maximum
^
tion Committee,
American Society
is
CONDUCTION
TABLE
183
43
-U. S.
Bureau
HEAT TRANSFER
184
The
insulation of pipes
is
given by Heilman
from that of
plates (as
flat
nominal pipe
size as
found by experiment.
The
those for drinking water, standard brine and extra thick brine.
for heat transfer for these thicknesses are given in Tables
TABLE
Values
48 and 49.
44
[B.t.u. per
Hour]
(These values are based on the tests run under most satisfactory conditions)
C per 1 In.
Thickness per
Square Foot
per 1 Deg. F.
Material
Wood
(fir,
Deg. F.
1.40
8.30
1.00
0.32
0.50
2. 06 J
1.00
0.60
0.47
0.84
0.50
0.30
1.30
on both surfaces
4-in. tile, |-in. plaster on both surfaces
6-in. tile, |-in. plaster on both surfaces
2-in. tile, plastered as above and roofing covered
Asbestos board
Sheet asbestos
glass, |-in. air
Air per
.00 (5.00)
Corkboard
Magnesia board
Double
A'
Still
1.40
1.25
1.45
.5 to
2.00
1.10
1.10
1.10
1,25
1.60
1.40
area)
1.50t
5.30
Roofing*
2.00
1.25
.00-1. 70
Air spacef
8.0
0,42
Mortar
Shavings
0.93
* Calculated from values of C for 2-in. tile with and without roofing.
"*"
\c
c,
Ci)
t See "Air Spaces."
X Per square foot of actual glass set in wood frame but based on total heat transmitted.
i For thickness and construction stated, not per 1 in. of thickness.
Kinds
of Insulations.
number
Referring
to Table 43,
it
will
be seen that
made without
all
For
KINDS OF INSULATIONS
185
space
1-in. air
per hour.
is
It is
fibre.
sulations
like
rock
asbestos
and
others
cork, w^aterproof
similar
of
vegetable
felt,
inlith,
nature.
Plan
36
in.
be obtained from
in l^, 2, 3, 4,
|^
to
and 6
1 in.
by
eighths,
Elevation
Fig.
134.
Continuous
Vv'all
Insulation.
and
in.
except
its
in
it
in 1917
and 1918
it
can be
is
made waterproof by
186
HEAT TRANSFER
KINDS OF INSULATION
rH
rH
187
-H
,-1
rt
HEAT TRANSFER
188
TABLE
46
Materials.
KINDS OF INSULATIONS
189
HEAT TRANSFER
190
by the mortar finish. The mortar finish assists in making cork fireproof,
but under any conditions it is a very slow burning material. At the
present time corkboard is used in the majority of installations where
In the case of tanks, shell and tube
molded insulation can be used to advantage, but in
many cases granulated cork can be packed around the body to be
insulated and held in place by means of a container made of tongue and
grooved lumber with waterproof paper between the layers. A good
example of this construction is shown in Fig. 270 for ice tank construcflat
brine coolers,
etc.,
tion.
TABLE
48
Size of
ERECTION
engineer
is
191
insulation
is
that there
is
it.
The usual
is
practice
practical,
is
to
make
and to use a
factor in the calculations for heat leakage that will allow for irregularities
in the erection
Erection.
and
the
favorable.
may condense back of the corkboard and even enter the interbetween the granules of cork, thereby causing a disintegration of
which
stices
the cork.
The
still
Cement
is
HEAT TRANSFER
192
does, but the latter
Cement
mortar.
apphed
in
is
less
than cement
finish for
feet.
cork insula-
the
It
maximum
4.
It
should be sanitary
a finish that
may
not absorbent
of odors
and
it
should have
damage.
5.
It
should be odorless
itself,
it
spaces.
6.
It
edge.
It must be economical.
For the great majority of work there has been no alternative in the
The choice has been Umited to the ordinary
selection of the finish.
plaster, not because it was satisfactory and fully met service conditions,
but because it was the only material available.
Plaster, however, is objectionable, and has proved unsatisfactory in
many particulars. In the first place it does not bond well with cork.
Cork is without suction or capillarity, and a surface that lacks this
property is difficult to plaster on with any assurance of good adhesion.
There are many instances where plaster has fallen off the cork sheets,
and has had to be replaced with the addition of wire mesh or expanded
8.
make
its
use
is
by
cracking.
It is
193
it
will
Standard Construction.
tion'*
construction.
tested
following schedules:
Brine thickness.
Special tliick brine.
Ice water thickness.
is
applied.
all
and smaller
pipes 8
in.
Fig. 135.
Pipe Insulation.
for
and smaller
and 10 in. and
in.
with
all
one-half of the
first
(Fig
135).
All
half 36 in. in
all
joints
and wired
in place with
copper-clad steel wire, using not less than six wires to a section.
For brine thickness molded fitting covers shall be used on all screwed
and flanged fittings 6 in. and smaller. In the case of special thick
brine, molded fitting covers shall be used o*n standard screwed fittings
5 in. and smaller, ammonia and extra hea^^ screwed fittings 4^ in.
and smaller, and all flanged fittings 4 in. and smaller. For ice water
thickness molded fitting covers shall be used on standard and extra
heavy screwed fittings 6 in. and smaller, standard flanged fittings
4 in. and smaller.
Molded fitting covers shall be applied with waterproof cement on
all joints and wired in place with copper-clad steel wire, using not less
than four wires on screwed fittings and six wires in flanged fittings
*
The
Cork and
HEAT TRANSFER
194
(Figs.
All spaces
fittings shall
be
filled carefully
Space
filled
Space
filled
Fig. 136.
Fig. 137.
Valve.
be
Space
filled
filled
138.
Insulation-
Flanged EU.
filler
all
so as to leave a
lagging.
molded covers
shall
fittings larger
be covered with
than the
sizes just
Space
Space
filled
Fig. 139.
filled
mentioned
made from
fitting covers
Insulation
Flanged Tee.
Fig. 140.
of
Insulation Flanged EU
Large
Size,
with Cover.
for
cork
all
than
joints
and wired
six wires
lb.
waterproof cement on
195
and Tanks.
thickness of cork lagging that has been found economical for the tem-
peratures noted:
Inches
Below 5 deg. F
5 deg. to 20 deg.
20 deg. to 32 deg.
32 deg. to 55 deg.
55 deg. to 65 deg.
F
F
F
F
4
3
2
1
Band
and
Fig. 141.
The
The
by a
HEAT TRANSFER
196
the flanges. This flange lagging shall project beyond the head of the tank
a distance equal to the thickness of the disk and shall have a bearing on
body lagging
the
Walls.
built of
It is
Fig. 142.
Insulation Vertical
Fig. 143.
Brine Cooler.
Insulation Riveted
Brine Cooler.
space equal to the thickness of the wall insulation plus 1 in., so that the
wall insulation ma\^ be continuous to its connection with the roof insulation, as
shown
in Fig. 145.
Any
The
wall surfaces
filled
>
WALLS
true
The
(if
less
197
than ^
in.
after the
plastered,
Prepare
amount
suitable
of asphalt
Asphalt cement
put
it
first
row
Corkboard
..
to
lit
..,._.
^-...
Asphalt cement
^f^oof sJab
Beam
in asphalt, then
^""--Beam insulation
3'-0'-
The
corkboard must
in place quickly.
of
Ply roofing
Corkboard
cement.
Fig. 144.
Insulation
Wall and Floor.
the floor on a level line,
and should be carried clear
around the room if all four walls are to be insulated. The boards
must be kept in perfect alignment, in order that the joints in the
upper rows may fit close and tight. As each board is put in place care
must be taken to butt it tightly against the adjoining boards. All vertical joints must be broken, or must be staggered, as shown in Fig. 145.
A second course shall be laid as follows: Saw some of the boards
lengthwise down the center, so as to have enough pieces of half the
regular width to make
one row around the
shown
Dip each
as
Cross
Section
Fig. 144.
piece
Elevation
is
that
already laid in
is
and the
place,
edge
Insulation Wall.
then
in
put
it
in
quickly, drawing
wooden
lower
and
asphalt,
place
it
up
the
end that
to abut the board
Mortar finish
Corkboard
Asphalt cement
Corkboard
Asphalt cement
Asphalt paint
Fig. 145.
in
first
erection
of
the second
HEAT TRANSFER
198
Care must
layer of corkboard, using sheets of full length and width.
be taken to keep the first row in perfect alignment so that the upper
rows
may
be close and tight, as the efficiency of the insulation depends upon getting tight joints. At
the floor and roof and in the corners
of the
layers of cork-
first
course, but
Two
nails or
146. InsulationJoint at
and Ceiling.
Fig.
be
filled
filler.
must
first
be erect-
filler
-3"x6"Stud
|-
seam
Seam
filler
-Cork plug
be wide enough
roof
rarily secured
as
shown
to the wall,
is
put up.
in.,
Fig. 147.
Insulation Backstay.
must be erected on
4-ft.
centers horizon-
tally
and
8-ft centers
vertically to a
ROOF
packed with seam
filler
3X6
is
erected.
the insulation, as
against
tight
199
5 Ply roofing
Roof insulation
Roof sheathing
ted for a
distance
of 3
line
thickness
insulation used on
The
the walls.
Prop for
layer
first
is
Corkboard
Asphalt cement
Corkboard
Waterproof cement
to
beam with
cement
layer
Asphalt finish
Steel
first
Nailing strip
Joist
out
ft.
The buckdrawn up
Fig. 148.
beam
sets, as
Asphalt finish
cleaned.
Corkboard
Asphalt cement
loose
Corkboard
Asphalt cement
Asphalt paint
Steel
Fig. 149.
coating of
against
amount
of asphalt
proximately
whitewash,
etc.,
carefully.
beam
the
surface
is
not
In
if
reasonably
surface
on the basis
must be removed
with a Hght
All
mortar,
Prepare a suitable
-Asphalt paint
-Asphalt cement
of ap-
-Corkboard
two
"Asphalt cement
and one-quarter
pounds for each
-Corkboard
-Asphalt finish
corkboard
that
has
been
not
scored.
finish
Corkboard
Asphalt cement
Corkboard
Asphalt cement
Pour out
cement
Concrete
Asphalt cement
Fig. 150.
asphalt
along a few
inches
in
the
HEAT TRANSFER
200
^Plaster finish
Sub frame
Sill for
Wood
Floor
Concrete
Sill
Vertical Section
High
Sill
FLOOR
Vertical Section
201
HEAT TRANSFER
202
jesp
am
U!
-mP!MfuEn;es3||g--^
sienba 3Due)S!p
3u|sop
joj
siiji
'
uieo
jeap
u|
JOOQ
Sujuado ||BM
asphalt.
Take
and to
--H
seal
these
to
follow.
in
Break the
203
joints
used in wall construction, but be sure that the short joints of the
second course do not come over the short joints of the first course.
Especial care must be taken to insure that the joint between the roof and
the wall insulation
is
perfectly tight
The corkboard
and
shall
38'-0"
154.
On
this surface
a 4-in.
Tables 50 and 51 give dimensions and shipping weights for corkThe design and construction of cold storage doors are shown in
Figs. 151, 153 and 154, and a typical cold storage window by Fig. 152.
board.
Bunker room construction, showing the opening for the warm and the
cold air, and the insulation required are shown in Figs. 155 and 156.
The Economic Thickness of Insulation. It has been the custom of
1 in.
of
mean temperature
204
HEAT TRANSFER
2
1
t
o
205
Xi
a
o
HEAT TRANSFER
206
the room where
tion which
it is
depreciating charges
economical to use in order to reduce the cost of refrigerain the case where the charge of $2 or $3 would
be made. The cost of power, of water, and of labor are decided factors
that must be considered if the thickness of insulation is to be chosen
tion
it is
4'-0
Fig. 157.
which
->{<-9-^
The
factors
2.
3.
and
The
The
The
particularly the
4.
The value
room
by the
Let
C =
in item
1,
these losses
Con-
may be expressed
manner:
in.
P. Nicholls,
207
F =
B =
in.
of surface;
ft.
A =
G =
=
R =
delivered;
not included in A;
etc.,
first
cost;
Y =
=
r, R', Y'
ta
the
life
air,
etc., in
G;
=
=
tp =
S =
tm
the
maximum
air, in
deg. F.;
1 cu. ft.
room
u
the coefficient of heat transfer of the wall, per hour, for the
_]_,!,
Ill
,I2
Cl~^
C2'
The
will be:
ta-t
X
^
X
24
365
XF XA
288,000
u'^ C
2.
The
^
3.
The
VlOO
100
1 in.
thick
^F
^ ^
u^ C
288,000
\100
100
Y'
HEAT TRANSFER
208
The
4.
12
As a
B =
where
by the formula
\-
is
square foot;
and
Also,
B'
is
is
if
room
cold
hyG,
then
XP
12,000
kx
(t-
tpY
where
A;
Z =
Then
if
ta-t
(C
365FA
100
^F
100
u^ C
^x
Ut
12,000
x^
12,000
fc
u^ C
For a minimum, dZ/dx
to zero and solving for
0, so,
of the
-^ R-\-
manner
The
with a
Let
wall
^-in.
may
7
/?
Jl
\100
differentiating
^
,
^^
finish
=
=
=
i_\
100
and putting
may
^j
Y'J-
this equal
XC--u
8.3*S
of x
mortar
7'
x,
B'll
As an example
by
XP w
- g
on the cork.
6 per cent;
6 per cent;
3 per cent;
may
in.
be cal-
of brick
=
=
Y
y=
R'
=
=
C
k
fsTerage
i
^max
(t-Q
F
A
S
Imax
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
209
2 per cent;
15 years;
8 years;
1.5 B.t.ii. per hour;
50 dcg. F.
deg. F.;
95 deg. F;
10 deg. F.;
1.0;
$2.00;
ft.;
95 deg. F.;
installed,
all accessories.
072_+jL065x\
B
G =
288,000
24
XP
it
tj)
Placing these values in the equation the value of x becomes 7.0 in.
*S the value of x is changed to 11.5 in.
Solving
x,
y////////////^/////////////////////
the curve in
More
impor-
heat
transfer
build-
of
pertaining
to
condensers,
and coolers
of
various
portion
of
piping,
sorts.
correct design
of
the
The
every
Fig. 158.
Hausbrandt's Formula.
refrig-
erating plant depends on the proper use of the various heat transfer
coefficients.
than a guess,
in
HEAT TRANSFER
210
passing through
the surface
is
Q =
given by
Ak(t2
h)
where
A =
k =
Q =
^i) =
(^2
Until recently
it
area of piping
is
l.U
of
American Society
Mechanical Engineers
figured
as
fictitious
value in
The
cases.
is
many
flooded at-
example)
least
each
pipe
liquid
has
with
filled
its
at
with
effective
proportion.
The
double-pipe and the atmospheric condenser with the hot gas entering
at the top will certainly lose in
*
The
feeling prevails
among
effective liquefaction
area as con-
is
greater
from the metal walls of the condenser to the condensate and then to the gas than
from the walls to the saturated refrigerant. In the ammonia condenser the area
exposed to the superheated gas is comparatively small in amount. In the bleeder
tjrpe, for example, this amount is frequently limited to two pipes and only under
The remainder of the
exceptional circumstances does it increase to three pipes.
condenser is in a wet condition with beads of liquid condensate formint; on the upper
The
side and running down the inside or dropping to the bottom of the pipe.
refrigerant is not exposed to a dry surface but one constantly wet 'Rath the liquid.
Except in that condenser design which forces the liquid through the pipes at a high
velocity
thereby continually breaking down the surface film there is no advantage,
and in fact there is a positive disadvantage in permitting the liquid to remain on the
surface of the condenser.
Once condensed the refrigerant should be drained off as
known and
ammonia
211
densation occurs and the liquid condensate flows from pipe to pipe
into the Hquid receiver.
The loss of effective surface (loss in the
sense of decreased heat transfer due to the layer of liquid
ammonia)
might be easily 50 per cent or more of the surface in the lower tubes.
This trouble is even greater in the case of the drip type condenser,
which has a hquid flow in many of the pipes counter to the flow of the
compressed gas discharge from the compressor, and always has most of
the work of the condenser performed in the upper pipe when cold
condensing water is used or in the upper two or three pipes when
large amounts of warm water are used.
Another disturbing factor in condensers is the presence of air. In
Orrok's'' tests on steam condensers it was found that the presence of
air reduced the value of k to about ^ of the value obtained with an airfree surface.^ However, all commercial condensers have air present to
a greater or a lesser degree, although there is more care now (1927) than
Geo. Orrok, Amer. Soc. of Mech. Eng., 1911.
Heat transfer in ordinary cases
Effect of Surface Film on Heat Transfer.
is often confused with the thermal conductivity of the material through which the
heat has to pass. For example it is said in the proceedings of an important associa^
^
The
is
Actually it
This indicates that there is some factor in heat transfer for which one must look
If one considers a plate of copper 1 ft. square and 0.065 in. thick the usual
further.
values for the thermal conductivity of copper would indicate that there should
flow through the plate, per degree F. difference of temperature on the two sides of
If this were an iron plate, about 6500 B.t.u.
the plate per hour, about 40,000 B.t.u.
should pass through under the same conditions. In actual practice the values taken
are usually from 2.50 to 300 B.t.u. though it is possible that the practical value may
go up to as much as 1000 under unusual conditions.
Evidently there is some resistance other than the resistance of the metal itself.
seven times.
The
usual exj^lanation
is
of the metal.
it
know what
and how
it is
possible to predict
their resistance.
Consider a tube with water on the inside and steam on the outside, and also the
is offered to the flow of heat from the tube to the liquid.
It is found
that the greater the velocity of the liquid the thinner the stagnant film and that the
greater the viscosity the thicker the film.
For a film of given thickness the narrower
tubes or denser liquids result in higher rates of heat transfer. These factors can be
resistance that
may
have.
HEAT TRANSFER
212
J3d
bs J3d
-Jij
jad
-n
-g uj
'>|
213
HEAT TRANSFER
214
was found
mean temperature
difference.
water had the effect of making each pipe more effective, and of decreasing
the difference in the amount of Uquefaction between the upper and
lower pipes, thereby making the lower pipes assume some of the load.^
In the double pipe and the shell and tube condenser the velocity of the
condensing water has a great effect on the value of k, but the atmospheric types do not appear to be affected by showering more or less
oil,
milk, etc., the cleanUness of the surface, the velocity of the refrigerant
in
so far as
it
affects
the surface
through which the heat is passing and kind of fluid being cooled are
Frostation varies in amount, the piping
the factors which affect it.
design permits
more or
less surface to
be non-effective and
oils
and dirt
Only
the shell and the tube brine cooler has reasonably standard conditions,
uniform in
is
its
performance.
The engineer
is
k,
Can
ice
making piping:
Old style
Flooded
Ammonia
B.t.u.
feed, non-flooded
15
20 to
80
condensers:
30 to 40
60 to 65
125 to 200
125 to 150
150 to 300
150 to 250
Submerged
Flooded
Shell and tube
Double pipe
Baudalot
12 to
atmospheric
tj^pe:
75
60
10
60
gO
Mflk coolers
Cream
coolers
Oil coolers
Water
coolers
^^^^^^^^^
Brine coolers:
90 to 100
The
150 to 300
was one
ft.
long.
.E
CONDENSER SURFACES
Cooling
215
coils:
Water
and
cooler, shell
2J
to
1^ to
15 to 25
coil
shell
and
coil
45
accumulator.
Air dehydrator:
Shell
and
5.0
o rv
3.0
1st coil
coil (brine in coil)
,
I.
^j
2d
.,
coil
Double pipe
6 to
Superheat remover,
The
and tube
shell
15 to
7
25
by an amount
varying from 1| to 2^ times the vakies for unagitated air whereas frost
decreases the value of k. One inch of frost is considered to decrease the
value of k 25 per cent.
Condenser Surfaces.
size of
The
condensers are as follows, using the value of 260 B.t.u. per ton per
12 to
As an example
will
method used
of the
sq. ft.;
in dealing
be solved:
Problem.
The
125 deg. F.
Water enters
and
discharge
ammonia
gas
is
cooled to
at 70
is
is
lb.
per
The temperature of discharge from the compressor is 234 deg. F. and the amount
removed from the ammonia, per pound, is 725 655 = 70 B.t.u.
The number of pounds of ammonia passing through the superheat remover is
of heat
200
The heat
290,500
of water heated
is
150
160
60
removed = 70
4150
613.6
4150.
150.9
3631
lb.
per hour.
290,500 B.t.u.
iO
mean temperature
84 55
- = 68.5 deg. F.
difference as
log,
Then 290,500 =
A X
20
The amount
68.5
A =
290,500
'
1370
212
sq. ft.
ft.
HEAT TRANSFER
216
Difference.
is
is
constant and the hotter varying (the brine cooler) or the hotter and the
0.4
0.5
4f =VaIue of
0.6
tm where
0.7
to
Fig. 163.
cooler both varying either with parallel or with counter flow of the
For the
may
two
be derived as follows:
Referring to Fig. 158, the heat absorbed from a small area dS per
unit time is,
fluids.
first
dQ = CMdd
where
C =
specific
weight of the
dd
fluid flowing;
THE MEAN TEMPERATURE DIFFERENCE
The
dS
in the
same time
217
is
dQ = dkdS = cMdd
therefore,
do
log.^
Values for this expression are shown in the curve in Fig. 163.
T-
dS
Integrating
log.
Therefore
AQ
kS "
dg
db
^^"^
,
ea
Condenser Tests. Figs. 160, 161 and 162 are taken from Bulletin No. 171 of
Engineering Experiment Station of the University of Illinois by Kratz,
Macintire and Gould.
the
HEAT TRANSFER
218
TABLE
49
Inches
Transmission in
B.t.u. per Linear
per
2
24
Hour
0.141
0.147
0.156
0.161
0.165
0.185
0.202
Pipe
Size,
Inches
Transmission in
Linear
Foot per Degree
B.t.u. per
of Difference
In Temperature
per Hour
0.217
0,228
0.259
0.247
0,281
0,293
0,354
Pipe
Size,
Inches
Transmission in
B.t.u. per Linear
Temperature
per
9
10
12
14
16
Hour
0,364
0,377
0,417
0,478
0.515
0.575
50
219
220
HEAT TRANSFER
TABLE
SiZKS OP
52
Size
Number
CHAPTER
VII
REFRIGERANTS
In Gottsche's Die Kalte-Maschinen (1915) there are 27 German firms
ammonia compressors, 29 of carbon dioxide and 17 of
listed as builders of
In Great Britain
due
possibly to law
water the carbonic compreshas been much more popular than that using ammonia up to recent
Ijut also to
sor
Apparently in
little.
system
all
is
ammonia
ammonia has
to use the
nearly the entire tonnage except for certain localities and kinds of work
where the carbonic system has the preference and for small compressors
where sulphur dioxide or some of the special refrigerants are coming
into use. Viewed impartially, sulphur dioxide^ has no present excuse
for being used, for the charge of the refrigerant and all oil entering the
system has to be anhydrous or the acid formed with the water will start
corrosion.
bad shape
in a short time.
The only
capacities
up
to 10 tons of refrigeration
is
is
The matter
of detection of leaks
is
supplied,
This factor
is
initial
of particular
moment
which, like methyl chloride, do not react chemically with any convenient "indicator" as
The
dioxide do.
number, as follows:
and commodities;
it
it
According to
May,
W.
S.
Douglas, of
SO2
in
221
1800
1700
1600
1500
1400
1300
1200
1100
1000
950
900
850
800
750
700
,A
675
^
<
650
.E
d-
600
625
575
:::
550
tu
525
?500
P-l
Diagram
Pressure
Thermal Potential
0=U + Apv.)
for
Carbon Dioxide
from:- Experiments
^450
^ 425
^400
a:
380
360
350
340
320
300
290
280
270
260
250
240
230
220
210
200
40
FioT
164.
P-I Diagram
130
'60
50
Thermal Potential
140
in B.t.u.
for
Carbon
Dio.-dde.
To face faac
iili.
CARBON DIOXIDE
high suction pressures
300
to 450
lb.
per sq.
223
in.
TABLE
54
Temperature,
REFRIGERANTS
224
may
may
send
the
over 200
pressure
(r)
is
lb.
high
from 550 to 590 B.t.u. at usual evaporating temperatures, but the gas is
extremely noxious to people and has a bad effect on commodities if
heavy leaks occur. As leaks are harder to prevent and are more expensive
than they would be for steam under similar pressures, the result is a
special form of flanged joint (see Chapter IV). Tests'^ seem to indicate
that ammonia is an explosive for certain confined mixtures with air
from 13.1 to 26.8 per cent by volume, and some very destructive
ammonia explosions have occurred from this cause. Ammonia is found
to be corrosive to copper and copper compositions if water is present,
and therefore steel and iron are used exclusively in the circuit, and the
valves and gages are especially constructed with this point in view.
Great care is taken against accidents and the possible loss of life. Where
liquid gage glasses are used, special automatic shut-off valves are
employed to safeguard against the effect of the glass breaking, and
remote control stop valves are frequently used in the larger plants to
close the mains near the compressor should a cylinder head or other
trouble occur to the compressor.
of ammonia has been a subject of interest for
Lowenstein gives as the result of much testing that no decomposition occurs if the ammonia is pure, even with pressures of 300 lb.
for a few days at a time. If water dropped on the piston rod this would
The decomposition
years.
work
good mineral
If
air.
is
in part
oil is
used,
it is
it is
the
the air as
it
Sulphur Dioxide.
ammonia but
is
in small amounts.
It is
heat of vaporization
(r)
life
is
for the
and there
is
same operating
no danger
in small
water
of explosion
amounts
is
is
present, even
in the air.
lb.
The
and the
not a combustible
conditions.
It is
from leaks or
in the
if
ammonia
much
steel
and
event of accidents
TABLE
55
225
226
REFRIGERANTS
TABLE 55 Continued
TABLE 55 Continued
227
228
REFRIGERANTS
TABLE 55Continued
TABLE
55a
229
230
REFRIGERANTS
TABLE
55a
Continued
231
232
REFRIGERANTS
TABLE
55a
Continued
TABLE
556
233
234
REFRIGERANTS
TABLE 55b Continued
Temperature,
ETHYL CHLORIDE
TABLE
Temperature,
55bCo)Uinued
235
236,
REFRIGERANTS
TABLE
56
Temperature,
TABLE 56 Continued
Temperature,
Degrees
F.
237
238
REFRIGERANTS
TABLE
56a
Pressure,
Degrees
239
240
REFRIGERANTS
TABLE
Temperature,
Degrees
5QbConlmued
To
TABLE
57
241
REFRIGERANTS
242
.-a
2.0
rtcu
(a
p,
SPh
1-1
-^
ri
icu
TTTTTTTTTTTTTTTi
_r
ft
iOO'COiOOiOOiCO0<-i"0'-iCOT-lcO'-iI^OC5-<'MOO'*iiOcOt^rt<c3:0^iMCCTl<
'*C<5'-'005^CO>0'l<C0^035X5iO'<tCO'-i001Xr^'0-*CO'M005h-CO'0'*iMi-i
243
lOcoot^xcnojO'
lOo^^o^coo^^^offllO-|^3L.'3t^02'^*oxo--^l^^fC*LC!O^^QCO'-l^^lco"*LotocDtO'X^otOl^^
ot^Tt<^xioiMt^Tj(ot^-*Offlc-)X'0'-<i:^coooc^iXTtioo!NX0'Ht^coc:;iO'-<t^MO;ocoa3cc
OXt^O-frOC^JOOlXOiO-^WrtC-. Xt^C'>*<CO^OXt>.0'1<CO'^005:^COTt<CO(N003t^OiOrtirO
i-ia:t-~Xt^l^Ci35-HTt<f^(>4:0'-HX"-iXtOOOt^C^-l<c001COO'-iX'OCO(MO:C<l->!tiXr005t^iOCOiOO
XCD^ClO^<tCOCSX^'*lO;cOX'OXlOCOt^^^^005l-lC<500COXlOM003^D02-HlOOCO<tC^1C<OlN^5
2E9'5'J^^Q'%3'^^^<^'*^^0'^'*''Cxo<N'*<)XO(NTt<ccxoiN'*coxoe^Tt<coxo
REFRIGERANTS
244
in
many
with
less difficulty
Methyl Chloride.
blance to ethyl chloride, but the unit pressures are greater and the
piston displacement per ton of refrigeration
is less.
It is slightly anaes-
encountered are 95
per sq.
lb.
in.
(Table 58), and the evaporating pressures are greater than one atmosphere if the boiling temperature is higher than 10 deg. F.
commodities.
effects are
only from the absence of oxygen, as would be the case with carbon
dioxide or nitrogen.
v^^ith
effect, as
may
not
show the real effect on a person until some time after the exposure.
Both methyl and ethyl chloride must be anhydrous, or the water content
will freeze at the
Mineral
expansion valve.
chloride, but this
is
oils
dissolve readily in
dioxide.
field
it is
(ice
is
in considerable
numbers.
In either
^ Certain
Physical and Chemical Properties of Methyl Chloride, by H. J.
Macintire, C. S. Marvel and S. F. Ford, Amer. Soc. of Refrigerating Engineers, 1927.
*
240
245
lOO'OO'OO'OOiOO'OOiOO'OO'OOiOO'OOiOOiOOiraOinO'OOiOtDOiOO'OOmOlO
I
M M
^_^
'}*Or^M^C5?0'**'MO00t^'OTt<'M'-HOOC^0000cD:OcO'Oi0O-^T}<-^Tt*'^'^^Tf-^C0Tt^C000M'-'
3>-*COCOMCOMroMMC<3COC<3<XlCOCOCOCOMCOroroOTC<3COrocOMMC<3CCCOC<3C<5MC<;cOC<5WCOCO
so
OOCiOOX00C^C/D00l^t^t^r^t^t^t^t^!^<O^C0C0O^CDC0:DCDOcDc0''CDO^CDC0CD<'OD
ooodoooooodooodooddooodooooooooooooooooooo
s
o 3
t. o
C^)tDO'^t-'^iOO>'MtOO-1<OCC-)cDOOO-lCO-^OiOi-it^Mcn'!^C;C-lMroOOiO^tDC^OOTfCC
CSOaOt^cDO'O^-^COCCCl^Hr-^OOO^^CICCCC-l^-^iCiOOt^t^OOOOOOOOi't-H(M(MCO't-^
OOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOO-H'-Hi-i^'-ir-H.-H.-i.-H
oooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooo
I
0OiOOiOOOOOOOOOOOiOOCOOiOOOOiOO'OOiOiOOCOOiOiCOOOOiOiO
1-Hc^^cO'OoxclO'-HcoTt^l0^^oociOc^cctoco^^o:>Ol^^ro^ooooooc^coOlOcD^"ClO'-<<^^c^lM
a>
>
lOO^O'-':>o^-^^ooooocoooo^*^*^*r^^*t^t^Goccocccoccca3C;GlOiaiCiOOiOOOOO
iOOiOOOOOlOOOiOOO00
OiOtOOOOOOOOOOOOOOiCOOOiOiOOiOiOO
CDt^^'^^c:iO^-HOcD^01-HGOoc^^OcooGO'-Hrf^^occcoo(^^lOcc1-HTt^^0'-^'^t^Oco^*OM^*
I
c>t^co^>ocniOM'Hro-j'Ooot^t^oc<5-^M<i'nin<oot^t^CTiO
sOJOi-iC^MCOTfTfiOttlOOcDO'
OOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOCOOt
^^
ccococ^it^eofM-ico^HoooiCi
005CCC5t^t>-COt-ii003-^OcD'NOt^-^'M005t^COrPCOlM'-('-HOa:oOOOr^t^t^cOOOiCiOTj^'^Tj*
*iN^O100t^(riiOT<-*'*MCOO)(N(N<N<Nr
<oooooooooooooo
ooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooodddbd
oooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooodddd
t^-^c^ot^-<0'-ioo>oooocotoocot^.-iioocO'-ir~mo5t^T)<c^oo50ooooooo50iMiC(M^m
-^
^,
r-,^^^^'^
...
REFRIGERANTS
246
case
medium
is
secondar}', as
Tables
properties of butane
()1
first
and isobutane.
TABLE
60
Maximum
Explosion Limits
with Air Ratio
Ammonia
Pounds per
High
13.1*
26.8
5.7
54
52
102
102
10.7
14.0
98
3.1
4.3
1.4
7.0
8.9
2.4
Gasoline
Illuminating gas.
Methyl chloride.
Propane
Sulphur dioxide
19.6.
of
mum
Pressure
Maxi-
Seconds
0.252
0.027
0.175
0.027
0.018
108
0.049
100
6.0
21.0
15.5
8.4
is
Time
in
Square Inch
Low
1.65
Butano
Carbon dioxide.
Ethane
Ethyl chloride.
Explo-
sion Pressures,
bv Volume
Refrigerants
amount
of power required
and 62 give the thermodynamic
the
is
0.026
0.017
95
81
100
0.099
0.023
104
0.020
86 deg. F.
be noted that
difficulty,
if
all
any,
is
nominal.
6-2 lb.
The
is
result
is
easily obtained.
is
to
remove the
compressor through
W. H.
It will
Carrier,
Table
TABLES AND
S"
ICOOOOOOO
H^
*rt
- 3
^ O
JK m
o o o
o
lO
"O
o o
o d
o o d
>ra
lO
o o
o o d
'.T
o o
oo aj r CO
eu "J
'
^5:
s
'
t^
'
C-t
"5
CO -^
CI CC fO
-"
1/^
,-4
li U5
,-
,-1
U)
(Z/
,-1
c(0
-z.
iz,
o O
lO
"5
O O
c/:i
C-.
i-i
i-<
w ^ o
c-i
"1*
"t'
i-l
"5
fT^
("^
O O O
-
':
(- cv
-"
-< ci
71 CI CI 71
tIOCO<OOCOOOCO
ooci-i<cocootD'0-"<ooo-<-^t>.r-t>.o>oooci(co'iioc-,
^N cj po
Vi <^
^i * _
_ .^ f^ r^ ^^ _
C, O
rt rt
O
c.
CO CO
O O O i.OiOOOOO'0'OiO>-OmOOO''5tr5>00'-'5'00'0
CliOOOOCOOCS-H-t.!, OeOtOCO'-<-1<
^r-<i-l>-lClCICIC0COC0CO^^
B'^
'O lO
r- lO
".O
cr.
i-l
-<
dddddddddd
CI -r -5 r- crI, I, 1- I. I, I,
>o -<
o O
CO CI
Ci
iO lo 'O -r
CI
CO
ift
.-.
r-l
-H
f^j
T-i
r-l
#!
ert
(Ti
f~^
v^
CI CI CI
-<
-
i-o
(af^-i"
/
s^ CO
/v^
CO CO I- *i
CI
CI i
I, OO 00 C-i
oooooooooooooooooooooooooooooo
CO "5
o "O 'O o
-f
CI
to 71 c CO
to
CI o c -f -r CI o to to -f -< ^. I71
o
to o "O o lO 'O
-ff-fcococococi
-f CO CO CO CO CI
cococococoeocococococococococococoeoeoeoeococococococoeococo
(<
'
.S'
.s
oooooooooooooooooooooooooooooo
oooooooo o o o
247
CilARl'S
I, CO CO CO
2-^
--<
1- to "O
->
<
-f
<"
-<
jr.
00 CO CO CO I- i~ r~ I- I- f^ to to
'-'
-i
i.o
'-0
-)<
-)
CO CO CO
N C;
~ '-!"t0C5C00OC0OC00>i0-Hi0C0-'OO<0"-0
O
O
O
O o
rt CO '!5
'^ CI
I CO - 'O I CO
I- CO
C.
CI CI CO
f- C*
CI
to to to
to to r~ t- t- r>. 1^ i J- CO CO CO :> oD- CO
-- CO
-- C".
oi c; 05
CI CI 71 71 71 71 71 71 71 71 71 71 71 71 71 71 71 71 CI CI CI CI 71 71 71 71 71 CO CO
o O
o O
OOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOO
oooooooooooooooooooooooooooooo
****
OiN-OOCOCOtOCOOOC5^0
r^ -, lO CO -
{_;j'.__,-.
'
CO c>
I
~ tc
to CO
CO
"J"
to
o>ooo>ciooo'05>."-<0'Heor.coc5
-r to 05 CI to <o o CO r~ to o to -H to 71 t^
-H.-irtc<e^c4C4eoco'>)<'"o>o<otDi^t
^too-for-toooocooto'Otooto'Ocj 71-j'cotecoofo
71 to O
o *c to
OicO-l-tCt^Ci<co
OlOO>AO'aOiAO>AOiOO>00''3
iOOU30*rtO000000*COO(00*-0
0*00*OOtftOirtO
--NNCOCOTi^iOiO(0t~t>.00OOC10iOO
CICIC0eO^
REFRIGERANTS
248
^^^^^^^^^
IIII+
lO 0 0 lO 0
'l^
-^
-t^
-^
-t^
-^ '^ '^ -^
Tt*
-^ lO 0
i-O
lO lO 0 lO lO CO CO
^O
CD t^ t^ t^
oooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooo
OiOOiOOiO^CD'-it^(MOO-*0>''2i-ihc<50>CD(NOOO:'OC^100>OC10t~'*i-ia5cO
O-H.-iOOO'H^OlOlMM'^'^'OcDCOr-t^COOOOO'H'-iOCOCO'f'OCOCOt^
1i^'-i.-Hr-i.-iT-cr-i.-i-H
OOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOO
oooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooo
I
lOOOO'OiOiOOO'O'O'OOO'OiOO'OiOO'OOOiOO'OOO'OiOOOOi
;k
U5O000O>0i0O0O0OO00OOOOOO0O0iCOOC>0>0O0iC
CDt^00050<>)C<3Tt<COt^050(N"^iOt>.0'HC<3iOl^0505'HM'0000 0)-:J<t^OlMiO
iOiOcOOcDCDCOCOCOCDCDt*t^t^t^t^t^OOCiOOOCOOOOOC50C50iOOOO'-H^HT-i
i-li-lr-lT-(i-(i-l,-l.-li-(i-(i-(>-li-li-lr-lr-lr-l.-li-(i-li-(i-lr-li-lrti-li-IC^l!N(N(NlNlNC^
0J(MIMC-)C0C0C0-1<'*'1<i0
pq
10CDCOC0t^t^C00005OO^IMMC0
000O00O0O00000000O0000000000'-i'-i-(.-H.-<.-i
Pi
o
B5
Ph
iOOTC7:Cn'-lTt<t^t-lcO<NOOiO(NC2r-'*C<l'-IO>t-CDlOiO-^COC-4^003020000t~t^
OO>00t~t^c0'OiC'^T(lC0C0C<5<N(NiMlN<Ni
oooooo
So:
00>0i0>0i0-0
i-i(NCO"^COt^050'-icC'^CDOOO'-i(N'^Ot^C5^i:OCCOcOOOCO"'t^a:(NTt^t^
cDCCcOCDCDCOcOt^t^t^t^t^t^t^OOOOOOOOOOCC050>05 00>000000-Hi-i^
N
MM
oooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooo
oooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooooo
C-)
o
0)
CI O) Ol
C^l
tN
(>)
(N IM C^ IM
C-4
C-1
(M
(N (N C^
C-l
<N (N (N
C^l
iM
C-)
C^I
CO CO TO CO CO
CC
C2H2C12
63
Condensing and
249
REFRIGERANTS
250
is
not
known
method
of securing high
vacuum
one.
Chapter
Lubrication.
many
I).
Lubrication
is
one of the
at the lowest
251
is
Tables and Charts. Figures 164 to 168, inclusive, are P-I diagrams
carbon dioxide, ammonia, ethyl chloride and methyl chloride,
respectively. These diagrams (see Chapter I) represent the action of the
entire refrigerating cycle and they present an easy and accurate method
for the solution of problems in refrigeration. Tables 59, 61, 62 and 64
were compiled by the Linde Air Products Company.^ Table 56 and
Fig. 166 are from D. L. Fiske, Refrigerating Engineering, Dec, 1924.
for
The
Standards.
Amer. Soc.
W.
'
CHAPTER
VIII
refrigeration
may
and
is cooled by
commodity by means of pipe
coils or by sprays. The small job generally uses the direct method (called
direct expansion), while for larger work whether the direct or the indirect
(the brine system) shall be used depends on a number of factors, so that
indirectly
to
have an extremely
is
it is
necessary
tight system.
usually of
little
may
commodities from the released ammonia. To keep the pipe line tight
means special fittings and very careful pipe work, with either the tinned
and soldered or the lithage and glycerine thread joint.
On
The
the other hand, the brine refrigerating piping need not be special.
static pressure
of brine,
lb. in
excess of the
fittings
can be the usual kind for 125 lb. pressure. If the brine system is a
closed one with a balance tank (Fig. 169), the pumping cost need be
only that which
head.
There
is
is
some kind
required, however,
coil,
circulating
its
it
pump
heat capacity
As the brine
is
used
is
pump must
be
and
ammonia
due to a broken
or other refrigerant.
252
size,
a heavy
ADVANTAGES OF BRINE
lost.
is
With
brine
it is
loss small.
253
if
difficulty in
the piping
keeping the
The
refrigerating
as refrigeration
is
desired.
sudden demand,
as, for
steel, in
the pas-
comes
in
Overflow pipe
Balancing tank
Pipe space
Collecting pipe from risers
Fig. 169.
Floor line
vp
Main return to brine
tank in basement
b}^
in
The
special
advantage here
lower temperatures
as to
make
in
is
in the
washing of the
air,
and
for the
It has been
found also that a quicker and more satisfactory cooling can be obtained
1
254
at times
by the use
with the
air.
faction.
There are some industries which cannot permit the use of ammonia
Carbon dioxide usually is innocuous, but carbon
In England and in
dioxide is not in frequent use in the United States.
Northern Europe the condensing water is usuall}^ quite cool and the
result is that carbon dioxide can he used with satisfaction, and is used
for about 50 per cent of the time, whereas in India and other tropical
countries with water temperatures in the neighborhood of 100 deg. F.
may
it
may
careless
some
in
This
is
it is
ammonia
static pressure
is
is strictly
an important one.
will pass to
usually
is
a minimum.
correct.
loss to
when
required, although
is
relatively short,
is
its
line,
own
which
Usually
it is
* With brine sprays, especially if the temperature is low, foaming may result, in
which case the surface tension of the brine needs to be increased. This can be done
by the addition
BRINE COOLING
255
Gas outlet;
End Elevation
with Head
of Cooler
'-"'^''^ '"'^t
Removed Showing
Tubes
Fig. 170.
from
is
is
As a
leaks.
used.
it is
simple,
The
construction
Fig.
is
ft.
1^ of
in.,
and the
usually |
in.
The tubes
The diameter
trouble
tube sheet
little
shell,
is
from
while the
256
No. 12 gage charcoal iron, and are expanded into the tube
design may permit a single pass of the brine, as is the case of
the ice-making installations, where the cooler is submerged in the brine
tank, or there may be eight or more passes by the use of baffles in the
heads. As a rule the number of passes should be kept down to six, for
one of the advantages of the use of the brine cooler is in the high value
of the coefficient of heat transfer which is due in part to the rapid flow
If the number of passes becomes too
of the brine through the tubes.
great, the resistance to the brine flow may become excessive and costly.
Examples are known where the pressure difi'erence between the entrance
and the exit has been as much as 75 lb. per sq. in.
Shell and tube coolers are liked because the ammonia part may be
made very self-contained. With the possible exception of the condensers
(which may be on the roof), the whole system may be placed in the
and are
sheet.
of
The
"'^^
ij'steel elh
^Gasoutlet|/V''f'
6"Nipple 'rCIxe Nipple
l|"x6"Nipplev
i5-'^^|"Pipe tap
H Mach.
bolts
^
I4
Gauge
column
lixif'i"
Fig.
^if'SteeleN
'^T^
Cooler.
compressor room under the eye of the engineer. The ammonia charge
not so great and the pressure drop from the evaporator surfaces can
is
be
made almost
(per cooler),
inappreciable.
and the
liquid
is
liquid trap can be placed in the suction line about six feet
and
this liquid
may
ammonia
full.
above the
fine,
The advantages
cooler are as follows:
The ammonia in
and tube
the free passage out as does the vertical one, and the hquid priming
is
caught by the tubes which are staggered to some extent. The headroom required is not so great, although more space is required on the
floor, but there is greater ease in any repair work that is necessary.
These coolers should have connections at the top and the bottom for the
gage
inlet,
glass,
brine cooler has the disadvantage of danger due to the freezing of the
CORROSION OF BRINE
brine,
257
of the tubes.
the density.
pump may
will
Even under
cause trouble,
if
and that a
advised
It is
much
lower
the
ammonia
boiling temperature
is
such as
The
design of the brine pipe system (Figs. 174, 175, 176, and 177) is
not very well standardized.
The essential feature is to reduce the
pumping
cost to a
of a piping
arrangement so
I2 Suction to machine
2"^Bnne
Exp.
Length of 2"pipe 17 -6
Length of 3" pipe
6'-
2"
18'.
Fig.
Stamped
steel
stands
2'^
The
static pressure
the
pump
Considerable
of
Brine.
attention
258
may
Pressure gauge
Brine strainer
Fig. 174.
\^^Aa^^^A^^^^AJA
CORROSION OF BRINE
259
rooms
wann
employ
carcasses
chill
brine practically
salt
with
its
salt brine.
Morgan
"The
all
and the
other apparatus in the vicinity, especially with regard to the generation of electrical current. With
regard to the refrigerating apparatus, several factors must be considered, i.e., first, the nature of
the metals used with consideration of their ability alone to resist corrosion, and their tendency in
combination to set up galvanic action and induce corrosion; second, the design of the apparatus
and the general workmanship in assembling the varied elements which go to form the finished
plant.
practice
and
an
is
worthy
if
we place two
of
electric current
current passing from the iron to the brass through the brine solution.
electrically dissimilar
at once set
The action
up
such
of this
a
current
such that the iron gradually passes into solution and subsequently is oxidized to form the familiar
The solution of the iron in such a case may take years. On the other hand, it
may take a much shorter time, for the rapidity with which such a reaction takes place varies directly
with the magnitude of the current set up. This is equally true of the combination of any electrically dissimilar metals, only varying with the relative degree of dissimilarity in the metals used,
and for this reason it is perfectly obvious that but one metal should be used as far aa possible in
is
refrigerating plants.
" Not only should but one metal be used aa far as possible but that metal should be of the greatest
much
same manner
mechanically combined.
This
is
the
which
is
260
for acidity,
process of corrosion.
lime (CaO) or caustic soda, or the use of a bag of lime suspended in the
is
apparatus as far as practicable should be provided with suitable vents so that any trapped air
can be withdrawn from time to time. If an air pocket does exist for some time, corrosion soon
makes itself evident, and if allowed to go on will eventually cause failure at the point.
"We may now consider the brine solution to be used. Since the brine is made up by dissolving certain chlorides in water, it is very evident that the nature of the water is sure to affect
the resulting brine solution. Water containing acid of any description should never be used, since
the resulting brine will also be acid. An acid brine is far more corrosive than an alkaline or a neutral
of
brine.
".^8 a matter of fact all brine solutions should be tested from time to time for acidity, and if
found to be acid should be neutralized at once with some alkali such as lime or caustic soda.
Sufficient alkali should be added to make the brine distinctly alkaline towards a suitable indicator.
The best indicator for such purpose is phenol-phthalein. This is made up by dissolving phenolphthalein in alcohol about one-half ounce in two quarts and adding to the solution two quarts
Another good indicator which may be used is methyl-orange, which turns
of distilled water.
yellow on adding brine if the brine is alkaline and red if the brine is acid. When making up the
brine it is well to avoid saturating the brine with air, for brine saturated with air is far more
corrosive than brine carrying only a minimum amount of air in solution. Brine should never be
agitated with an air-blast, nor should it be allowed to fall through the air into tanks as is often
the case with return brine. Return brine is often very nearly saturated with air in just this manner.
As for the strength of the brine and the temperature it is certain that the greater the concentration
and the lower the temperature the less likely is the brine to assist corrosion.
"The selection of chloride to use in making up the brine solution is no longer a serious problem
since practice and experimentation have proved the truth of the assertion that the most economical
and the least corrosive chloride is that calcium chloride which contains as small an amount of
magnesium chloride and of sodium chloride as possible, and the least practicable amount of water,
"There is no longer any doubt that magnesium chloride and sodium chloride in calcium chloride
brine materially increase the corrosiveness of the resulting brine, compared with a brine containing
practically no chloride other than calcium chloride. This is especially true if the brine containing
chloride becomes acid through the unstable nature of magnesium chloride.
have been asked whether ammonia present in brine would increase the corrosiveness of the
Experience of long duration, in which the ammonia contr^nt of the calcium chloride brine
brine.
in question was maintained at a constant value, shows that ammonia tends to rctar.l rather than
to hasten it, when present in sufficient amount.
" In addition to the eiTect of galvanic action caused by different materials in the system corrosion
may be greatly hastened by the action of stray electric currents which find a way into the refrigerating apparatus from which they pass to some neighboring metallic circuit or directly to the ground.
If the refrigerating apparatus, in whole or in part, is positive in electrical potential towards the
ground we may be sure that some stray electric current is finding its way into the apparatus, and
that corrosion is being hastened in proportion to the magnitude of the stray current. It is said
that a difference of potential of 1 / 1000 volts is all that is required to start corrosion two miles
from the dynamo. It is a wise precaution, therefore, to see that direct current apparatus of all
sorts is properly insulated so that it will not be a continual menace to the refrigerating engineer
and his plant."
magnesium
"
CORROSION OF BRINE
261
Brine feed to
count
magnesium
which
ide,
to
system
is
nature
stable
he says,
Brine return
O^ressure Gauge
11
open system
of
chlor-
tends
Valves
cannot
Check valve-
made
alkaline.
Emerson
Poste"^
result
Brine
D. P. Brine coolers
says,
of
his
experiments,
P.
as
pump
Motor
Thermometer
Valves
own
"esFig. 176.
um
Warm
brine inlet
chloride
made but
to
air.
it
is
when
alkaline
first
With
comes a
this acidity
marked
increase
action.
increased
in
the corrosive
and
formation
the
ammonium
emmonia
chloride
corrosive
of
in the case of
Contact of unlike
leaks.
The
tendencies.
of brine decreases
these electric
corrosive action
with
increasing
Chlorides
brine density.
are
on
with magnesium
first-class
chloride,
materials
are
though
available
free
XcOj inlet
Fig.
177.Shell and
for Carbon
Emerson
January, 1923.
P.
Poste,
Milk
who
Dealer,
262
10
|8
h
"o
ra
>
fic
2
1
CORROSION OF BRINE
263
Should, however,
brine
is
it is
not so corrosive.
1.20
264
amounts
265
and add 70
lb.
The
in.
may
chloride systems at the rate of 60 lb. of zinc dust per 1000 cu.
brine.
17
little
ft.
of the
lb. of
test
the silicate.
Friction to
Flow
of Brine.
The
The
A. H. Gibson,
is
little
attention.
The Resistance
to the
Flow
of Brine Solutions
through Pipes,
of a non-compressible fluid
oc pv'^(p{
lib.
per sq.
of surface,
ft.
\pvd^
where
p
fM
*(."^)
cc pv^l
lb.
for
water flowing
per sq.
ft.
in pipes
of surface.
\pvd/
Footnote continued on page 266.
266
is
by
independent of
267
calcium brine.
J in. to 1
Portland.
in.
Use a mixture
of
3,
in rich
and if
mortar rubbed
of other construction
in
H. C. Boyden, Journal A.
S.
with a brick.
268
269
270
Ofa
to -0
3 o
E
^ I
St3
C
<V
* 2 S
iz;
*t3
0
S
^
W^
to
O
O H
G.
r^
ego
2
P3
^
^
Hz
Is
<:
>j
w
CO
5
<
n1
-o
tH
271
68
Capacities of Double-Pipe Brine Coolers, 1;-In. and 2-In. Pipe, 10 Ft. and
20 Ft. Long Over All, Specifications, Weights
Effective
Pipes
Effective
Surface
High
Surface
When
Submerged
Height over
Top
Pipe,
Inches
Height
over All,
Inches
Full
Extra
Weight
Heavy
Pipe,
Pipe,
Weight
Weight
Add
for
Soldering
Joints,
Dollars
272
TABLE
Capacities of Multipass Shell and
70
Weights
SpECiFirjATioNs,
273
274
c^t^^ico
^xcioo ^x<N!00
oiMOOico
ioxc<i3o> wicaj<M<o
^mccc^^ foosoioj
II
II
iCX
<McO
x^tox^
II
Mill
t^i^oioua ^cocctN^H
Mill
II
-ioo^o
oo-n'oxc^
II
'rtx^'^x
Tfr-orji
TtTfAOC^M-'OOClXOOr-cOcOO'*<')<CO<N(N "-"OOC^iOXCSOCnC^
Mill Mill
(N'OX'-'tH
DXXO^
t-OCOt^O
iC^CC<N
,H^Wr-t^
l-Hr-Ht-H
O'NCO'^iO
II II
II II
C^C^CO-'t'iO
CC<iCi(NiO
-^'OOlOJ OOI>OCOCO
II
II
II II
II II
II
Mill
(^^
00:0X00 f^COCD'O'^eOO-HOOOOh-O'OTjlec'O'^C^OOO'N"*
OCCCDO<N lOX^-^CO CJC^iCX^ ^t--0^r- CCC-O^t"DX'-i'rt^I>.
u5-<f
-^CCci C^
MM!
OOSJ
II
II
00r-t^<OO
"^t'-^fO'MiN
Mill Mill
^COCNiO
C:C^4cDOM
II
^XCO**^
Ci<)'^--00 CDCOOt^-""!* C^XOC^O> CDCCOOh- lOTfM*iOr-OCliOX'-H CCCOOIC^-^ t^OCOiCX -'CO'X'O'H ^r-OtMOO iC-NOlCDCC
^OLT^fOCO C^^OOOi 00XI>CDiO lOrt^CCfNfN -tOO(N"3 CiCTiiCC:^^
MM
II
Mill
II
II
II II
II
II
Mill
r-iXCDCO
II II
'^
II
OXC<NO> COPOOOiiO
CDXO'^'O
i-H<N-^CO COOJ'-'CC'*
NOXXX
XC^COO
OiXt^COlCTj<Tt*(N i-iOOfMcOOiCOlCOr^
r-i'-i^MC^
P S
II
H-
C^
:
^00(Nh-
^-i^iMlNCO
+
t^XXXt^
OWO ooooo
-ooo
bote*
X-^'W
Tj'|--.-.ir3X
^'N-^O
"(t^OcDCOOi iO-^X'<f
X^OX^
Xt-CO
<D^"*'<**CO
OOiXt^eO
II
U3TtC0C^'-l
II
OOSOOt^O lO-^CONfH
I
11
-''*t*r*occ
II II
ecc^-^
o c:xxt>.
Oi-fC^CO'^ lO(OI>Oi
275
276
CHAPTER IX
THE WATER SUPPLY
Heat removed by the Condenser.
hold refrigerating machine, which
is
majority of cases,
all
refrigerating
The quantity
removed
theoretically
is
of heat requiring to be
done on the refrigerant by the compressor, provided an expansion cylinder instead of the pressure reducing valve
statement
used.
is
In practice this
is
more work
means
done on the gas than would be necessary with noncondensing cylinder walls.
As dry compression is used in America
almost entirely, the temperature of discharge from the compressor is
that
is
heat
If
is lost
the condenser
is
on the
roof,
whereas self-contained units and particularly the shell and tube design
condenser with a short nm to the compressor will lose very little
of
The
result
is
that the
The amount
II),
the condenser
the compressor. It
as
much
as
it is
is
of refrigeration
and
may either
it is
ob-
use a large
The
Electrically
Engineers.
277
278
0)
bO
t-
C O 3
""
<*CO(M(MC<|i-H^Hi-It-H
lOoooQiMcqi-ii-ii-H,-!
Ills
Pm
locccooac^'-tii.-(i-H
S.2
o +^
bD
Ph
C O 3
''^
'^ coc^ (M c^
'
^ fOC^ CM c^
&H
OCO COIM (M
bC
01
'
PhtJ
Tf<
bC
^H
fl
O 3
CO !M (M !M
13
a-2^a
* CO(N C^ IM
'
Ph
Li
a)
be
rt
p
tH
O)
<* COCM CM CM
'
-^3
bJD " T3
C O 3
a-2^a
fe
QJ
t-,
a>
hcf^
^-g
-
bCg
?3
c2
3j
fl
^ 3
oj o
a^
O
O
O TJ ii
CL,
oTg
3 bclJH
.
CMcorcTf<'*ioiocDor^ooQoa300'-HCMCMcoTHipip
-^"^
CO
iHT-Hl4rHl-l-H.-lr-lrH-H--Hi-lT-HCMCMCMCMCMCMCMCMCM
suoneg
279
280
rise of
number
The
154.5
lb.
and 19.6
lb.
heat to be removed
gas
non-condensible
80 deg.
is
present)
that
corresponding to 70
amount
of water
room.
Temperature
of
is
The
lb.
most satisfactory
Figure 183, taken
from the United States Geological Survey statistics, ^ shows the approximate temperature of the water from non-thermal wells at a depth of
30 to 60 feet, and Fig. 184 gives the corresponding temperature of the
In this bulletin it is stated: "The temperature of the
surface water.
water in the ground at any place is in general about the same as the
mean annual temperature of the air. Near the surface the temperature
of the water follows the temperature changes of the air; at greater
*
Collins.
281
c
o
mate temperature
and
of the air.
Very naturally^
282
Types
of
Wells.
The
is
reciprocating
pump
is
and
There
is
283
is
Water
Fig.
600
gal.
must be sunk.
600
60
500
.c400
300
200
100
185 The
if
Pohl^ Air
level
Lift.
more
wells
284
on
a^
cDco<ocoxt^xt-xxx^-t*r*t*t^
xooioicioo
XXXXXXXXXXXXX
(OOt^<>XXXI>-XXt>.Xr-Xr^t>-
XOOiOiOiOO
^ X O X* C
-00>00'^t~-b-03^C5XCCeDCDtDCh-
285
Tt* Ol Tt<
t-- CD Ci t^
(M
CO CO CO CO CO CO CO CO 0 -* lO 0 't C lO
CO CO CO T(* CC CC CC CQ CO CO CO tP CO CO CQ CO CO
USb-iOCOCDCSNCOr^CDr-OiXiO OCOOC^C^COtOiCOlCOOOOCO'-'COCOO^'-iOC^CO'-H
^^^^^^^^^^^^Tt4'<t<
r* M' -^t*
X ic Tf ic o; *
C-- '-'
.Tr-*C0'*-^'*'*'-^C0'<4-*-^Tt*'^-*-^lO^-*'JTj*'<*f^
X CO (N CO <N o
<NCD-^-^cOO-^
rir^'-icoxior^x
^^^^^<t<^C0iOcOCD:DiOr^(O
b-X'*'NC^COX-^X^-HO--^-*'^'MC^co--"0't<-*r;000'X!XOXX^-(NNiOXX
lOiOiOcDcOcO'OCO'OCO^DCDCO'^iCiCiOcDcD'OO'O'^iCCOCOiOiOiOCOcOt-t^XWXX
oict^xiO'^c^'^coO'*'tt*a:cnx xc0'-'^cs'Mt^c^xxt^C;xt0O'*r^^ica:O'^
Oco(NXeo^OTJ*coo**o^xcllO-Hco^ooocoot^o^ooco-^x^0'<t<^oox^^-
^^-^^-o^-t^^^^^^-|>^t^coocC);c>co^~t>-^-^^-!CcD^*^*l^^-cD^*xxxc:xc;Oi
OiU3COOl'-^^Olt^XOiOOOt^'^iCiCiO-^COiOCOcOcOXCOCO'*iOcOC^M*COOOOCOCl
t* t^
X t^ X X t^ t^ r* t* X X X t^ ^ coio o X r^ r- r^ r^ t^
1:^
t^ t^ 1-*
t-*
J>
X X Ci ci ci oj Oi Oi
iC u^ Ci
fM X ^ X ^ CO Ci ^ Ci O -*
Oi r* c^ o
C: O to CO X CO ^ XI ^ ~j M CO
X 1>
o*
M
t^ X i> X t^ X X t^ X r- 11> CD X t^ X t^ i> [^ r^ 1^ t^ t^ t^ t- 1^
t^ CO t^
r
X t^ xt^ X
cri
''f
1~-
t>-
t-*
O X O O t^ * O ^ Ol O) to Ci ^ X "^ CO CD lO -^ t^ ^ C^ C^ 0 * r- -^ M CO CD * -^ CD CO CO '^ Oi
Xl>xx^*xxx^-xXI^x^cocococox^x^-^'^*t^^-^^x^-^^xxc:a:xalOlOs
'Tl
OOO^CDXCDOXCOXXiOTfcD
t^h-r^t..t--t'.|>-Xt>.t>-I^t--h-t>.cO
OO
cDt^t-t^t^r-CDCOt-t--t^t-t-l>t^cDt^cDt>CDCO
^ O O CO
O X t^ C^ Oi X ^ O CO 1^
CO
XX
c; O lO Oi '^ t^ ^ l> ^ CD ^
1^ t^ r* X X OS X Oi Oi oi
t^ r^ t^ o o CD CO X
t* t^ CO b- 1> r*
t^ (N
CD Oi
a: O;
r^ r* (^ b- 1^ r* r* t^ t^ t^
<-!
'-'
t>-
I"-
.5
OS
aCLi
XiMOXX'*'*ClClCXai-^'NCDX t^^C0I^XC^COiOt^t^O1C0O'NX'<^XI^^'NCD
oi
(OcOCCOCOCDCOCOCDCOCDCOCDCDOiO lOCDCDCDCOCO'OcO'OiOCOCOtOCOCDCOOOCOCO'O
AE*
COCC^OcO^'*b-t^COXXTt<-ft*XiN^O CDcOCOCO'^cOXCl-'tiOX^^IiOXOiOiOt^
OcOcOcOOcD'OiCCDcD'Ol^t^t^cOt^t^t^t^
CDCDCOCDCDCDCDcDcDcOcOcOcOcO'^iOiOiO
XX
^-C^C;XCDOt^r*'^XX^Tt<iCC0
5 18
iCCD'O'^iCiCiOiOiOiOiOiO'O^CQ'^COCO
C5Ci-<-HG0CDiOMtOai
COCO^'^^'^'^'O^CO
r*
CO
CO
-xxoc^icit^ot^
COCO^^CO^^CO
NCOlMNC^COCOTt-COtN
iC00^OTt<'^Tt<iOiOTPiOcO0
OX
O Oi O CS CO * ^ X
Tt<
Is-P a
-r^oco
03 =3
OOOCICDXCDXXCD'NO'^CX
^CC'^COCD'^CO
^
-^ CO CO CO CO c
CD
o X
^
fir-^os
t^
Ol bo
f4iO'*-<*co'*^co-rjH-<**rococoio-*j*co
cD^b-'O'NX-'t'*-*^fJ^COCO'^COCOT"
CDCDCDCD
.^(J^rt^CO'^COCOO^'^'OtOiOiOTP
-!*<
t^ ^N
X -^ 0 Ol CO O CO O -M 0 M CO lO
-I.
COCOlN'MCO'MC^COCOCOCOC-^'r^^JCOC^COCO'MCO'^COCOC^COCO:^
.a
CO CO CO CO CO CO CO CO
CO
CDO^COC0COCO
COCOCOCOCOCOCO
^^ ^
* tJ* lO
tJ*
-^
-co CO CO CO CO CO CO CO
.
cO'+C^'^'^'^-^'-'XCO'^^'OiOcD
eOCOCOCOCOCOCOCO'^COi-OiO'*'^"*
-CO'*<'^CDt>-COCD'^COX'N'fdO;0>OC^OC^00
C^COCSCO'MCO'M' C0'-'CO(NCOCO0--CO'MCOC^CO
;*S22S22?5
COCOCOCOCOCOCO
0)
53
a.";
2^3
S^ "^M
~o
--E
t-
e i g gfc
53
co-^coTt*-^-^-^c<jc;c^>oootDO
COCOCOCOCOCOCO^Tf Tt*Tt*iOiO'^0
22Sl;:22S^^SS~S3S2SS9rtc^coc:o-'(Ncor-xoio-r^cococoxoio-<cfleo
0 fes;; Pis
Is
^^^
=5 =^s2 g
286
gal.
for the
lift
lift
compressed
air is
supplied
in
bubbles.
As the
finely
divided
column
means
lessening the
of
the
-Diffusion ring
discharge
impeller
discharge
However,
pipe.
size of
Pump
bowl
it
Diffusion ring
air
to
through
Impeller
the
discharge
small
overall air
lift
holes.
pipe
The
efficiency is as
Suction pipe
The diameter
*Blaisdell, Power,
Nov.
23, 1920.'
287
of
to
TABLE
Air-lift Tests,
77a
Power-house Well
Number
Test
Date
of test
2/11/12
Length
from discharge,
feet
level, feet
level, feet
Running pressure
Head on
air
lift,
Submergence,
Submergence,
Submergence,
Submergence,
at nozzle,
pounds
feet
running, feet
running, ratio, per cent
starting, feet
water.
669.0
155.0
177.0
213.0
153.0
11.9
141.1
343.0
326.0
49.0
492.0
73.5
5.4
60.0
166.0
1146.0
2031.0
383.0
2/18/12
669.0
155.0
177.0
213.0
153.0
10.0
143.0
338.0
331.0
50.0
492.0
73.5
5.3
60.0
161.0
1132.0
1847.0
380.0
669.0
155.0
177.0
213.0
153.0
10.2
141.8
342.0
327.0
49.0
492.0
73.5
5.3
59.0
165 0.
1129.0
1880.0
360.0
gal.
5.58
6.9
5.15
7.0
4.90
7.0
5.31
6.8
power
Pounds of dry steam per 1000 gal. of water
Cubic feet of free air per pound of dry steam
Water horsepower
Least
air
Efficiency of air
Efficiency of
Efficiency of air
lift
system, over
all,
per cent.
3.0
84.9
21.0
99.0
315.0
31.4
82.4
25.8
2.9
78.3
20.8
96.5
286,0
33.7
81.7
27.6
3.4
80.9
20.9
93.5
267.0
35.0
82.0
28.7
3.1
80.7
20.5
97.2
289.0
33.6
80.4
27.0
288
The
Centrifugal
Pump.
The
centrifugal
pump
187)
(Fig.
is
the
latest
and
development
The pump
slime.
summary
in deep-well
of tests
is
performed at Armour
TABLE
Date
&
Co.
Drawdown
Gallons per minute
Total working head
I.hp. (input)
234.0
308.0
54.0
1600.0
330.0
197.5
280.0
338.0
58.0
1470.0
365.0
205.6
280.0
314.5
34.5
1910.0
336.0
834.0
8.1
67.5
7.1
65.9
2 3
24.7
156.6
46.0
it
because of
its
own
as follows:
776
April, 1921
of Test
is
power and
pump has replaced the reciprocating pump to a large extent. The centrifugal pump is compact, small sized for its capacity and needs very little
and it has an efficiency above 70 per cent at its rated
However, it is not a positive acting machine in the sense
of a displacement pump. In its operation water is thrown out by the
action of the revolving impeller as a result of which a particular velocity
is imparted to the water, and the theoretical head becomes
attention,
capacities.
29
where
h
V
=
=
There are two forms of centrifugal pumps, the volute (Fig. 188) type,
which permits the water leaving the impeller to come to partial rest in
the spiral casing without the use of guide vanes, and the turbine type,
289
which has diffuser blades in order to slow up the velocity of the water
without impact or shock. The volute
type is the more common, and is the
better design for variable conditions,
economy
was designed.
are shown
in Figs. 189 and 190, in which are
given the variation of the head pres-
Characteristic
sure with
it
curves
Fig.
188.
Pump.
290
gives the effect of changing the speed, or the diameter of the impeller,
is
From experiment
Variable Speeds
One
200
"7-^50
it
follows that
f-
Impeller Diameter
^"'i^,f'i<'3^v
/?./>..
180
160
140
S 120
100
80
60
40
20
CSI
CD
U^
IT)
<Z3
C3
LT^
CNj
<Z3
LO
C3
Lr>
CSI
CS
LO
>^^
I
Cnj
CD Wi
CD Cn4
CO CO
O
CO
LO
CO
Cr>
Lr>
Fig. 191.
the diameter
change
if
1.
The quantity
Centrifugal Pumps.
of revolutions
pump
(the revolu-
Likewise,
is
if
the speed
is
changed:
1.
2.
3.
At times the engineer can vary the speed and the diameter
impeller so as to get the head and the quantity of liquid
pumped
of the
to suit
to
by the action
remainder
may be
of evaporation of
291
some
cooled.
ing
Ladder
Fig. 192.
and
means
pressure.
of the air
from 5 to 15
lb.
is
292
bulb temperature.
in refrigeration this
Fig.
water required will be 1.0 per cent for every ten degrees cooling of the
water, not allowing for the cooling due to the air.
Construction. -The cooling tower is usually constructed with steel
frames.
The
metal, structural
tower
is
steel,
made
of special anti-corroding
all
The
CONSTRUCTION
spray caused by the wind and return
it
293
is
taken in this respect the loss due to windage becomes excessive. The
tower is placed sufficiently high as to permit the water to flow by
gravity over the condenser if the condenser is of the atmospheric type.
is
that necessary to
lift
Wire
netting
From dfy
main
From pump
or other
water supply
To
circulating
pump
?,y:Float valve for replacmgv^i,^.i\V';L^;=}i^%^ipw
Fig. 194.
tributing troughs.
Types
-T-^;:-"^^---'-"-^-^'^-^^^
Cooling Tower.
of construction are
shown
pump
the circulating
approximate
results of tests
on cooling towers.
In the spray nozzle system the pumping head
is
that necessary to
lift
294
78
Tower
295
the water up to the nozzles plus the head necessary to fonn the spray.
The
is kept as low as
and it should not exceed 10 lb. per sq. in. As the water in
spray form will drift excessively in the wind, louvres are essential.
Even with the use of louvres the loss becomes very great at tim.es.
possible,
Figure 195 gives a typical arrangement of sprays on the roof, from which
the water flows to the condenser.
Ql
The
from the
MaCp{t2
following
air in contact
h),
with water:
296
where
Ma =
=
and h =
Cp
to
The amount
weight of
air, in
pounds;
initial
temperatures of the
air.
water:
Q2
2~
')^P^^^
^1^'
where
M\ =
M2 =
The amount
initial
final
of heat
in the air;
where
P^i
The amount
Myj
Coffey and
Q =
where
water
M^{t2
is:^
h),
Home ^ found an
the wet bulb, which gives a measure of the cooling effect to be found in
cooling towers
E =
et)
0.0116(r
is:
t),
where
E=
T=
t
Et
et
=
=
=
PURCHASED WATER
297
amount
158.0 to 139.2
water
per
lb.
sq. in.
may
In
the water.
140
120
100
60
40
head corresponding
3
depend on the
amount of
pumping
total cost of
all
w = Cooling
Whether
Doubling
to 190
10
lb.,
mercury
and when
298
where
A =
m=
condenser temperature
temperature difference of the condenser water in and out
of the condenser
ta
Et
= Combined
B =
He =
= 200 + 42AWc
Wc = The condenser i.hp. per ton of refrigeration
G = He -^ 8.33d = the condensing water per ton.
In order to find the minimum cost the first derivative
zero,
is
equated to
and therefore
dC
Am
O.OQBHc
dt
Et
8.33^/
ta
total cost of
8.33G(F,
mtg
^ ^
pumped water
Et
is
+ /)
33,000^;^
Where Ep
is
the combined
Fs
is
is
the friction head due to the flow of the water in the pipes.
In order to
in
make
efficiency
pump.
is
adopted by Waterfill,
where
difference
D
'
r - '^
therefore
Et
Comparison
dC
did
Et
of Cooling
due to
'
taEp
^^'^
33,000
HcF,
t^dEp
33,000
3HcKD~
l^aE^
The
33,000
first
cost of the
less
drift will
HAF,-^K{^
'^
299
TABLE
80
Nozzle
Number
60
50
45
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
8
5
4
3
2
A
B
for
Which
Nozzle Is
Threaded,
Inches
30
40
CHAPTER X
ERECTION AND OPERATION
The
refrigerating plant
is
more than
it is
desirable to consider
Foundations.
for
two
vibrations developed.
As considerable care
is
is
in the
if it is soft,
soil,
the
must be widened.
Bolts.
al:2^:5oral:2:4
used, either
clean sand
be removed.
The anchor
up
The pouring
KIND OF JOINT
stop at a point from
to
in.
301
When
the foundation
is sufficiently hard
be moved into place and leveled.
Wedges made of wood or iron should be placed near the anchor bolts,
and the machine should be leveled in both directions. In a horizontal
may
can be
relied
by
by
tightness.
Kind
of Joint.
302
The
solder joint
the metal
molten
is
is
bright.
solder,
made
made by cleaning
The pipe and the
of half-and-half of tin
Methods Used
in
and
lead,
Supporting Coils
Vertical Coils
8'-
8'
->
Q=\
Lag screws
into the
struts of
the box
\
When
2-
2'
or less
When
2x4s can be
bolted on
as shown below.
When
'
long as the
on the
Dimensions
only
straps
coil
n loToilo
coils.
is
iron bars as
IjnIloljnffO
jo lio
PIPING DETAILS
The
lithage joint
is
made up by applying a
and the
303
thin layer of the mixture
fittings.
made
in small
it
304
that
may
it
may also
be
filled
Low
points,
where liquid
Purge-fe
"'^""^l"
Connections for
Large Condensers
Flanged angle valve
Ail
screwed
fittings
Connections for
Smaller Condensers
Fig. 199.
connection
regenerator.
is
PIPING DETAILS
occur at any time.
305
Supply
Sewer "
^_J'<^m
Sewer
Supply
Fig. 200.
Brine tank
Fig. 201.
Ammonia Coils
in
Brine Tank.
gaskets are put in place, as a check. The difficulty with lead gaskets
is that lead has no elasticity and that it will not give good service
306
when exposed to the hot discharge gases from the compressor. For
the ammonia discharge hnes it is better to make use of a high-grade
asbestos sheet gasket material which takes without trouble the highest
Gas
inlet
inlet
elasticity.
Gas
outlet
In making
STARTING UP
may become
307
times used in
drip tank.
The
the compressor.
The
other refrigerant.
as possible,
it will
and
it
should be of the
function well. At
ammonia
or
first
size
the need
little
air
As soon
is
cleaned.
as the
erected, water
The compressor
pressure.
pumping
is
<
used for
pump up
taken not to
any time
Make
Fig.
too rapidly at
is
in
is
in
is
used in the
cylinders.
Cylinder
is
Oil.
It is
ice
machine
oil
used for the cylinder and the crankcase in the enclosed type of com-
cases
As a
the
compressor.
Starting Up.
All refrigerating machines are designed so that the
compressor may be used to pump out the system normally under condenser pressure and to discharge this gas into the low pressure side.
308
Each
and the discharge line close
up to the cylinder. There is required also an opening (a valve or a
plug) to the atmosphere on the suction and the discharge side of the
that the required starting torque shall be as small as possible.
cylinder also has a stop valve for the suction
cylinder.
low
Discharge
Discharge
Suction
stop valve A.
By-pass
valve c.c
Suction stop
valve. B.
\J)i\
gauge
Oil drain
filling
Fig. 204.
By-Pass Valves
and
conn.-^(^
Compressor.
pressure side only, have the cross connections open with the discharge
open to the atmosphere and the expansion valves closed.
With water passing through the jackets operate the compressor
slowly (or intermittently) and raise the pressure on the system to about
150 lb., unless large leaks evidenced by the noise of escaping air appear
is
reached.
In a
new
plant the
first
things to look
When
make a
all
duration test
309
by a lowering
Any drop
accounted
due to leaks and should
of pressure not
is
Coils.
The piping
is
pipes
any
of
loose
which
line.
may
be in the
For
this pur-
any
which
out
dirt
grit
has
cyl-
chine)
and
205.
ma-
ports.
It is
Pump
as good a
vacuum
as possible, as
it is easier,
and cheaper, to free the pipe system of air at this point than after
charging.
310
rise to
about 50
lb.
LiquidTo
system\
Fig. 206.
Charging Connections.
part only and, storing the ammonia in the other part of the system, to
break into the line that needs repairing. The larger plants have separate
pump-out compressors and pump-out lines to the different coils or sets
of coils, so that repairs can be
need to use the compressor, and the cross connection by-pass valves,
to pump out from one part and to store the ammonia in the other
part of the system during which operation the plant must be out of
commission.
To Charge
ammonia should go
If
in operation.
The
drum should
act for
the evaporator
is
first
indication of the
311
The Amount
for charging
of
Ammonia Charge.
It is difficult to
different cases.
One
rule,^'
ammonia used
in
in practice, is as
follows:
atmospheric condenser, 12 pipes high, 20 ft. long, 140 lb. per stand.
standard atmospheric condenser, 24 pipes high, 20 ft. long, 60 lb. per stand.
Ij by 2-in. double pipe condenser, 8 pipes high, 20 ft. long, 20 lb. per stand.
Ij by 2-in. double pipe condenser, 10 pipes high, 20 ft. long, 25 lb. per stand.
2-in. flooded
2-in.
by
Ij
2-in.
for pipes
ft.
submerged
in brine or
water
greater than that required for direct expansion in cold storage rooms.
At 22|
lb.
per sq.
Ij-in. pipe
in.
submerged, as
in
is
recommended:
per
1^-in. pipe
^ lb. of
2-in.
lb. of
lb. of
is
The
100 deg. F. of superheat, or more, and from the brine cooler or the
direct expansion piping to the compressor
it is
is
all
less,
condenser
is
The
vertical
itself
shell
and tube
must be
It
seal
'
J.
312
Usually the operator can also detect by the whistUng flow through the
is passing through, but the better method is
by means of
The operator then has
times the amount of liquid seal on
Other
when operated
at 25 or 30
lb.
amount
side
The
and
suction
pressure affects the specific volume of the gas so that the higher the
pressure the
more weight
is
Also, in operating, the nearer the temperature of the brine or the air in
ammonia
amount
extreme conditions
it will
is
of flood
it is
In
possible to carry.
ammonia
is
is
line.
The
is
If
the load
is
this valve, as the suction pressure will raise or lower until the
weight
its
own
5,
is
This
is
The low
pressure piping
is
laid
out
was planned. Incidentally, it is generall}" understood that a liberal amount of evaporating surface, and a relatively
high suction pressure will give best economy to the plant. With a certain
amount of piping (if it is clean and operated in the correct manner), if
conditions for which
it
is
and increases
the horse power per ton of refrigeration and therefore such action should
be considered the
last resort.
OPERATIOxN:
313
condenser where
to
pump
it will
will
remain.
If care is
taken not
If care is
taken not to
pump
vacuum
on any part of the plant there will be no occasion for the amount of air
Ammonia or
or other non-condensible gases to increase in amount.
other refrigerants do not disintegrate under usual operating conditions,
although some cheap lubricating
discharge gases
The
is
do so
oils will
if
excessive.
is
then
Ptotal pressure
The
Plot the
is
air
/^^ot the
ammonia
mixture.
If air is
still
is
is
in operation.
The
densest air
is
where the condensing water is coldest as a rule, but the non-condensible gases are naturally swept along in the direction of the flow of the
ammonia. Purging,
* Even sharp freezers requiring 20 deg. F. can secure this temperature without
having a vacuum on the low pressure side of the compressor. The reason for air
leakage into the compressor when operating under a vacuum is that the stuffing
box on the rod will usually leak air into the cylinder. Pumping a vacuum on shutting
down is very bad practice. Modem machines, even enclosed compressors, can take
150 lb. on the low pressure side without difficulty. It is advised on shutting down
that the evaporator coils be pumped down to not lower than 5 lb. gage.
< See Chapter III.
314
ammonia
is
coils,
ammonia out
made up
All that
required
is
of the
either as a shell
and
mixture by
coil or as
is
pressure of the
mixture
will
ammonia
density of the
ammonia
This method
will
at that temperature.
present
there
devices to assist
purge
are
patented
several
in
line
is
100
lb.
The Regenerator.
It
undoubtedly
is
for
some time a
certain
The
ally.
all
Purge Drum
and the
of
liquid
in
separate
the liquid
and water,
some extent) a solution of
ammonia and oil. The result is that
liquid receiver
Fig. 207.
oil
of the oil
amount
and
but forms
licjuid
Connections.
(to
oil will
oil,
other sources.
oil
regenerator (Fig. 208) which operates on the principle of boiling out the
ammonia
at suction pressure.
regenerator
warm and
Warm
connections are
water
made
is
all
low
The action of bleeding off should be done at freammonia returning at suction pressure and some-
315
consists of water,
oil,
Defrosting the
frost
Low
will give
Pressure Piping.
on
on the piping
Frost will
decrease the heat transfer until finally the evaporator surfaces will
fail
to give results.
Absorbent
Head
Water
Drain
valve
Fig.
shut
off
brushed
inlet
Water outlet
208.The Regenerator,
snow may be
be accomplished
In the last mentioned,
by the use
chipped
the ice
of hot gases
off
or defrosting
may
method in some plants, the frosted pipes act as a conand by the use of the by-pass valves, or by the use of a special
the preferred
denser,
The
is
larger plants
pumped
make use
which can be used at other times for the purpose of pumping out.
Another advantage of the defrosting pipe line is that the warming of the
lines
piping permits the congealed oily mixture of mill scale, oxide, sand,
oil
etc.,
316
piping.
If
expansion piping,
it is
it
is
erection.
If
there
is
Hardening room
rack
Fig. 209.
Defrosting Piping.
may
result
example of an improvement
may
result in a
An
in operation is as follows
317
Small
Liquid from
coils, to
made when
store
all
of the
The
needed.
ammonia charge
in
amm. cond
Fig. 210.
do
this,
and withdrawal
becomes necessary.
In
gas after
pressure
by
be used.
pointing
designed
for,
usually 50 or 100
In withdrawing the
lb.
the system
it is
not neces-
Usually
it
is
proceed as follows:
318
and the expansion valve, with the valve on the shipping drum
Open the connections to the shipping drum, and cool
Note when the drum is full by weighthe drum with cold water or ice.
Particular care must be taken not to fill the drum
ing frequently.
beyond the safe amount indicated by the shipping tag.
Causes of Excess Pressure. Excess pressure in the condenser may
receiver
pointing down.
be caused by:
a.
Too
amount
decomposed lubricating
oil
c.
and
Poor heat transfer, due to dirt and scale from the cooling water,
and dirt on the ammonia side of the condenser.
Condensers partly filled with liquid ammonia due to an over
oil
d.
One
or
to broken or faulty
Causes
of
Loss of Capacity.
caused by:
1.
scale
2.
on the
Leaky
and
oil
inside.
number
of causes.
full
opening.
4.
Too
may
are nominal.
as follows:
1.
2.
Turn the water on the condenser and the compressor water jackets.
Start the brine pump, and (if a centrifugal pump) make sure that
the brine
is
flowing.
amount
cylinder a small
4.
319
of cylinder oil
ammonia
by hand.
See that the suction and the discharge valves on the machine are
and open the by-pass from the discharge to the suction.
closed,
5.
6.
Open
valve.
7.
Adjust
expansion
the
valve
so
as
proper
get
to
operating
conditions.
Ammonia
losses^
are
greatest
It is
through the
next to impos-
sible to
211)
(Fig.
located
centrally
at
all
times
in
Arctic lubricator.
the stroke.
Carelessness
wear
in the
crosshead shoe
sible
for
in taking
is
respon-
Also,
middle
the
in
the
at
should
in.
probably
It
is
be
will
wise
than
stroke
of
64
and
require turning down.
keep
to
attention,
stems
valve
all
and occasionally
for such leaks,
by white
tight-
The sulphur
en on the packing.
being
more
excess
in
given
well lubricated,
is
the
of
Wear
ends.
up
stick
a leak
fumes,
as
Fig.
already stated.
The
or the brine
(ice)
made by
of distilled water
red precipitate
*
is
c.c.
c.c.
of distilled water.
and 35 grams
Add
of potassium
Average ammonia
losses,
New
ice,
is
320
potassium hydrate (KOH) in 200 c.c. of water and then dihite with
water until 1000 c.c. is obtained. Add this to the HgCl2 sohition until
When
('d 'H
"I
dUJOO
UBLJ}
first
ammonia
it is
by adding
321
necessary to precipitate
to the
JOJO|/\|
(Na2C03)
Nessler's solution.
presence of
ammonia
322
Heretofore it has
been considered satisfactory to rely on the numerous leaks in the piping
to remove the air but it is quite evident that this custom will need to
be abandoned and that provision will have to be made to pump out the
air, at least partially, as in the case of systems with nominal condenser
after the operation of charging has been completed.
pressures.
Charging.
volume
ammonia
plant by a cal-
on the
high pressure and the low pressure sides and the amount of the liquid
which should be in the condenser and the liquid lines. By the selection
volume of the vapor for the pressures expected to be
found in the pipes a fair estimate may be made of the required charge.
The usual manner, however, has been the rather crude method of
estimating the charge by the discharge pressure, which should approximate saturation for the temperature of the outgoing condenser water.
If the condenser pressure is considerably lower than this amount then
No gage glass
the charge is insufficient and more gas must be added.
is used on the liquid receiver of the carbonic plant, as such a glass
would need to withstand pressures in excess of 1000 lb. per sq. in. nor
of the specific
has
that with
ammonia
is
decreased in proportion.
it is
CHARGING
323
The
if
desired.
boils in the
ammonia and
evaporating
The only
is
coils in
is the very
temperature (88.0 deg. F.) above which the gas cannot be
liquefied even with excessive pressures.
However this fact does not
low
disconcerting factor
critical
mean
Great care must be exercised to operate with the proper sized openIf this pressure reducing valve is open too
much the liquid seal is broken and partly cooled gas is permitted to pass
ing of the expansion valve.
The
an increased
evaporating
coils will
gas from the evaporating coils in the usual manner but at or near the
end
324
When
under the higher pressure flows in, the low pressure suction valve
closes and the gas in the cylinder increases in pressure at constant
volume. During the compression stroke the total weight of the gas in
the cylinder is compressed, and this is considerably more than would
have been the case if the low pressure suction gas only had been com-
The manner
pressed.
of operation
is
as follows:
The advantage
of the dual
may
system
is
very evident.
The
refrigerant
Referring
to Chapter 3 it
between the temperature,
15).
To
ammonia
amount
of
ammonia
until the
A
made
calculation similar
for the absorption
325
cooler.
pump
weak
weak aqua regulator is operating.
Note the absorber pressure
c. Start the brine pump, if there is one.
and consider whether it is the amount desired and to be expected with
h.
aqua
is
Turn the steam on the generator steam coils and adjust the presby the design of the generator and the concentration
carried.
Note the amount of liquid in the liquid receiver and estimate
whether the amount is sufficient.
e. Open and adjust the expansion valve.
In shutting down use the reverse order of operations.
Some disintegration occurs in the generator and inert gases are
d.
sure required
formed.
To
using 0.2
lb.
per 100
lb.
of
TABLE
81
326
82
CHAPTER XI
THE TESTING OF REFRIGERATING PLANTS
The
the plant.
it
may
may
be for the
becomes one of securing values for heat transfer and of measuring the
of water used and the refrigerant liquefied.
At the present
time (1927) little has been done on air-cooled condensers or on the
automotive fan type of air-cooled radiators using water on the condenser.
The low-pressure side embraces methods of increasing heat transfer.
This investigation requires a knowledge of the amount of the refrigerant
boiled from the coils per unit of time and a complete knowledge of the
temperatures involved. In most of the investigations on refrigerating
amount
328
made, and
methods
temperatures will
of securing
value only
error
is
atures.
of
ice
under
standard
temperature
atmospheric
pressure)
deg. F.
^Thermometer
CPlug
x|" Reducing bushing
intermediate readings.
Soft rubber.
This joint to be
made
Thermometer
Stuffing
range required in the test. In refrigeration the temperatures usually desired are
Box.
between 20 and
+40
deg.
If the
this
may
be calculated as
follows:
Correction
0.000085
X N(T -
t),
where
=
T =
A'^
the
number
of degrees
is
212 deg.
F.,
= 0.000085 X
112
(212
75)
of the air
above the
1.3 deg. F.
is
best located as
shown
in Fig. 214,
329
is
Ihe
desired.
metalhc thermometer well (Fig. 215), made of iron for ammonia and
brass for other fluids, is a good arrangement for temperatures that do
not require great accurac3^
When
thermom-
eter in a
eliminate
excessive
as to
radiation
may
be,
to
under
two
more degrees.
The Electrical Resistance Thermometer. Resistance thermomcertain conditions, as great as
or
on the principle of
should
affect the
resistance
of
the wire.
In the
temperatures).
tion a fine wire
is
construc-
wound on a
Fig. 215.
Thermometer Well
in
a Tee.
Bureau
'
P. Nichols,
of
-\-
ro.
of Standards, Circulars
The
330
potentials, e
Ohm's
and
e' ,
law,
e'
= -R.
1-2
e
Adjustable resist.
^W.
I-^amp.
^oprov^de^^p.
-OBa.+
Battery
Ba.O-
Br.Q
5
Ohms
resistance
^Zero ^6Ga.(J)
-gE.M.F.(S
resistance!
Il_|,_J
'.(J)-'
*To check
Galvanometer
Resistance to/
reading of battery
Fig. 216.
protect galvanometer
Type k Potentiometer.
bedded
in
material
over a
ture
area.
For
this
when
it
is
de-
an average tempera-
sired to obtain
considerable
length
or
be
To
be able to
translate
resistance
ment maker,
is
in
resistance
and temperature
covered in B. of Std.,
S.
147 and
S.
coefficient
331
of
Commercial
148.
soft wire
was
7^1
Roll
a(ti
to)].
where Ri and Rq are the resistances at ti and to, and a is a constant for
The symbol a represents the coefficient for con^ostant mass; that is, we are dealing with a fixed weight of wire and not
a fixed length, as the length will change with the temperature. Values
a definite value of
^0
0.00238
0.00223
0.00219
0.00214
32 deg. F.
59 deg. F.
68 deg. F.
77 deg. F.
The value
be expressed
as
0.00255
0.0000053/.
_ Ri Ro _
~ 0.00223/^0
temperatures.
is
in resistance will
332
TABLE
83
Size of
F.
all
THERMOCOUPLES
container with a mixture of ice and water.
The
333
wires must be insulated
is
to divide
it
can be
by the number
If
number
of
TABLE
Copper
E.m.f.
Constantan
84
Thermocouple
in Ice
E.m.f.
334
The
effect
itself,
and
Such stray
sizes, especially
or cold media.
" 2. Galvanic effects at
may
reduce
will
this.
" 4.
all
if
they are mixed up with high voltage used for heating or other test purIf the atmospheric conditions are good and the humidity low,
poses.
there usually should not be any trouble; but in hot, humid weather,
or
damp working
and
it is
trouble, especially
it
if
the rubber
in paraffin or cut
it
is
poor,
back for
The
eter
is
in Fig. 216.
Type
Leeds and Northrup potentiomThis inchides the potentiometer, lamp and
shown
circuit.
PRESSURE
scale, selector switch,
standard
cell
335
is
cell,
The manner
of
by getting
such a resistance in the potentiometer line that the battery current will
just neutralize that of the standard cell and the net result will be zero
a certain direction.
electricity flow in
The
The
Glass
tube
recording
a.
b.
c.
of
methods employed:
distinct
The
clockwork.
Pressures.
Pressures
are
given
usually
in
The tube
for
ammonia
Fig.
is
of
special
steel,
219. Thermc
couple Fitting.
pressure
is
and more or
less
semicircular in shape.
by means
As
of Hnks,
is made to turn.
No gage of this sort should
be used without cahbration by means of a suitable dead weight tester.
For accurate work, cahbration should be done before, after and (for long
tests) during the test. The barometer should be recorded at all times
is
336
can be given by means of a U tube containing mercury, oil, water or other liquids. Figure 221 gives a good design
for obtaining differential pressures, such as would be needed in the
differences.
Sometimes
this
Hj H2H3
H, n,
)|
->
I
iLli
Small
copper
li
S. P.
Switch^
ff) I
lea
^-Zy
Ice
box
'<:-5S^
box
D. p.
Switch
(b)
Cold
Hot Junctions
Cold Junctions
Cold
(a)
Fig. 220.
ammonia
Parallel.
superheated
as, for
MEASUREMENT OF QUANTITY
liquid
ammonia through
case
is
Fig. 222.
the
liquid
differential
per sq.
337
"^
in.
measurement
is
High pressure
F^-^
lass t ube
|
if
^H
I-
-I
IL
x-l
Jl
elQJQ
Fig. 221.
the reciprocating
pump
for
Ammonia.
is
measured
The
amount
by means
as well as the
338
Venturi Meter.
^'
where
Vi
C =
^'W^^ ^
^^^^^''
7i
M(2gh)^ theoretically;
Fig. 222.
M=
^1
Vi
Ai =
= CM{2gh)'
practically,
feet.
area entrance section at upstream connection, square
^-m
MEASUREMENT OF QUANTITY
339
where
D2 = the
throat diameter.
,
,u
r
also given as the value 01
.
IS
JD2 X
S2
,h.-h,>
Z2222^^^S^,
Venturi
tube^
Direction
of flow
\
^Throat co nnection
Main connection'^
h=h,*h.
Fig.
where
<S
the speed;
the density;
u = the
h
is
viscosity;
340
also,
= CM(2yh)'
T"
where
A =
C =
discharge coefficient
R =
-f^,
where Di
0.60 to 0.62;
diameter of pipe, Do
diameter of
orifice.
1$
o o
O 3
^^^^^^^\\\^v^^^ ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^'^^^^^'^^^^^^^^'.^^^v
\V'.V'v'>^^'>>,^'^^
^^
^^^<^^^^,^.^^^^'s^^^^^^--^^^^^^^^^^
Section
:^^V'.a^^^v^^^^^^^v^^^^^^^^^^^v^,^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^v.^^^^^^^^^^.^^^^^^^wv^:^
Section 2
Fig.
Section
Orifice.
and
W=
Of
Measurement
of Refrigeration,
all
especially for
MEASUREMENT OF REFRIGERATION
The weighing method
is
341
amount
The apparatus
connected by means of flexible
scales
Flexible pipes
equaHzing must be installed also, and the connection from the condenser should be very liberal in cross-section and should be erected with
for
Control valves
3l
Weighing drum
Weighing drum
I
JE
Fig.
225.The
Flexible Weighing
Drum.
give a quick
full
empty, the standard weight is placed on the platform and the time
noted with a stop watch when the beam makes contact at the top at
which time the standard weight is removed. The time is again noted
when the
scale
beam
342
weight recorded
weight
the
is
is
not the
total
not desired.
for
the liquid
To top
of
condenser
Equalizer
o=
To
liquid receiver
Automatic]
valve
IJO
I
<-s-
Valves and
Liquid
fittings
ammonia
measuring drums
01
C3
<o
HI
Handle for I" valves
so as to promote
quick closing of valves.
ra
preferred
Fig.
tanks
is
In this case,
343
with a gage glass of the best quality glass and with automatic
The
is that a check
For example, operating conditions are
established and maintained for a certain interval of time. After that it
would be expected that the amount of liquid leaving one drum would
reading can be
made
readily.
always equal the amount entering the other. If this is not so then
equilibrium has not been established, and the irregularity should be
As
by readings
Attempts
have been made ^ to demonstrate the value of the Venturi meter for
measuring liquid ammonia. While the Venturi meter and the flat plate
orifice are excellent means of measuring water and brine, yet with liquid
ammonia the case is different, for in this case there is a volatile fluid
tending to form bubbles of gas with a decrease of pressure or an increase
of temperature. For example, if the air temperature is 90 deg. F, and
the condenser pressure is 150 lb. gage (corresponding to a temperature
of saturation of 84.4 deg.), then there will be a tendency to absorb
heat and vaporize.
A drop of pressure will take place in the meter
which will cause trouble also. The method advocated is to precool the
plant to another like an engine indicator or a test wattmeter.
liquid
means
ammonia
before
it
The
by
valves, although
it
in the
cylinder due to inertia of the valve, excess pressure loss in getting the
'
J.
West compressor
is
344
gas out of the cylinder and into the condenser and leaky valves and
piston rings.
In using the steam engine indicator very great care must be exerif the speed is over 100 r.p.m., or inaccurate results will
cised, especially
Inaccurate springs.
b.
c.
mechanism.
d.
The outside spring indicator has the advantage of the inside spring
type because of the lesser temperature variation in the indicator cylinder,
although this is less important in ammonia compression than in steam
engine testing.
hardened and ground, and arranged for lubrication. If the crosshead cannot be reached, an eccentric on the shaft or a crank and connecting rod should be used, designed for the same ratio of crank to connecting rod as in the compressor. The reduced motion can be extended
to a convenient point, where attachments to the indicator can be made,
steel,
by means of steel
all
the time
by means
of a helical spring.
For speeds of 200 r.p.m. and over the steam engine indicator is of
doubtful value. Under such conditions some other form of indicator,
the optical or the Bureau of Standards' diaphragm type, for example,
should be used.
There
(if
If
the compressor
is
if
this
is
and
not
steam-engine
driven, indicator cards of the steam cyhnder, the weight of the steam
and the
initial
test
345
It
does not include ice making and other apparatus emploj'ed in the utilization
In so far as the fundamental operations of all the systems are in
of refrigeration.
rules will be laid down and where the systems differ separate rules
For the test of the driving element in compression systems, the
A.S.M.E. Power Test Codes for Steam Engines, Steam Turbines, Internal-combustion Engines, etc., should be consulted for details not contained in this Code.
common, general
be given.
will
Object
In accordance with the '"Code on General Instructions," the object of the
should be first determined and recorded. If the object relates to the fulfilment
2.
test
of a contract guarantee,
concerning
all
of the test.
Measurements
3.
The
(a)
(6)
(c)
{d)
principal
The
The
The
The
in
test are:
auxiliary apparatus;
(e)
(/)
(g)
(/i)
(i)
(j)
(A;)
in carrying
(a)
Suitable meter for measuring liquid refrigerant on the high- or intermediate-pressure side where it passes to the expansion coils of the
(6)
Platform scales and suitable tanks for measuring water and condensed
steam
(c)
Water meters,
346
(d)
(e)
compressor.
(/)
(g)
{h)
(i)
F.;
for
(/c)
(1)
Planimeter;
indicator;
driven machines.
The
calibration
and accuracy
of the instruments
Code on
and
Instru-
Preparation
5.
carefully studied
physical conditions of
all
and recorded in accordance with Par. 6 of the A.S.M.E. "Test Code for Reciprocating
Steam Engines," and Par. 12 of the A.S.M.H "Test Code for Displacement Compressors and Blowers."
7. All measuring devices should be installed and in the case of the meters for
measuring water or brine a means of calibrating by direct weighing or checking by
calibrated tanks should be provided. The meter for measuring the liquid refrigerant
This
shall be calibrated by means of a closed tank or receiver of known volume.
volume should preferably be determined by weighing the water which fills the tank
or receiver.
may
The thermometer wells should be of steel for ammonia lines, and bronze for
brine lines, and should extend into the pipe a sufficient distance so that the bulb of
8.
the thermometer will extend at least to the center of the pipe. When comparisons
of temperatures are being made it is extremely important that the immersion in the
well should be identical in all cases. These wells should be filled with mercury to
the point indicated on the stem of the thermometer. Insulation on the cold lines
should extend even to the top of the well, and the thermometers pass through corks
well
Electric resistance
347
ammonia absorption
In
Operating Conditions
12.
and should
"Code on General
operation must prevail
Instructions."
Uniformity of conditions and evenness of
throughout the test. It is required under this Code that nothing but liquid shall
enter the expansion valve and nothing but vapor shall enter the refrigerating
machine. In commercial tests the allowable percentage of difference in the heat
balance between the water and the refrigerant must be stated.
Starting
13.
and Stopping
sufficient length of
when
the test should be started and continued as stated in Par. 14 of this Code. It is
essential to the accuracy of the test that all parts of the plant contain the same amount
of heat estimated
To accomplish
Duration
Each run
shall
tU'a
where
'
= approximate
less
than
hours,
to
= 3W6
in
pounds
wb =
total weight of
in the S3^stem.
Records
15.
sufficient,
case
Pars. 24 to 35.
'
348
16.
Each
and end
of cyhnder,
pointed out in
test of the
results should
to conform to the object in view. Unless otherwise indicated the items refer to the
numerical readings which are recorded in the log.
Calculation of Results
18.
Committee
American Society
of
of the Joint
of
(2)
is
288,000 B.t.u.
of refrigeration
is
per minute.
(3)
Note
1.
refrigerating
machine
is
of the absorption
refrigerating system.
Note
2.
Note 3. There shall be 9 deg. F. (5 deg. C.) sub-cooling of the liquid entering the
expansion valve and 9 deg. F. (5 deg. C.) superheating of the vapor entering the
refrigerating machine, the points at which the sub-cooling and the superheating
are determined to be within 10 ft. of the expansion valve and refrigerating machine,
respectively.
*
Note
4.
The
ature of 5 deg. F.
Note
5.
The
is
is
inlet pressure
(
15
deg.
C).
outlet pressure
Note
6.
inlet
ft.
of the refriger-
and outlet
pipes,
respectively.
19.
The
com-
mercial tons of refrigeration as calculated from the weight of liquid refrigerant and
amount of available cooling effect produced in the evaporator. This method shall
be employed in the case of all refrigerants where the physical properties have been
determined and where tables of such properties are recognized as sufficiently
accurate. The tables of thermodynamic properties employed shall be those adopted
and published by The American Society of Refrigerating Engineers.
20. The weight of refrigerant circulated shall be determined by a suitable liquid
meter as prescribed in the A.S.M.E. Code on Instruments and Apparatus. As an
the
hquid refrigerant
of
The amount
inaj-
349
by the
Where
there
Qe
where
Qe
fu
22.
tion
The
Wa(hi
>u)
Wa weight
/.'i
is
=
=
of
is
E.E.
-5^
12,000
23. Indicated
cylinder
is
i.hp.
hor.se
Pm = mean
of the
'
A =
area in square inches of the piston less the area of the piston rod,
if
any;
= number
total horse
power
of the cylinder
end
L =
N
The
effective pressure in
for each
PmLAN
33,000
where
power
Mean
Effective Pressure.
The
is
sum
the
mean
of the horse
power developed
in
found by
dividing the area of the indicator diagram in square inches as determined with a
planimeter by the length of the diagram in inches, and multiplying the quotient by
If a planimeter is not available, the approximate
be determined by finding the average height of the diain inches as obtained by averaging a suitable number of equally spaced
ordinates, at least twenty, measured between the lines of the forward and return
strokes, and then multiplying this average by the scale of the spring.
The length
of the indicator diagram is the measured distance along the atmospheric-pressure
line between ordinates erected perpendicular to it and pa.ssing through the ends of
the indicator diagram.
The theoretical horse power required to compass
25. Theoretical Horse Power.
adiabatically the quantity of vapor shall be found in the case of ammonia or fluids
having standard tables or charts, by referring to the Mollier Chart or the tables
mean
gram
effective pressure
may
_
~
of Refrigerating Engineers.
(hi
hi)
XWgX
33,000
60
778
350
where
=
=
Wa =
hi
hi
the vapor adiabatically at the average rate for a single stage or for any stage of
mutiple-stage compressors
hp
^
where
vi
pi
P2
luk
r /p.;
p\Vi
33,000 (fc
Ij
pressor.
is
found by
by the constant
0.746.
power (Par. 27) is that indicated as the motor terminals plus an equivalent
power required to run the exciter.
gross horse
29.
Volumetric
Efficiericy.
The volumetric
and
efficiency
The capacity
in cubic feet
is
is
the actual
amount
of
vapor
pressure.
power
The
mechanical efficiency
is
the
power
pressor
Compressor Efficiency.
is
The
vapor delivered by the compressor to the horse power developed in the compressor
cylinder, as shown by the indicator cards. The compression efficiency for any par-
OTHER TEST OBSERVATIONS
ticular cylinder of a multi-stage compressor
is
351
compress adiabatically all of the vapor delivered by the compressor through the
observed pressure range for the particular cylinder in question to the horse power
developed in the particular cylinder in question as shown by the indicator cards.
to
The two
The
total heat
Qe
where
Qe
hi
hi
w'a
=
=
=
=
Ifaihz
In this case
hi),
difference
is
manner.
Log.
mean
difference
te
fi
where
te
.
/i
t2
=
=
=
If a complete condenser test is to be made the A.8.M.E. Test Code for Condensing Apparatus and the Code on Instruments and Apparatus should be carefully
studied.
34. Evaporator Performance.
The
Qe
where
Qe =
^6 =
he =
We =
In this case
lOaihi
hi),
35. Determination of
(a)
Brine Coolers.
Brine
cooler performance shall be expressed in terms of heat transfer per square foot of
Log.
mean
difference
mean
=
loge
difference.
352
where
ts
ti
tf,
=
=
=
The performance
apparatus
will
^^p-
The
is
(lb.
(total
head
in ft.)
^^;^oo
power input
shall be
observed for
all
pump-driving
Compression Cycle: Qe
Absorption Cycle: Qe
Qe =
Qw =
where
Qs
Qi
Qi
Qs
=
=
=
Qw =
Qi
Qs',
^.^i
Q2
Qs
Qi,
38. For purposes of illustration the following list of quantities involved in the
computation of the heat balances of compound compression .systems is given:
Heat Absorbed
(o)
(b)
(c)
{d)
(e)
(/)
Heat
Heat
Heat
Heat
Heat
Heat
absorbed
in evaporator;
absorbed
absorbed
in low-pressure suction
main;
compressor;
ig)
(h)
(i)
Heat
(k) Heat
(I)
Heat
(m) Heat
(j)
(p)
(q)
(r)
353
(0
Before concluding
Par. 20 of the
data and results should be reported in accoixlance with the forms prescribed by the
committee.
CHAPTER
XII
PIPING
large
all of it in
amount
of the
equipment
in the compression,
is
piping.
the shell and tube brine cooler and, in the extreme case, a brine spray
Like
all
if brine is used.
other branches of engineering, the piping must be efficient as
it
These considerations
Kind
of Pipe.
ammonia
Full
will
is
at the present time, even for condensers and ice tanks, whereas
carbon dioxide refrigeration uses extra heavy steel pipe, because of the
much heavier unit pressures. Wrought-iron pipe is not so commonly
was some years ago, because it has been found that steel
pipe can be depended on much better than formerly, both as regards
the welded joint and the thickness of the walls.
It is usual to specify
for
pipe
sizes
2
in.
butt-welded
and smaller, but lap-welded pipe (drawn
down from a larger size) for normal diameters larger than 2 in.
Piping at the Compressor.^The headers and connections at the
compressors are usually irregular in design and therefore are frequently
welded, although the cast iron or cast semi-steel bends are used whenever the cost of the casting is less than the welded header. Considerable
used as
it
care should be taken with the piping to eliminate changes in the direction of the gas flow as far as possible, since
it
irregular flow through the cylinder ports (with sharp changes of direc-
tion of flow)
is
much more
hkely
charge port areas sometimes are designed for 10,000 ft. per min. gas
velocity, but if this is so the ports should be straight and when changes
354
Lbs.-Pressure drop
.3
.4
.5
.6
.7
.8
.9
1.0
1.2
1.4
1.6
1.8
2.0
2-5
inches diameter
SIZE OF
355
accomphshed by means
of long
radius bends.
Size of the Discharge Pipe.
much
piping, but
if
to be reduced to a
is
minimum
value the subject of the pressure drop from the cylinder to the condenser
must be gone
into carefully.
It
piston area
stroke
X 2 X
r.p.m.
:
=
if
the compressor
machine.
is
6000 to 7000
double-acting or
is
is
is
if it is
per min.,
really only
maximum
The
built up
ft.
an average gas
velocity,
equal
is
and to a lesser
manner similar to the
The
line.
If
undue
very
losses
be a decreased
volumetric efficiency of the compressor as well as an increased work of
compression.
However, wire-drawing
in
capacity of the compressor rapidly (Fig. 29), increases the horse power
per ton of refrigeration and decreases the volumetric efficiency. The
results are that,
if
ft.
ft.
it
may
be designed for
from
Fig.
ft.
An
may
be as low
Problem. A 2-in. pipe line for a suction pressure of 20 lb. gage is 300 ft. long.
Find the pressure drop if the gas velocity is 5000 ft. per min. Referring to the
figure it will be seen that the drop per 100 ft. is 1.85 lb., and the total drop will be
3
PIPING
356
W.
I.
separator
3\ centers
357
CONDENSER PIPING
UJLUE
3uoi
n- Rl X .,02
PIPING
358
is
is
Fig. 230.
receiver.
\2
o'
,11
couplir
on each header,
as shown in Fig. 228, while others have stop valves on each stand to
The
facihtate repairs on the condenser, as suggested in Fig. 230.
To compressor
Arrangement No
L.C.-
=^ Coils^
1.
2.
Liquid cooler
C. V.-Checl< valve
X - Expansion
S - Suction to math.
Arrangement No
-Liquid
Arrangement No
4.
ammonia
Arrangement No 3
Coils
FiQ. 231.
Coils-
The water
siippl}^
359
also.
The Liquid
Line.
liquid refrigerant
is
The
Some
shown elsewhere.
Vweld
li
M.I Welded
8 <->!<->,
/g
!<-^->,
iM'"-;
lN4f^-14fk4f^443<'k4|'^6jk4f4=-14K'k4f''4<i4|'^-14|'^3
,r~i3'-4'^
I2 Liquid
Header
J
Thr
^2
12
|<_
I" Oil'
li:ii
Ft
-^
-^
Holes
..
1^ X
I2 W.
I.
Separators
-10*-
4-^
1|
-6
15'-=
-6'-l
Fig. 232.^Piping
and Headers
1^
coil
for
Can
Ice Manufacture.
Neither
line is
is
As a
ft.
per
sec.
and long
lines, especially
PIPING
360
minimum
Too
value.
rise is required,
and
velocity head
The Low
vertical
lift.
Pressure Side.
Brine
cooling.
Whenever brine
is
cooled
/%>
-^^
Accumulator-
li^tK-Suction valve
Liquid
I
j'Oil drain
_''>^Gas_he_ader__^_
-4-
'
l.-t
I^M
Liquid header^k.
^Stuffing^ box^
Not less
L^^l"
than-^M
Oil
drain
e^-3-r,M
6- -0" long
IV
j^i"^
Check valve
Fig. 233.
the suction pipe line to the compressor. In can ice making it is somewhat more complicated because of the use of the flooded system when
direct expansion piping is used for the cooHng of brine. Several piping
The
arrangements for the flooded system are shown in Fig. 231.
flooded system embodies a device for precooling the liquid before it
enters the expansion coils, and an accumulator to prevent Uquid returning to the compressor thereby acting somewhat like the steam separator
in
steam engineering.
The
brine
In this case
minimum
itself is
cooled
by expansion
piping, as
shown by
Fig. 232.
what
is
desired
is
"
practicable.
Limits to welding
it is
lie
361
In can
ice
making plants
using shell and tube brine coolers, the piping would be the same as in
the indirect brine system.
&f^3'
li 2f
0'-^ - 4'- 6|"-
>[
3'-0'-^
amount
11'2K--
"J f~3'
O'V - 4'
6i'->t^3' 0->i
-^"j
^~
2tf.7"
Fig.
in
Ante
Room
-LJ
234.PipingThe Sharp
Freezer.
the frostation.
very heavy
(in surface) it is
any case galvanized iron drip pans should be placed under the coils
with a suitable lead-off pipe to take the drips from the pipes should the
PIPING
362
frostation melt
to decide.
The
off.
How much
deciding factor
is
pipe in series
is
an important matter
itself and
j8"[<-20"->j loV-15''>|6i'|<-
Butter Storage
recommended
is,
as a
maximmn,
1100
ft.
of 1-in. pipe,
1300
ft.
of li-in. pipe,
1600
ft.
of U-in. pipe,
1900
ft.
of 2-in. pipe.
loss.
The amount
z
I.
n?nsrtt
(H-J. un
Inset in concrete
See worfcflE
Fjst
J'Chet_/
'
'-*^i
iE^
^->^
lo-CilJl
vita
floor elev.
See *oriiiRg_dfjwing
J|
.f.^.
^toling
V-'k-'"
Laknut-^
^
5;';-'. i"
(lf3v.((ig
'
.";-/q;^Sl
See working
i^wi
174?
SOVl!'
6ne mlerj
LJ
Pumps and
Coolers
Fig. 237.
PipingBrine Details.
To
'^
Galv. iron drip
I'd & M
^2i'D & M
"^r
Drains
pan
in
between
^r^
W^
363
Cross Section
a,
PIPING
364
On
With brine hnes the case is different, as the brine is not subject
bad effects from gas formation in the pipe. The length of pipe
in series for brine varies with the operating conditions from 100 to 400 ft.
The use of " top feed " and " bottom feed " for ammonia has been a
disputed point for years. At present it is conceded by most engineers, if
trouble.
to the
0U..11UII
Yofrmachi'ne
^?S>^Pfesent
"r
--^
8"Suction
0. L. V.
lo
300 Ion
machine
freezing
tank No.
Fig. 239.
DEFROSTING
365
pipe decks, suitable stands from the decks can be used, and in some
special cases the piping
floor.
Examples
may
line
from discharge
Liquid
Fig. 240.
The
ice
designed
piping
NH,
is
it is
and
in bulk.
*
Fig. 241.
It is
Hot gas
from compressor
PipingDefrosting Large
Installations.
expansion job with the expansion valve arranged for bottom feed of the
hquid. The sharp freezer is a term used for a low temperature room.
It also is very heavily piped, ^ and may or may not have the piping
arranged in the form of shelves.
so that the fish
Defrosting.
See
to have shelves
Defrosting
of the
plished in a
1
may
PIPING
^;=*=
DEFROSTING
367
Feed to
coil
No.
ID
From
compressor
discharge line
Suction
line to
compressor
Automatic
expansion
valve
Fig.
Fig.
-'
'
1,
Single coil
with one
Fig. 244.
coil
by-passed
Coils.
PIPING
368
o
gj
^ nt e
pumped
may
By
369
and pump-out
line
can be installed.
is
shown
in Figs. 240,
These are
arrangements for permitting hot gas from the compressor to enter the
frosted piping.
Non-freeze Back.
A control
4
I7 Discharge
Charging valve
Connect to pressure
governor on control
panel
Suction strainer
Steel^valve for
"Water
testing'gauges
line to
sewer
Sewer
Fig. 246.
shown
i-eturn line.
This
is
done
b}'
the device
same
result
suction pipe and by setting the contacts for the temperature required in
PIPING
370
1
"
fl
-g -S*
tn
fl
00
iC
i-<
o>
lO 50 to
*C :0 CO t^
lo
lo "5
t^ t^ i^ t^
CO 05 C3
rt rt
o o o
Tj"
1-1
lO
rl
o
rH
t^ 0> -H CO
rt (N C<l
o o o o
00 O IN '*
M (N <N (N
371
PIPING
372
The Radiator
Section.
The radiator
section,
made
of a thin walled
Brine return
Brine feed
Bolted flange
-J
Screwed unions
Long sweep
ell
i
to
h')
Drop
-ill
hCH
Riser
111
Brine feed on
same plane
.^.
^0-
H><h
Check valve
Gate valve
Globe valve
Angle valve
J
Gauge
Thermometer
Air
Brine strainer
Fig. 247.
cook
pressure and will carry a heavy load on a long span without leaks or
without showing signs of failure. The advantages of cast sections are in
the ease of erection, the probable better heat transfer^ and the greater
ease with which the section frees
piping.
The
refrigeration
2
The
itself of
common
ammonia
Ammonia, H.
J.
Macintire, Journal of
in
J.
373
Figures 245 and 246 show typical piping for automatic operation of
ammonia systems. Table 85 gives the dimensions and cross-
brine and
for piping.
TABLE
86
l(
CHAPTER
ICE
Natural Ice.
ago
it
MAKING
ice is less
negligible, as
amount
Natural
XIII
can be seen from the table (Table 87) which gives the
and stored
twenty years.
reasons for this falling off in the cutting of natural ice are several.
The
The
first
necessity,
This
is,
ice, is
it
has
been well determined that freezing frees the ice of impurities, and when
it is not used for several months the bacteria are mostly killed before the
ice is consumed. At present natural ice is used chiefly for car and boat
icing, where the appearance of the ice is not a factor.
Manufactured Ice. The artificial ice industry, including plants,
buildings and delivery equipment, is estimated (1924) to comprise nearly
The
felt in
effect of the
the larger
cities,
and
in
some
is
and markets.
374
beginning (1927) to be
driven two, one and the
NATURAL ICE
TABLE
87
Recapitulation
375
ICE
376
MAKING
may
United States.
The ice manufacturing industry,
like all appHcations of refrigeration,
has changed from steam engine to
oil
tric
it
was convenient
are
pressors
of
necessity
can
system.
electricity also
The
use
of
has directly
factor
in
decreasing
manufacturing
The
ice
Fig.
249. Typical
Ice
Making
Plant.
costs.
Distilled
Water System.
or
pond water
is
frozen in cans without the proper system the ice produced will be marblelike in appearance, due to the air which is always in solution in the
377
it
for table or
is
household purposes.
Where crushed
cream packing, ice and ice and salt railroad car icing, or in fish packing,
no difference between the two, but
transparent ice must be suppUed.
there
is
One
artificial ice is
manufacture
of crystal
engine
is
or surface blowoff to
oil,
Reboiler
Ammonia condenser
||
Exhaust steam
Fig.
250. The
Distilled
Water
Ice Plant.
etc.
the latter to remove any traces of oil present. The distilled water
now ready for the cans unless some system of precoohng is available.
The resulting ice, if care is taken not to let air become absorbed by the
distilled water, will be transparent without the medium of any com-
filter
is
water
Being
free of air
and dissolved
salts,
the
ICE
378
MAKING
The problem
boils
down
salts in solution,
its
100
lb.
Boiler
Cooling
water
1st. Effect
100
lb.
Condensed
boiler
c^
144
steam
lb.
Distilled
water
Distilled
Distilled
water
water
Fig. 251.
The Raw Water System. One of the first of the so-called raw water
systems (water not distilled is called raw water) was the plate ice method.
This system is one in which the refrigerant maintains a plate at zero
it is submerged in a tank of water.
Ice is formed
on one side only, the water near the freezing surface being in a constant
state of agitation.
In the process of five or seven days a thickness of
some 10 to 11 in. of ice is formed, and this ice is melted off the plate by
permitting hot gas from the compressor to pass into the coils or the
hollow part of the plate. The plate is quite large and the tank is deep,
so that the cake of ice formed, which has to be lifted by a crane, weighs
from three to five tons. This large cake is now removed to the saw
table where 300-lb. cakes are made up.
The plate- system makes good ice, and, in fact, it is said that no
2 Harry Sloan says (N.A.P.R.E., 1922) that the quahty of plate ice has never
been equalled by any other method of manufacture. Only slight differences in thick-
is
some
It is
prejudi(!e against
greater.
379
tendency in can
last
is
few
years.
The Can Raw Water System. The history of raw water can ice
making systems shows a large number of different devices. The attempt
at first was to prevent opaque ice, due to dissolved air in the water, and
later the problem became a desire to overcome the effects of dissolved
Paddles were used in the
a plunger with a pipe connection to the can so
that an oscillation of the plunger created a surge of the water in the
can. The entire tank, if a small one, has been placed on trunnions and
has been rocked by a suitable mechanism. Experiments towards the
elimination of all agitation by special treatment has been attempted for
years and especially latel}^^ This latest process requires the use of
galvanized piping throughout, a telescopic water storage tank, a special
can filHng device and finally a very careful chemical treatment and
filtration followed by a subjection of the water heated to about 150 deg.
F. to a very high vacuum.
A second filtering completes the process.
It is stated that the first and the operating cost is less than is required
salts as well as dissolved air in the water.
early designs,
and
later
Of
all
ice
The cans
itself
although smaller sizes are used in small tanks or where the ice
to be frozen during the day-time operation.
(Table 88)
about
is
11
in.
by 22
in.
to be the
The standard
cross-section
is
ice
and
lb.,
desired
can
this
size
size
up
is
these are lowered into a tank of brine until the brine level (on the outside
of the cans)
is
at least
up to the surface
of the
obtamed
Much more
evenness of
ICE
380
MAKING
The
brine for
to be frozen
amount
raw water
ice is
may have
excessive salts,
of air, in solution.
bj^
decreased, as regards
soda ash or by pumping out the core water after the can is about threequarters frozen. These solids and the air in solution constitute a real
problem, and their removal brings the variety of designs which are now
to be found on the market.
TABLE
The Standard
Weight
of
88
Sizes of Ice
Cans
AIR AGITATION
The
result has
381
The
sorts.
first
system of
agitation used involved a drop pipe into the center of each can about
three-quarters of the
pressure
is
way
to the
bottom
of the can.
ft.
Air at about 3
lb.
used.
distilled v/ater,
but this
is
not used in
new
Tube
socket!
can
hose coupling
of a lateral, ell
Fig. 252.
is
very unusual cases. With this system, unless the drop pipe is removed
at the proper time it will be frozen into the cake (requiring the thawing
out by means of a steam needle), and its usefulness under these circumstances would be decreased because the pressure of 3 lb. is not great
enough to prevent
ice
formation about the end of the pipe and the stopFinally, the can is lifted by a crane
and
ICE
382
MAKING
the ice
is
The low
pressure air agitation'* raw water system will give fairly good
good water is used. There is an expense due to the handling of the
drop pipes, which must be removed at the proper time or be frozen into
the ice, under which conditions the pipe has the additional expense of
thawing by means of the needle, a process which results in added wear
and tear to the drop pipe also. The low-pressure agitation drop pipe
(Fig. 253) is placed in the center of the can and is designed to be frozen
ice
if
Detail at
"A" showing
opening wtiere
lateral
connects to hose
Ferrule (slotted
to drain water)
^ank
Fig. 253.
Low
brass tubing
is
perforated with
small holes at several points to permit agitation of the core after the
*
Some water
enough
to prevent impurities
from
settling to the
is
not vigorous
The cure would be either better softening (and filtration) or earlier dropping of the core, or agitation with a greater air pressure. But the low-pressure air
system is much cheaper in first cost, and it is often used where the water is good.
Harry Sloan says (N.A.P.R.E., 1922) that the disadvantages of low-pressure air
agitation are thick opaque cores and greater labor costs. The advantages are m
the low first cost, in more simple installation and most economical in the use of
in the ice.
power.
H. R. Halterman (N.A.P.R.E., 1922) says that 100 cu. ft. of free air per minute
compressed to 3 lb. per sq. in. pressure requires 2\ hp., and 0.5 cu. ft. per minute per
can is used. He states also that 100 cu. ft. of free air per minute compressed to 30 lb.
requires 10 hp., but that only 0.2 cu. ft. of air per minute is required per can.
AIR AGITATION
end of the tube
is filled
up by the formation
383
of ice.
It
may
be men-
decreasing
by
this
TABLE
89
Tons
of Ice
Air
Blowers
384
ICE
MAKING
385
as freezing continues,
The
taste.
core needs to be
and also because of the reduced freezing temperature of the core water
and the increased time of freezing required. This is done by means of
a core sucker (Fig. 265). The air for agitation is best taken from the
top of the tank, thereby getting a colder air than would be available in
the
is
summer from
delivered, as a rule,
air pressure
is
The air
The
laterals.
'^^=
^sss^
Fig. 255.
the
it is
is
located
part of the freezing of the can, and under these conditions no trouble
if
is
made an
air.
is
How-
it
comes into
ICE
386
MAiaNG
a few pounds up to 30
lb.
more than
is
Some
The Dehumidifier.
all
The first form employs a cyHndrical shell oneand kept cool with brine from the brine tank. The
air is admitted near the bottom by passing through pipes or plates perforated with small holes, and as it passes upwards through the water,
is washed, cooled and purified. Apparently much depends on the design
half full of water
Fig. 256.
of as bubbles
will decrease.
it is
is
further cooled
of a brine coil.
first
being one-half
full of
a brine coil and the second half-full of brine which is cooled by the
use of direct-expansion piping. The air line to the cans has also usually
5 For 18 lb. air a hole made by a No. 75 drill is satisfactory or a No. 53 drill and
a No. If B. and S. gage wire. The air should be compressed to 25 to 30 lb. at the
compressor if 14 to 16 deg. F. brine is to be used.
The high-pressure air system has the advantage because of the necessity of the
removal of the air tube in the low-pressure system, with the resulting stoppage of
and the large core in the ice block as weU as the labor required in the work.
The high-pressure air system requires the use of a constricting orifice.
Thomas Shipley says that the low-pressure air system is all right with proper
care and some waters, but the high-pressure air system would produce much better
results on the average than wiU the low-pressure even when the low-pressure agitation
agitation
is
doing
its
best as there
is
no stoppage
of agitation at
core
THE DEHUMIDIFIER
a cartridge
filter
387
A modifica-
tion of the
tanks,
brine
through
which
cylindrical
coil or shell
and tube
Separator
cooled,
the
air
Safety valve-;
passes in series.
collects
on the cooUng
surfaces and must be defrosted every six to eight
hours. ^ This is done by
frost
Baffles
of re-
The
of
particular advantage
this
plicity,
type
its
is
sim-
required in
operation,
its
Equalizer
pipe
where the
with
contact
direct
brine
comes
air
need of
of
in
Auxiliary
the
brine line
any
in order
filtering
The
can pipes.
accumulation on the
pipes assists in cooUng the
air by an amount at least
the
in
frost
rine outlet
four-way valve
when
is
Air inlet
the
reversed
return
Air Distributor
to freezing tank
^Moisture trap
Fig. 257.
(Fig. 258).
The
Shipley says that the use of brine instead of direct expansion for air cooling is
if the compressor stops at any time the air can be kept cold and
therefore dehumidified. Air pressures of 5 lb. for low pressure and 25 lb. for high
8
preferred because
same motor
The
is
ICE
388
MAKING
Drain valve
Check valve
Check
Drain to
valve
trap
Air outlet
of air
---^E
[
is
set
4 -Way cock
when cock
is
reversed.
i,
|^3
U'
Air inlet-
Enlarged Plan of 4
Fig. 258.
4-way cock--^^
1^
To dehumidifier-^*?
Note:
Full line
pump^
me irom pump'
-Way Cock
Coils.
ICE
DUMPING AND
REFILLLNCi
THE CANS
389
air
air,
5.0 hp. per 100 300-lb. cans for high-pressure air agitation,
(1927)
is
a drop pipe in the center of the can, made of brass and extending nearly
to the bottom of the can (usually about 5 in. of the bottom) as com-
in. for
It gives
a cake of
with hardly any perceptible core, saves tank room labor and does not
require
system of the
Ice
Dumping and
sists in
the
earlier designs.
filling of
many
heavy 3-motor
Heretofore the connection from the cans to the crane has been
by means of can dogs, but when four, six or more cans were "hfted"
considerable time was wasted because of the undue swinging of the
crane.
cans at the start and the stop, and injury to the cans or the direct
expansion piping in the tank. The result has been the use of the so-called
can basket
all
hoist.
The basket
is
the plant
ICE
390
MAKING
391
claimed that a can lift of 1 to Ij per cent is the maximum amount permissible at a time unless an excessive variation of the operating conditions
is
to be permitted.
in ice
is
ice.
Checking
is
due to so
Thawing tank
extended as indicated
Fig. 260.
many
Automatic Can
Filler.
medium and
temperature
all
of ice,
ICE
392
by removing the
MAKING
thawing of the
ice is
dip tank.
Can
Filling.
Even
float
plants
it
is
filler is
doubtful
profitable.
may
result
weakened
brine.
.CA
Top
204
r.
p.
of ice tank
m.
18" Dia,
4- Blades
Pitch=2.7 ft
slot in bulkhead
^
Side View
Rear View
Fig. 261.
a separate compartment for each can) and a pull of the control chain
starts the filling operation.
With a
3-in. filler
The
without
is
and with
less
amount
of agitation
AGITATION
larger plants,
is
electrically operated
dump
by means
393
of cables driven
by a
hoist.
Agitation.
Fig. 262.
394
ICE
MAKING
WATER SOFTENERS
395
In order to get this close operation and at the same time to acquire
Some tanks have been
production a heavy agitation is necessary.
designed for a difference in the brine level of from three to five or more
There
is
more thought
also
With a
bottom of the
tapering can
it is
is
more space
at the
brine tank between the cans for the brine to pass through than there
at the top.
Also there
is
is
tank below the cans. Since for best results the brine flow should be
reasonably uniform around the cans, attention is now being directed to
this matter.
The power
end.
is
Water Softeners.
the
ft.
pitch.
amount
of salt in
The
The
central states
it is
very bad.
Washington
and Oregon have soft water, but California water is bad. The water of
the Great Lakes is hard. In the southwest the water in certain regions
contains so much sodium bicarbonate as to make it unfit for raw water
making.
ice
If
is
it is
if
Thus magnesium
salts will
show as a white
If agitation is
surface of the ice and being frozen into the ice will give the pecuUar
and
is
is
moving
If
the
..
ICE
396
MAKING
CaCOa
Limestone
CO2
Carbon
H2O = CaC03C02H20
Dioxide
(Insoluble)
(Soluble)
The same is true of magnesium carbonate. But water chemists have reported
the bi-carbonates of calcium and magnesium in terms of calcium carbonate and
magnesium carbonate for so long that it has become standard practice. Occasionally, however, an analysis is submitted where they are expressed as bi-carbonates,
and the following factors may be of help:
Calcium Bi-carbonate X 0.617 = Calcium Carbonate.
Calcium Carbonate X 1.62 = Calcium Bi-carbonate.
Magnesium Bi-carbonate X 0.576 = Magnesium Carbonate.
Magnesium Carbonate X 1.735 = Magnesium Bi-carbonate.
The following table gives the names of the usual minerals found in water, how
they eifect the appearance of raw water ice, and the effect of treatment with hydrated
lime in an efficient water treating plant.
Minerals
in
Effect in Ice
Water
Calcium carbonate
Magnesium
discolored deposit,
Result of Treatment
With Hydrated Lime
Ca(0H)2
Practically eliminated.
Practically eliminated.
carbonate
peratures.
Iron oxide
Aluminum
and
oxide
Eliminated.
Practically eliminated.
Eliminated.
silica
Suspended matter
Calcium sulphate
Magnesium
sulphate.
Magnesium
chloride
like
sodium
Sodium
sulphate,
sodium
chloride.
Sodium carbonate
(actually
pres-
ent as sodium
bi-carbonate)
.
chloride.
Do
No
change.
Changes
calcium
Changes
calcium
to
sulphate.
to
chloride.
No
Treatment changes
makes heavy
deposit.
cores.
change.
so-
dium
bi-carbonate
to sodium carbonate
treatment
proves but
im-
little.
WATER SOFTENERS
397
Minerals
Calcium carbonate
and magnesium
carbonate (combined)
If
Iron oxide.
might be unobjectionable.
Some
Aluminum
oxide and
Suspended matter
in
quantities
requhe treatment.
silica
.
Analyses
Color
to
what
may
color
is
is
removed.
Calcium sulphate.
Magnesium sulphate
Calcium chloride.
Magnesium chloride.
Sodium sulphate
Sodium chloride
Sodium carbonate
.
grouped together.
Sum
If
sum
Total
total
is less
quality ice
average brine temperatures.
sum
and
less
agitation.
sum
and
less
more are
sum
carried.
total is
and
less
398
ICE
MAKING
WATER SOFTENERS
the poor appearance of these salts in the
effect of increasing
resulting in a direct
The treatment
salts
method
sum
of
cannot be removed,
ice,
399
as, for
magnesium
water
is
of the ice,
ice.
quite simple.
Certain
salts usually
is
making.
From 20
gal. gives
water that
to 40 grains
is
gal.
it is
all
and may
The presence
The
usual
method
is
ICE
40(3
MAKING
period the chemicals sink to the bottom where they are drained off as a
is drawn off near the top and is
remove the free iron, silica and the sus-
through a quartz
passer!
pended
dirt
filter
to
and sludge.
The tendency
of the design of
water softeners
is
to give
more time
more com-
and
is
figured
Can
Ice Making.^
"
The
clearness, firmness
ice
has, until comparatively recently, been almost exclusively used in the artificial ice
industry. Ice frozen from impure water is opaque, discolored, or brittle, depending
on the nature of the impurities.
"Freezing water is, in many respects, much like boiling and evaporating it, in
that by far the greatest part of the substances dissolved in the water freeze out in
the ice made from it. The most effective purification of raw water for ice making is,
therefore, that which reduces the objectionable impurities in the water to a minimum.
It is now generally recognized that the most effective purification is accomplished by
lime-soda softening, followed by sand filtration.
"In the process of the manufacture of ice from raw water, cans of the water are
surrounded by the sodium or calcium chloride brine having a temperature of 12 to
18 deg. F. Air under either high pressure (15 to 25 lb.) or low pressure (3 to 5 lb.) is
bubbled through the water as it freezes, the high-pressure air being in general more
effective. The first ice formed around the sides of the can is usually relatively pure.
The dissolved gaseous and solid impurities in the water are frozen and begin to
deposit on the face of the ice; but the currents of water set up by the air agitation
wash these impurities off the surface of the ice and carry them towards the center
of the can.
The impurities in the raw water thus become concentrated in the
unfrozen water in the middle of the can. If these impurities are insoluble, their
accumulation in this unfrozen water usually becomes so heavy that eventually the
currents of water set up b}^ the air agitation are not powerful enough to keep the
particles in suspension. As a result these white or colored particles are deposited in
the ice before the cake is frozen solid, or if the impurities are soluble, as, for instance,
sodium salts, their concentration may become so great that freezing is materially
termed,
is
ICE
MAKING
401
it, appear as white or colored deposits, and as air needles in the core
when the cake is frozen solid.
"The most common, and at the same time the most undesirable class of calcium
and magnesium compounds are those causing temporary hardness that is, the bicar-
water replacing
of the ice
bonates.
it
'
half -bound
'
carbon dioxide
and possibly of magnesium hydrate. With air agitation these precipitated compounds will be carried
more or less completely to the center of the can. Here they will accumulate until
it becomes necessary to pump out the heavily laden water and replace it with fresh
water. Frequently this accumulation takes place so rapidly that two, and sometimes
even three, core pumpings are required. Even with good air agitation, however, the
removal of the precipitated compounds to the middle of the can is often not complete, and milky white dots, bubbles and patches are found distributed throughout
the clear portion of the ice. Frequently also a white opaque shell of the precipitated
carbonates will be found around the lower portion of the cake, where freezing is most
and cause a
rapid,
it
tionable sediment.
cheaply,
and
leaves in the treated water no products of the reaction bej-ond the 2.5 to 4 grains
magnesium
"The removal
of
temporarjr hardness.
permanent hardness
Investigations
is
far less
important for
ice
making than
of
many
cases, possibly all permanent hardness need not be removed, provided that the
magnesium which always tends to make white ice is removed from such compounds
and is replaced with calcium. This is accomplished of course in the treatment with
lime. The calcium sulphate and chloride left in the water as a result of the lime
treatment appear to be no more detrimental and in some cases even less so than
the sodium salts which would result in the removal of the permanent hardness with
soda ash.
when soda
is
made from
is
equally
more complete, thereby reducing the load on the filters. Further, when soda
used the carbonate ions in the treated water are lessened and as the ice freezes
a much greater concentration in the unfrozen water is required before the ion-product
constant is exceeded. As a result the unfrozen water remains clear much longer,
and free from particles of the precipitated carbonate that would tend to deposit on
the ice, consequenth- core pumping can be delayed, a less amount of water can be
used and the refrigeration thus otherwise wasted, can be saved.
" As little as 0.2 parts per million of iron may cause 'red ice,' that is ice colored
reddish brown, principally in the core. Silica and alumina are deposited in the
core of the ice cake, imparting a muddy appearance to it, and when this ice melts
there remains a slimy sediment. Organic matter is frequently found in objectionable
quantity in surface waters, particularly in warm weather. It usually colors the
tanks
ash
is
is
muddy
the
ice is saleable
it
is
is
of
402
to
MAKING
ICE
The
chief objection to
sodium
salts
(and potassium)
is
that they accumulate in the core water and retard freezing and are finally deposited
as white solids in the
ice.
If
may
is present the
be so serious as to require several core pumpIn addition to this general objection certain
amount tends
siderable
results.
to cause brittleness
portion
is
quite clear.
to apply distillation.
'*
There
is
is
is
frozen under
is
used,
is
some
ice to
internal strain.
During the freezing process, while the half-bound carbon dioxide is trying
and particles of
the precipitated compound which are readily visible. The ice thus formed is comparable to a metal casting full of blow holes and impurities and is in consequence
inherently weak and brittle.
" Some weight is given this hypothesis by the general experience that removing
the bicarbonates of calcium and magnesium from the water by treatment with lime
results in the production of much clearer and firmer ice, and frequently permits the
use of lower brine temperatures. Further in a recent series of experiments ice was
frozen from water to which had been added varying amounts of sodium bicarbonate.
In all cases except the lowest concentration (10 grains per gallon) the ice formed
was quite brittle, cracked readily, and showed evidence of a bubbly structure.
Analysis of the melted core ice showed the conversion of the bicarbonates to the
normal carbonate in all cases to the extent that the normal carbonate alkalinity
strain.
Obviously
still
make
same
This
is
not known in
all
It
is
also
probable that the permissible maximum of silica and alumina is not exceeded in
natural waters if treated with lime.
" With regard to sodium salts, and to calcium sulphate and chloride, investigations tend to indicate that when the total soluble salt content of a raw water exceeds
30 to 40 grains per gallon exclusive of the temporary hardness, first quality raw water
ice cannot be made even with water softening high-pressure air agitation."
many
of Ice.
is
ice
making
checking of the ice cake during freezing, or during the pulling period
or even
up
The
1.
2.
be given
^'^
:
tempering
will
the cake
if
3. Filling
4.
403
is
Rough handling
of cans
sucking, hoist-
6.
Leaky cans.
Too low a brine temperature (approximately 44
7.
lb.
cans).
8.
9.
10.
From
the preceding
list it is
are present.
it
is
better than
slowly in cold water, and again, in other cases, the use of 60 deg.
water in the dip tank and a lowering rate of the can such as would
submerge the can has been found best. The old
form of sprinkler device at the dump is thought to be more likely to
F.
require 7| minutes to
cause checking than the dip tank, whereas the use of air agitation of the
dip tank is considered to give better results than the tank without
agitation.
stresses
is
because of freezing
Some
ice is
cracked before
it is
ice
during
cans.
Piping.
The method of cooling brine in the ice tank for a long time
has been to use direct expansion piping in the brine tank (Fig. 263).
ICE
404
MAKING
These pipes are arranged to run the long dimension of the tank, and are
placed in stands between the individual ice cans, thereby permitting
close proximity
These pipe
coils
PIPING
405
Liquid
ammonia
Suction header
gauge glass
ww<
Fig. 264.
in Ice
Tank.
with the flooded system with ihe same amount of agitation. As piping
has been considered to be the cheapest part of the plant it has been the
custom to specify 250 to 300 linear ft. of 1 j-in. pipe per ton of ice making.
For a 100-ton ice plant there would be required under these circumstances from 5 to 6 miles of pipe which must be made very tight unless
a loss of
chloride
means
is
of
ammonia
of the
ICE
406
brine from the tank.
The
sections,
MAKING
and arranged
filling
is
cooler,
ft.
to
travel from the expansion valve to the beginning of the suction return
The objections to the use of the
line to the compressor (Fig. 171).
shell
cooler
I
fear
that
could
the
cooler
be
made
not
where
the tubes were expanded into the tube
sheet, and that as the
cooling surfaces were
only at one end (or
both ends) of the tank,
the brine temperature
would be non-uniform
in the tank. There is
tight, especially
the cooler
is
too great,
much
expenditure of
power to provide
Fig. 265. Core Sucker.
culation of
cir-
the brine
some
per min., and the coefficient of heat transfer under these conditions is
90 B.t.u. per hour. The objection that valuable space will be taken up
by the cooler is answered in a way by the statement that as the piping
407
not placed between the cans, these can be placed on closer centers.
This is especially true in the case of cans in baskets which permit a
lighter tank frame construction.
The shell brine cooler lends itself to
is
the flooded operation, and by means of the separator and drain (Fig.
170) back to the cooler the danger due to a " slop over " to the compressor
removed.
is
70 deg.
F.,
then
If
38
B.t.u.
must be removed
advantageously in
Air
Brine
header
Special air connectors
JL
>:i__
^T
Ice lifting
/overs two
rods
/ cans wide
^
-;:^-^\t._JL\._/_
IT
Copper tube
water connections
header
Fig. 266.
cooler.
may
It
tWater header
Special pipe
Special insulating
connectors
material
all
.,
to lose
^^^'^
column
pipe
is
observed.
It is
easy
the cans,
in
ICE
408
The Bishop
Ulrich process.
to
fit
MAKING
the conditions of the can system, was arranged so that the water
entered the
(;an at
kept cool in the usual manner with brine, freezing took place from all
four sides and a fairly clear cake of ice resulted. The can was arranged
and the ice had to be loosened in the can by cirand the cakes lifted by means of hooks frozen into
the ice for that purpose. The Quick-freeze system attempted to cut
down the time of freezing by the use of a special pipe arrangement
so as to be stationary
culating
warm
Overflow bucket
brine
in
which
is
Tank top
when heighth
of
bkcks
is
Handles
Granulated cork insulation
level
also
'
regulated
ie e
lid
m
'
The length
one
same
One
layer 3"corkboard
36"wide
Fig. 267.
broken away so as to
lor
operahng brine
^'^^
^'^
J^'t^''^/""
"'""^nk lop
//""^'i
//
projecting
brine.
In the
the time of freezing of a standard cake of ice would be reduced.
Hill-Ray
method,
only
apparent
the
advantage
the
there
was
plate system
which was an arrangement of wedges by which the size of the cake was
The
reduced and the amount of sawing diminished in proportion.
time,
froze
the
cake
from
sides
same
two
at the
Center-Freeze method
the pipes being spaced about 5 to 6 in. apart, and it was claimed that
a reduced time of freezing was accomplished. The finished cake would
of course have holes in it where the pipes had been during freezing.
of
FREEZING PROCESSES
The
H olden
Regulation system
409
is still
sibilit^^
expansion,
is
made
to revolve with
its
of water (see Lard Coohng, Chapter XIV). The ice film is scraped off
and the snow is compressed hydrauhcally to the size of cake desired.
This method is very nearly ideal, the cost per ton is low, and the process
Unfortunately there is no known means of producing
is continuous.
thereby a crystal cake, and this method has not been used commercially
for years.
Finally, there is the Jewell process, a modification of which
(the Arctic-Pownall) is a most successful present-day design.
The Jewell process uses a double-walled can which is stationary.
The space between the two walls is filled with brine, the brine entering
at the top and leaving at the bottom. The bottom of the can is insulated
and contains the air connections for agitation. The Arctic-Pownall
arrangement is shown in Figs. 266 to 268. The brine is cooled by means
The ice
of shell and tube brine coolers, and the agitation is vigorous.
open
at
the
bottom,
and
supported
on
beams,
tank needs to be
is
I
as
shown. The filhng of the cans, dropping, and the refilling of the cores
are performed by the means of piping connected to the can flanges. A
number of 300- or 400-lb. cans from 28 to 84 are connected so as to
form an ice tank. These cans are all interconnected so that can filling,
core dropping, etc., can take place in unison by the operation of one
valve.
By this method all cans are filled at the same level which can
be adjusted, and the water for can fiUing can be stored in a tank to the
correct
of
desired).
as follows:
The
construction.
plant is made up
The water for the
The
is
emptied and
the cans of the tank by the opening of one valve and the brine
by the operation
of
two quick-acting
is
valves.
The advantages
one
man
is
economy in the use of brine in the precooling of the water for the cans
and by the use of this heated brine for the thawing of the ice out of the
cans, the use of low-pressure air for agitation entirely and no chance of
white (marble) ice due to shut-downs of power. The first cost is considerably greater (10 to 15 per cent) than the usual medium-pressure
air
ever,
it is
calls for
How-
ICE
410
MAKING
Make up
water line
Warm
ice
brine to
tanks
Brine line
from
pump
\^
^cr\
Overflow-H
Brine coils
Ammonia
Water
ice
coils
line to
tanks
Tank drain
Fig.
411
and tear on the equipment, and with less labor on the tank room floor
with this system than with any other.
The Design of an Ice Making Plant. Ice plant design is different in
various parts of the United States and even in different parts of the same
city.
In order that design details may be emphasized, some material
it
affects the
matter of design.
TABLE
91
412
MAKING
ICE
agitation
is
for the
CO
r~.
fsj
^^
cr>
413
MAKING
ICE
414
in the cans, although the empirical formula for the time of freezing
and Table
is
The
relation of
well
shown
number
in Fig.
269
92.
The matter
The
ice
and
154.5-lb. condenser pressure, using 70 deg. F. water to the cans and
The outside air temperature is 90 degrees, and the
16 deg. brine.
temperature of the earth is 50 deg. F. Use high pressure air agitation,
30 lb, at the compressor and 15 lb. at the cans. Two dehumidifiers,
brine cooled, to cool 200 cu. ft. of free air from 90 to 20 deg. F. per
plant
is
to be a 100-ton
minute.
Two
Each tank
ft.
1 in.
in.
high.
will
Storage.
To
To
To
1 lb. of ice
from 32 to 16 deg.
(spec,
heat of ice
Total
Add
and
U =
5)
190.0 B.t.u.
19.0
g.
cypress.
=
[-
1.4
0.0231.
12
These
1"
B.t.u.
38
144.0
8.0
.
of ice
1 lb.
0.296
"
See Chapter
XIV.
^ ^
5-in.
corkboard,
9-in. concrete.
U =
5
0.0558.
_9_
5~3
0.308
0.0231
0.0558
X
X
(90
(50
=
=
16)
16)
4260 X 24
2000
2030 B.t.u.
"
6490
= 8520
Total
415
B.t.u.
lb.
of ice.
50
The
change
certain
r-j-^
or, in
terms of the
ice
493
The
transfer,
made,
X 24
2000
60
100
35.0
lb.
pump
equivalent of the
Agitation always
it is
horse power
is
20
The
42.4 X 60 X 24
100 X 2000
209
02
one pound of
3 56
.
ice
made
is
to the calculation.
The value
''^-
then
219 7 B.t.u.
.
53
is
generally used
by the use
number
made according
In this
is
1.6,
although some
ill
^4iV4F->H-14,^Vl4i'^<-14i''->f<--17^^-14^''>^14^'->k-14^'^-l4i'U-14i^^
MoJfemale'flangesi
li"x
4''
E. H.
Nipples
ll"o^3,
!
!i
-^?fc-14i!'>k-14i"H^14iVl4^'-Kl4i;Wl4^->fj^
^^'^ ^'^"g^-J,!
...
./i f
I4 Liquid
^^
I
i
^i\.^^.^
,,
*7
'=
/./
15'-lj
Ij Liquid inlet
|<-7i'!|<-7i!!l
E
,i".
t'^^
^1;
outlet
4-3-16
->J<-
^"Cofk
,
5-7rsr---x/i6r-----D-02 -*!<(<-
8'-Aj
^<-
8'-
13
Coils,
Opening
board
j"---- -->!<----->K-
8'-
4|'
-4<-
8'-4t-
8'-4f
In
bulkhead 3'-0x 6
4^
6'-3j"--->|<-3'-3f
^--^
l<--Tank5'-0"
Fig.
270. Can
Ice
Tank
Design.
first
417
and
second,
Medium-
have produced
sized plants
possible that with good agitation and with the flooded sj^stem (which
makes it possible to decrease the amount of gas in the evaporating system, and by having a heavy feed with some liquid in the coils for the
entire length of the direct expansion piping) a value of 30 or more can
be obtained for k, ^- but a design of this sort requires more care in the
is
Selecting
the compressor and the compressor drive has become a difficult problem
in these days,
with the
many
However,
men-
It is
ammonia
means an appreciable
loss of
minimum, but
double-single-acting design.
gas flow.
The
by
is
a uniflow principle of
efficiency
may
be a
a term
is
little
low for
It
stuffing-box which
is
much more
difficult to
at
all,
is
have more
is
friction
not used
of horizontal
Thomas
1926.
!=>
XIX.
ICE
418
MAKING
have horizontal compressors only
As regards the
drive, for
electric-driven
compressors^^ requiring
amount
usually
ticularly
of the compressor.
1*
1^^
and 154.5
i"2Ub.
g.
t'sedeg. F.
= 614.9 -
= 476
138.9
lb.
B.t.u.
1 lb.
liquid
ammonia.
X 7.28
476.0
= 3.06 cu. ft., and with a volumetric efficiency of 0.86 the piston displacement per
ton per minute becomes 3.06/0.86 =3.56 cu. ft., not allowing for clearance.
(See Chapter II.)
The horse power per ton
of refrigeration
is
n
=
n
rpivi
1
'
\/^i
\PI/
28
= - X
obtained from
0.28
169. 2\ 1.28"
0.
144
Jo
34,500
ft.-lb.
X38.7 X3.56
38.7
1.05 hp.
and
419
becomes
3.6 cu.
ft.
per ton
276 cu. ft. per min. for each of the compressors. The
chosen will affect the rotative speed, but the
compressor
type
some form of light weight valve of the plate
practice
is
to
use
present
The
hea\y poppet valve is practically obsolete.
ribbon
type.
the
or
motor
be used clearance pockets may be employed
synchronous
Should a
the
capacity of the compressor.
in
regulating
advantage
to
Ice-making plants have use for two suction pressures, ^'^ the second
76.6
3.6
of the
This
is
especially true
Hand
For
Fig. 271.
Hoist
400* or 2 300*cans
is
much
care
is
taken to prevent
In choosing the details of the air agitation and harvesting, the costs
The
high-pressure air system was selected for the problem, and also multiple
15
See Chapter
1*
See
first
II.
ICE
420
can
lifting
and
consideration.
MAKING
filling devices.
^^^^^^^^^^^^g
wwwwwwvww^
the present time this type would be used only for the smaller plants.
The larger plants would use the air or the electric motor-driven hoist.
Ice-making Plants. Figures 272, 273 and 274 give details of modern
All plants
have a daihj
ice storage,
ICE
MAKING PLANTS
421
c3
422
MAKING
ICE
^Ugg
s^s^^^s^^^^^s^sss\^s^^\^^^
k^^vAvv\\^-,.v'.^'
"^JOiEiiSe suuq
ibdijjsa
f:
'...
[ ;-.-.
wwav\ v,^vv.
-'
.\vvw
To
ICE STORAGE
423
and most of them have a storage sufficient in capacity to permit an emergency shut-down of from tliree to four days. It is a question whether
the large ice storage warehouse, using a smaller sized compressor for
is more economical
than the larger sized compressor and ice tank, to be operated as the
demand for ice requires, without the ice storage.
6"Cork
^^
tile-v.
Forecooler
.Ta_nk top
'
^
i
r4" Cork
.r
ctVCork
^4|"Cork
Z'-'z
Wood
floor
-l^
"'=Fill"=
r^
^^^Bn)
Fig.
The
following paper, by H. T.
Whytc,
The capacity
of the
-^
Ice Plants.
assistant general
manager,
N.A.P.R.E. on November
of compressors, tanks
and Exhibition
'!'
,,i
5"
(Cork
;
:''W*7
Annual Convention
12, 1924.
of plant should be in direct
and monthly
For instance, where a large daily demand is encountered, which goes on
for a period of five months or more, it has been found as a rule more economical to
provide for practically the entire requirements through machine capacity, with but
small storage room for reserve, in that greater economy can be obtained through
pulling requirements direct from tanks, rather than providing large storage room
and storing ice throughout the year for disposal during summer months, resulting
in excess cost on account of extra handling and, as well, the cost of maintais'ing
relation to the annual tonnage requirements and, as well, the daily
demand.
ICE
424
MAKING
temperatures on storage room throughout the year, and with practical'y no shutdown period during the winter months.
For example, let us compare the relative merits and costs of operation of a 200-ton
daily capacity manufacturing plant, costing approximately $300,000, with a 125-ton
daily capacity manufacturing plant, with 10,000 tons storage room, costing $277,000
k--F
breakage
in storage
and
>
>t<
of
A
Fig.
h-
is
the advantage of
which of course
is
first
quality fresh
ice,
quite costly.
prove desirable;
pressor
room
also, in
building.
the type of construction to be used for tank and comIn some locations, it is possible to construct this portion
425
ICE SCORING
Water
is
one of the most important factors aflfecting ice manufacturing producpure water freezes more rapidly, makes tougher ice,
for
ice
less is
used
forecooling
making and
for condensers;
re-
it
be
also
for
assured,
over condensers
is
as
of
cold water
is
available.
Ice Storage.
ice storages
elevating
of
signs
In
two de-
The
may be used.
daily
storage
chain con-
the
floor
is
moving of the
ice. For ice storage
rooms of medium
tal
Fig. 276.
By
this is
With certain
retail
trade there
is
demand
for scored
426
ICE
MAKING
ICE SCORING
427
proper saw cut so as to register the size of a 25, 50, 75, or 100-lb. piece
Figure 277 shows such a scoring machine.
of ice.
Fig.
Item
Tons
200-ton plant
Cost
per ton
taxes,
interest
depreciation
on investment (14
and
pei
$1.08
cent)
Plant labor
labor
Power
Ammonia
Water and other supplies
Maintenance
Salary of portion of crew
during'-
shut-down period
Winter storage room labor, 10,000
.15
tons
refrigeration,
10,000 tons
Totals
$2.79
Total
of Storage
428
ICE
fc
MAKING
-31'0"
,5,'.
V .,5:
-40--*^K3'0j>[*-3'-51hV-4'-0--HK-
y^
--7'-3|
/-BJ--
ri
,5"
t*--4'08 CorkboardN
6"Corkboafdv
\^
9'.4"
_>^
(^
">U 3V o^L^J|f- 3^
9'.5"
0"->'<-2'- 1
1'y* 3^
_>(
O^^U 3^
9'.4"
0''->l*2^
loUs- 3^
0^
CHAPTER XIV
COLD STORAGE
The most vital application of mechanical refrigeration is cold storage.
The space in the United States cooled mechanically to 40 deg. F. or
lower for
is
all
No
ft.,
and
this represents
estimate of the
amount
about
of goods
A.
(1925)
W. Oakley
Some thirty-five years ago tlie cold storage industry carried along in a limited
way using natural ice as a refrigerant, but in the past twenty-five years there has Vjeen
rapid development in the science and art of refrigeration and
its adaptation in a
commercial way to the preservation of food products from the producer to the
consumer. This is indicated by figures giving the approximate refrigerated space
in public cold storage warehouses, which in 1914 was 200,000,000 cu. ft. and in 1923,
298,000,000 cu. ft., as given by the United States Department of Agriculture, whereas
in 1922 the combined public and private warehouses, including meat-packing establishments, aggregated 559,000,000 cu. ft., of which space about 25 per cent is freezer
and 75 per cent cooler. In this space there is carried approximately 1,930,000,000 lb.
increasing
possible
foods.
Cold storage warehouses serve to stimulate production and prevent gluts in the
market, and the modern warehouse is constantly striving for better handling and
preserving of perishable goods in the cold storage rooms by proper use of ozone,
ventilation, air circulation
and control
of humidity.
429
COLD STORAGE
430
Some
idea
New York
may be
City per
week:
Dairy Products
Milk
800
2200
750
600
300
850
1750
50
Meat
Live Stock
Poultry
Fruit
Vegetables
Sea Food
7300
Total
employees.
New York
and 400,000
60,000 distributors
most
of 30,000,000
of
The cold storage warehouse also provides against food shortage in emergencies
such as railroad strikes and embargoes.
The
is an economic one.
It provides a means
and continues the market for vegetables like
The purpose
and
eggs,
and
by holding the
commodity
the
by a glaze
by
of ice, or
nature of
for
may
be kept
season over the natural one of a few weeks, unless cold storage can
solve the problem.
To serve a useful
the surplus supply
it
until the
must take
demand
increases.
is
Months
Eggs
5.91
Dressed poultry
Butter
Beef
2 42
Mutton
Pork
4.43
2.28
4 45
0.88
.
THE APPLE
In addition,
it is
431
fish
(frozen)
is
devote one-
quarter of the space to egg storage during the egg season, about 10 to
12 per cent to meats and
and about
fish,
and
cheese.
The remainder
used by a large
miscellaneous variety. At special periods, of course, these proportions
are very different, as, for example, apples may take half of the space in
of the space in the public cold storage
warehouses
is
fall,
The
Apple.
fruit,
as
difference in the
to distinguish
storage.
air
must be able
and carry away the heat generated by the chemical action which is
always going on to a greater or lesser degree. Scald is caused apparently
by the accumulation of certain gases given ofT by the apples themselves,
and it can be prevented only by air circulation or by the absorbing of
these gases. An oiled (not waxed) wrapper with 15 per cent by weight
of oil decreases scald to a
1
Dr.
J.
marked
degree.
in Storage, U. S.
Agriculture.
*
Fatmers
Bulletin,
No. 1160, U.
S.
Department
less in crates
of Agriculture.
Bureau
of
COLD STORAGE
432
by 4
in.
decreased the scald by permitting the air to circulate freely provided the
If
The
best practice
is
1-in. strips
between
layers.
by
ends.
although this
The Pear.
is
"^
According to Dr.
is
30 deg. F.
J.
Handling, storing,
and
Rapid cooling of
air circulation
is
to be similar conditions.
California,
results
from investigations
where grown,
etc.,
The Egg. According to Bulletin No. 729, United States Department of Agriculture, only large eggs that are clear and have clean
whole shells should be used for long holding in cold storage. The net
weight of a case (30 dozen) of eggs packed for storage should be not
less than 42 lb. They should be packed in new, odorless cases fastened
preferably with cement-coated nails with medium hea\'y fillers. Odorless fillers
securely fastened.
lid
should be
The egg room should be dry, clean and free from odors, and the
temperature should be kept at from 29 to 32 deg. F. In storing, ventila2-in. strips on the floor and |-in. or thicker
between the cases in the stacks. If the eggs are fresh and have
clean whole shells they may be successfully preserved for from nine to
ten months. The loss in spring-packed eggs by candling is about 3 to
4 per cent., but it is much greater for summer-packed eggs. The loss
in weight due to shrinkage per case is about 3 to 4 oz. per month. The
relative humidity of the room should be about 85 per cent.
tion
strips
THE EGG
In the
summary
Agriculture)
show a
it is
of Bulletin
most
of
stated that clean whole eggs that have not been wet
months
in handling,
433
in storage.
Imperfections
bad
for
of the
eggs.
to be very inefficient.
firsts.
If
heated or stale they should be packed in bulk and frozen, under which
after storage
did
maintained.
The
Dr.
Mary
The conclusion
good economy.
It
is
as follows:
is
in
which
May
is
when the present standard egg package is used, and when the temfrom 29 deg. to 31 deg. F.
2. The humidity of the storage rooms was controlled during the late summer
and winter months by a regulated current of outdoor air.
3. Apparently moving air does not accelerate the usual shrinkage of stored eggs,
storage flavors
perature
is
Department
storage.
COLD STORAGE
434
them
They
below
first,
and makes
market
in the
ripening.
Low
itself is
is
in
Poultry.
Dressed
poultry,
fresh,
may
is
it is
possible,
decreased.
For the best results the poultry should be dry picked and dry packed.
Poultry which has been in contact with ice should never be stored. Icepacked poultry and scalded poultry usually age more quickly. Poultry
should be packed in clean, well-made boxes
usually
12 birds to the
manner
Fish
is
in order to be
such
fish as bluefish
delicacy.
^
FISH STORAGE
For storage
fish
number
of fish
the
if
AND FREEZING
fish
By
this is
435
fish or
around a
is
likely to turn white^ and the fish to shrivel, because of the loss of
moisture. The glaze also tends to prevent the shrivelling of the noses
and the
fins,
fish is
of the fish,
Department
of Agriculture,
COLD STORAGE
436
Agriculture (Bulletin No. 635) indicate that properly glazed fish were
kept for 27 months during which time and at the end of this period
unsuitable for food, nor were there any important differences in the
fish.
Other
experiments show that after 9 months there was nothing in the taste
by which the average consumer of fish could detect the stored fish from
the fresh
fish.
as the stock
is
of storage is
is
about 8 months,
again plentiful in
the market.
Walter
Stiles of
University College, Reading,^ the use of cold brine for the freezing of
fish
air cooling.
due to the
tion of moisture
up
to 6 per cent.
These changes
an
The
weight by evapora-
in the fish
were not
that brine freezing tends to prevent the formation of this ice glaze.
fish
is
into the
body
become
general.
of the fish
Report
J.
'
J.
VEGETABLES
437
glazed as before.
Large
fish
fish freezing.
^1
I T & G./
Cans'
'
Fig. 280.
^Strap
Iron
Vegetables:
bruises,
Department
of Agriculture.
S.
COLD STORAGE
438
from 50 to 55 deg. F.
Onions.
Only sound, well ripened onions should be stored free
from loose skins and properly dried. They should be stored in slatted
after stowing.
Cabbages.
Solid heads,
free
placed one layer deep on slatted shelves properly arranged for good air
circulation.
Fig. 281.
R. tracks
relative
humidity
of
Ice
it
The bean
if
c
+
The
or even at 39 deg. F.
The sawtoothed
at 32 deg.
month
439
The northern
flat
and dried
fruits,
was
and
10 deg. F.
Plums.
variety. ^^
"
Cruess, Overholser,
F.) or higher.
324,
University of California
of California.
COLD STORAGE
440
cell sap within the tissue frozen to death was much higher than the Beckmann
measurements.
Various external and internal symptoms of frozen apples, such as changes in color,
the
Some
distinctions are
is still
present,
made between
frozen
or above.
Department
of Agriculture Bulletin
peratures of
Some
Fruits,
when
fruit or vegetable
products
Under
certain
many of these products can be undercooled; that is, cooled to a point below
the true freezing temperature of each and again warmed up without freezing and
without apparent injury. Certain products under certain conditions may be actually
conditions
frozen and then thawed out without apparent injury, while, on the other hand,
some
products are injured if stored at temperatures well above their actual freezing points.
Evidence seems to show that different individuals of the same variety and strain
when grown under different conditions will have somewhat different freezing points,
and that there are also some variations in the freezing points of products of the
lot.
In view of these facts the freezing points given in this bulletin should be considered only as danger points at or near which, either above or below, there is a
These are
possibility of freezing injury if exposed for a sufficient length of time.
temperatures at which it is unsafe to hold produce for any length of time, as serious
danger of frost
injurj^ exists.
moths and
Because
of the
damage from
has developed
441
The
at 40 deg. F.
all
movement
is
suspended.
TABLE
93
Summary of Averages
COLD STORAGE
442
w o ixijao
i2
6^^
p.-g ca'5 3
>>-o
uT.t.c
g c5^
-So "o.H
S 3 ^
13
C3
C
X .Th O
c
- - -
oj
o a-2 c ^
to
!^
2^
OJ :>
J
r^
8 a
g
o
22
.3 O..S
'-
SS
a.G a
S?qi:
3-0
g)
S'
0.
i5 til
c3
g"3
.S
5Ji
a.2_:
"S
tU
c a-B
=5
"^
S"^ "H c
a " S
Ms
.2^1
32^ .
o^S c
3 J=
=0.2
c-1
2 S o c
3=s^^
"3
" ~
2'3
2'3
.a -^
" o o
o
32
.9
a a-f^
|||-o
aa
>
g
3
ta"g
S c o
^-o
g = S =^
g2
a-2-d
~^^
TD
1^11:
bc
f mI
2 c
ca
J=
c3
C3
2 -s 5
a2
^2-a 2
a 0.2
9
a'a-o e.S,2
o ^i "Sis c
.g
3 o o
^-O_o
co"^
assJ'i.'
S M
ca
ca
o C
a
C Gj bt
c3
-o
2 -2'-^
a g o
2
t;
>. bo'g.g'-'
'
Js
caT3
" "-d3
gJ=-2^
M.2 a >>j=.2
<~
'^a s
" o
C C 3 a"?
ca
"g-o-a
^"Sm
c3
He
S
aa
==.2 g-s
o22_g
ca-a 3 "
ci^:^-M
>
*
c
*:*
^2btHSg-i:l-2Ea'
3 "
ca aS.^ o a
:g
B.2
XJ3 3 c p
'-ca't
2-^
^ a
?:i'^-a
5 2a.
E'3S
.,1,
^*"
S.a.!! 2-^
" O m
fei-1
5;
"^
hl5 .
t 2
="2
"r^-
M c a-
"S
2-|-2 g a>.
.2"3
oIj
==-0
fe-S'.ogg-=2 22s
2S2a-S.5g _5
all
.
"- o " o
5 ^ rt .^-a
u;
)g^-3
2a-sgae-agg2?'
2
^o
0-5 2
Ml
cs
O 3
c-o
<
Ml
3^-S g
J g a; 2
go
^ O o
"
g S
._
ti>'0 2 o gS
c3 ."S ^ a p. P m
^i-iJ
-t
o^
tfi e
-a -a.,
-^ S'S-o.^
S?-
o o
-OM^g-gcot;
ja'O
bL
O^
'"
''
.S3
tSfejq
D,'
;
a If
^U^""^"
JH
c c =
KM "
*^ CO
-^-o
c.B"
rt
-t:
tsB
"^
a t
3
,
^ M J''
-t^
S g-
'
a
t
2 <i'r;o
"
a S
bC
_,
=3
aj
23 o
2 bD
Om ^
S
'S
5 n S
p.
:|S.:5a|-Z;
.-fa
h a._.S a
'"
Jot. ^-g>2
"3
rt
i.-a
M ST. 5 *^^
"-
CO
G^
f^
53
S g O
443
COLD STORAGE
444
445
COLD STORAGE
446
The moth miller and the beetle are killed at a temperature of 40 deg. F.,
but relatively slowly, whereas at 32 deg. F. they are killed quickly. If
they are rolled up in rugs or garments they may be protected for weeks,
but the evidence is that no damage is done under the conditions of 32 deg.
to 40 deg. F. In fur or rug storage it is better to hang up the garment
and to lay the rug out in flat piles, and the temperature must be 40 deg.
or lower. The larvae may survive a temperature of 18 deg. F. for weeks,
but usually it may be killed if the temperature is permitted to rise to
45 to 50 degrees for a day or two and then lowered again. As a rule,
25 degrees
is
E. A.
of
Entomology, U.
S.
Department
of
Agriculture
Cold storage
Once
for
is
the best
in cold storage
stuffed animal heads, blankets, carriage robes, curtains, upholstered furniture, etc.
This is true because clothes moth larvae or worms cannot feed at temperatures
below 45 deg. F. A temperature range lower than one of 40 deg. to 42 deg. or 45
deg. F.
is
unnecessary.
of Agriculture,
against
why
them by
of the
days after removal from cold storage? The presence of living larvie
can be explained in two ways. First, larvi may have crawled to
the articles after they were removed from storage from other infested material in
the home, but this possibility is rather remote if living worms are detected within
several days; second, that while cold storage temperatures were sufficient to protect,
they were not sufficient to kill. Cold storage concerns should determinine in advance
as a matter of policy whether they offer a service of protection against damage for
the period of storage, or whether in addition to this they are to guarantee the
articles refrigerated to be free from living moths at the time they leave storage.
There is very little exact data on the effect of cold temperature upon the different
stages of clothes moths. Some years ago Dr. A. M. Reed, of the Security Storage
Company in Washington, D. C, conducted experiments in cooperation with Dr.
L. O. Howard, Chief of the Bureau of Entomology, which indicated that larvse of
the weVjbing clothes moth lineola biselliella can survive for a long time a temperature
of 18 deg. F.
No explanation was given of what a "long time" meant in actual
days. It was found, as has been discovered in the case of other insects, that it isn't
always the cold alone that kills, but the sudden fluctuations from a cold to a warmer
temperature and back to a cold temperature. These experiments, referred to above,
resulted in the present recommendation of the Department that to kill clothes moths
in storage the infested articles should be refrigerated at 18 deg. F. for several days,
then suddenly exposed for a short time to 50 deg. F., and then returned to 18 deg. F.,
and finally held permanently at about 40-45 deg. F.
articles several
in such articles
447
it is
sufficient to
three weeks; at 30-35 deg. F., in 26 days, and at 35-40 deg. F. in about one month.
But the older well-grown larvce are very resistant. While the.se well-grown larvse
were killed in 67 days when subjected to an even temperature of 20-25 deg. F.,
and in 93 days at 25-30 deg. F., others held at temperatures ranging from 30-35
deg. F. and 35-40 deg. F. are still alive after over four months.
The ability of well-grown larvai to withstand long periods of refrigeration at
moderate temperatures was demonstrated recently in a Washington plant whose
rooms were said to have had a temperature range of 24-48 deg. F., but with the
temperature mostly at about 40 deg. F. Larvae were removed after storage at the
end of 6, S, 10, 12, and 14 months. Storage for 6 to 8 months had no appreciable
effect upon larval mortality. After 10 to 12 months' storage, many larva? died soon
after removal, and only a few survived 14 months' storage.
Yet these few were
thoroughly normal, and upon being placed in a sufficiently warm temperature for
feeding, resumed activity and transformed the pupae and adults as though their life
had not been prolonged by an enforced 14-month hibernating period.
These facts are important for they explain why patrons have at times fovmd
living robust larvae in articles several days after removal from 4 to 5 months in
cold storage. If a fairly even temperature around 40 deg. F. has been maintained,
such a discovery is to be expected and is no reflection upon the storage firm. Experiments under way will determine definitely the effect of various temperature ranges
upon not only the eggs and the well-grown larvse, but upon the larvae of different ages.
The
fur storage
room
is
not opened to
is
nearly
all
the
the
require no
to be
is
made
joints
If
in.
with the
half-inch
ceiling.
very carefully protected so that the frostation on the pipes could never
drip on to the goods.
COLD STORAGE
448
one or two places, but the larger rooms need distributing ducts for the
Such ducts may, of course, be designed for
supply and the return.
high
2100
ft. per min., but as a rule lower velocities
as
velocities as
in
are used
from
Refrigeration
is
different
from heating and ventilation as regards the use of fans. The fan not
only uses power to drive the air, but the heat equivalent of the work
done must be neutralized by the use of the refrigeration machine.
Excess power supplied then is a double expense in the case of refrigerating
plants, and in fact there is required a i ton of refrigeration for every
horse power supplied to the fan.
Air fn
v/////////////////^/////////y//////////////////////A
Suction
gas to
"/V////////////////////////y////////y//'////y////y7^
Ammonia
coils in
bunker
v////////.
machine
Y
Air out
ryyyyyy/y///y////y//y/y//z^^ '/////////////////////////////////////////
/.
,vy/y/yy///y:
Expansion
valve
Door to bunker
Fig. 283.
The hunker is usually designed (as in the case of the chocolate dipping
spray chamber) for 550 ft. per min. air velocity, and the bunker is
usually arranged for three passes of the air, and in some of the constructions the baffles are used to catch the condensate and guide it to
the waste pipe. Where the size of the plant warrants it, there is no
reason
why
air.
now on
the market
As
air infiltra-
is
449
(Fig.
Ammonia
ammonia.
piping
is
now
pipe-coil
designed for
little
and
in this
TABLE
95
some idea of the large amount of fruits and vegetables consumed in the principal cities of the United States. While it is not known
just what proportion of these cars were refrigerated, it is presumed that
a very large percentage of them, owing to the character of the product
transported, were under refrigeration. The number of carloads unloaded
eration, give
Unloaded at
Boston
Chicago
Cleveland
Carloads
30,528
48,222
12,389
Cincinnati
10,573
Detroit
11,969
Kansas City
7,601
Minneapolis
3,797
New York
94,194
Philadelphia
28,559
Pittsburgh
20,145
Louis
Paul
Washington, D.
12,115
St.
St.
1,891
5,014
In the case of certain commodities the records and reports did not begin until
June
1,
1923.
From
one.
the foregoing
It is
it is
With
it
is
a small
depends on the
insulation provided.
is
COLD STORAGE
450
100
90
80
7.0
a>
.9-
60
a.
5D
4D
ao
(0
2.20
Often.
451
is
to
for not
when used
in
it is
Ozone ^^ will inhibit the development of spores but will not destroy mold growth. "Ozone is a prophylactic and not a remedial agent. It has been found by experiment
that air with a mild concentration of ozone has prevented mold growth
in egg storage carrydng a relative humidity of 90 per cent. In egg and
bacon rooms with very high humidity, molds have been effectively
inhibited.
Equally good results have been obtained in general cold
storage practice."
off
]\Ir.
its use.
Hartman
says that
all
non-odoriferous.
Ozone has been found satisfactory for freeing the
atmosphere of these gases, and thus preventing taste transfer or modification. Onions can be stored in the same room with fruits and vegetables
without transfer of taste, and it has been found possible to combat mold
formation on grapes and other fruits. In storage of such commodities
as cheese, the air in the room has been maintained fresh and free from
odors, whereas ozone itself has never caused deleterious effects on the
goods stored.
Calculating the Refrigerating Load. The refrigerating load is very
hard to calculate at times with accuracy, and so it has become the
custom of refrigerating engineers to use the method of the rule of
thumb. This is because there are so many variable factors which may
affect the machine capacity or the amount of piping in the room that
it has been found desirable to install the refrigeration or the piping
surface from experience with other and similar jobs where satisfactory
results have been obtained. For example, Fig. 284 gives a set of curves
of such an origin for different sizes of boxes and operating temperatrres
and conditions, such as whether the boxes are to be " opened frequently " or " seldom." It is quite evident that such curves have a
value, but the box that would be satisfactory in New York need not
necessarily be satisfactory in Alabama. These curves then are for the
practice on which they were based, and similar curves are sometimes
marked for " good insulation " and for " poor insulation." However,
the small cold storage box, say of 5000 cu. ft. interior contents and
^^F. E. Hartman,
November, 1924.
COLD STORAGE
452
900
800
700
600
tsoo
<
400
300
200
100
is
453
load to be encountered.
-. 14'-8-
Flaxlinum
1
Layer of paper
between
7 Flaxlinum
& keyboard
-xCemenl
stucco
3" Concrete
J^ 7
Triangle
mesh
of*3
2 Layers
felt
G
"2 Layers
D&M
fjl'l
^1
of papei
sheattiing
Layer of paper
^^
yMestiG. W. screen''^16"gauge
is
called for
same
is
to
Fig. 286.
Construction
of
[for
Problem].
has (unless built for some particular purpose) no well-defined load, and
so the surface installed in such boxes must be hberal.
cold storage
room
(Fig. 286),
on the contrary,
COLD STORAGE
454
is
more
Such a room
easily calculated.
is
likely to be of
permanent
estmiate of the heat leakage under the assumed conditions and then the
The following illustrative
refrigeration required to cool the "live load."
The
cold storage
Fig.
286.
The
20 barrels of apples.
50 barrels of potatoes.
20 cases of eggs (of 60
10 tubs of butter.
lb.).
The
The operating
as arriving at 80 deg. F.
Take the
specific
apples, potatoes
and eggs
will
be taken
heat of beef
apples
potatoes
butter
eggs
The
in
= 77
= 0.9'2
=0.80
= 60
=0.76
.
(average)
outside temperature will be taken at 90 deg. F., and the temperature in the beef
The first problem will be the
will be held at 33 degrees.
Wall "A
".
5 in. stucco,
This
and
is
composed
^ in.
"^
'^'
fci
^2
"^
Ci
"^
"*"
C,
Ci
^^'''
Ci
J_
1.4^4.2
Ceiling
"E."
2-|
in.
(i
+ i)X24
0.75
10
8.0
7.9
1.0
sheathing, 2-5
in. fla.xlinum,
and 8
J_
1_
1.4
4.2
(I
=
^)
7.9
24
9X24
X24
10
in.
0.03745.
shavings.
0.0397.
This
is
455
construction.
0.0397.
Floor "G."
1
1
0.93
4.2
0.03486.
3.0
H
10X24
8.0
10
0.03745
0.03486
0.0397
Ceilinc
0397
Side
Side (shipping room) 0.0397
Floor
X
X
X
X
X
(644
674
674
448
184
+
X
X
X
X
205
(90
(90
(33
(90
205) (90
= 2250
= 1340
= 1526
33)
33)
B.t.u.
B.t.u.
=0
B.t.u.
33)
33)
= 416
B.t.u.
= 5532
B.t.u.
33)
Total
Add 20
per cent
B.t.u.
1106
One end
0.03486
0.0397
0.03745
X
X
(448
X
X
464
203
(90
(90
Add
20 per cent
(464) (90
33)
33)
33)
Total
= 1474
= 922
= 1050
= 433
= 3879
B.t.u.
B.t.u.
B.t.u.
B.t.u.
B.t.u.
776 B.t.u.
The second problem is the calculation of the live load, The assumption
temperature of the commodities is reduced to 33 deg. F. in 24 hours.
Live Load
hr.
is
hr.
that the
COLD STORAGE
456
Piping required:
27,430
[1.6
(33.0
16.6)]
room 26,360
-=-
[1.6
(33.0
16.6)]
Meat room
Provision
The arrangement
An
= 1045
= 2405
= 1002
= 2320
by
sq. ft.
lin. ft.
U-in. pipe.
sq. ft.
lin. ft.
Fig. 287,
U-in. pipe.
coils.
and
of
27,430
machine becomes
+ 26,360 =
4.47 tons.
B.t.u.^''
The
12,000
found
(at
155
lb.
200
Volume
of gas
616.8
**
The value
and
is
6.35
4.47
low, but
is
139.
of 1 .6 for k
lb.
ft.
careless operation.
11.9 cu.
ft.
per min.
The
cross-
457
\3-3"x8"Y.P.
joists
2-2"x8"Y.P.
joists
5-94"x6"Girder/
^4-3"x4''posts
3 concrete
-l-Jt
Ceiling joist
Wood
Cross Section
Provision door
2'-6"x6'-0"
sleepers
C-D
9
^P-
ij
valve
-17-2"
2-2^^^ --4
Vi-t-^-
-5-11"-
Warm
r-
-^-3'-2--
->J^_-_5'-ii'i
-I
duct
air
^
^
(
IV4" Suet, riser to
Cold
mch.
air
in
basm't.
duct
Wy
Egg Storage
Fig. 288.
in
Pipe Deck.
458
COLD STORAGE
TABLE
96
459
TABLE 96 Continued
Cold Storage Practice
Temperature
cf Storage,
Degrees F.
Humidity,
Per Cent
Allowances
35
32 to 34
30 to 31
2 or lower
30 to 35
34
34
35
80 to 90
70 to 80
75
70
85
80 to 90
80 to 90
80
Aisles
1
1
1
1
1
Allow
Allow
Allow
Specific gravity of
11.9
144
ft.
high).
per cu.
lb.
= 0.428
sq.
ft.
in.,
and as the
f-in.
4000
pipe has a transverse area of 0.533 and the ^-in. pipe has one of 0.304 sq.
|-in.
tions
in.
the
pipe would be the one to be chosen for satisfactory results unless the connec-
and
it
uneconomical to
Such plants, if
considerable temperature rise is to be prevented, require under these
conditions either brine operation and a brine tank of sufficient storage
capacity to carry the load during periods of shut-down of the compressor,
or must provide some auxihary means to absorb the heat leakage during
it
is
amount
of brine
is
same time
than a tank, in which case the pipes are filled with brine. If in the previous problem the provision room was to be controlled during 12 hours by
the brine pipe the leakage would be (for 70 deg. F. average temperature
outside) 2520 B.t.u. per hour,
30,240 B.t.u.
If
the brine
is
and
in 12
COLD STORAGE
460
the
room
(that
is
to 13 deg. F.),
amount
= Weight X 0.83 X
30,240
Weight
and using a
of brine
of brine
30,240
12.45
15.
2430
lb.,
2430
H-
(1.16
62.3)
33.7
cu.
ft.
Brine cooler
Fig. 289.
Problem
in
TABLE
Refrigerated Space
Summary by
Brine Piping.
97
1,
1925
Number
Ciass of Business
cerns
Total
of
Con-
10 Deg. F.
and below
416
264
41,311,130
3,288,072
212
397
11,530,051
34
4,142,218
1323
68,721,782
8,450,311
29 Deg. F.
30 Deg. to
44 Deg. F.
inclusive
inclusive
11 Deg. to
45 Deg. F.
Space
and above
20,196,430 175,244,429
5,313,301 14,291,508
5,811,924 242,563,913
1,172,946 24,065,827
36,383,333
1,027,711 57,034,780
23,150,561 246,165,622
11,173,425
16,458,902 195,026,108
6,272,375
41,067,020
59,414,433 462,012,398
5,355,995
56,837,608
36,519,137 626,667,750
'
of hold-over brine
If 8-in.
pipe
and the
is
461
can be calculated
ft.
be 97.1.
Friction
Head
in refrigeration
in Brine Pipes.
it is
surprising
how
little
Fig. 290.
loss
is
temperature.
'5
1914,
The
results of
been
collected.
The only
specific gravity
COLD STORAGE
462
fT
Fig. 292.
To
One
--r^,
12 pipes wide x 3
K92'0'long = 3312'-03
coil
_>ll^
<:rlj
Fig. 293.
Typical PipingAmmonia.
To fac9 page
463.
\
\
463
shown
Problem. A brine coil of 10,000 lin. ft. of 2-in. pipe is located on the 10th
warehouse. The brine circuit consists of the following: The refrigerating
coils, of 2-in. pipe, 10,000 lin. ft. in 10 coils; distance from the brine cooling coils to
riser, 108 lin. ft. 3-in. pipe; the riser, 121 lin. ft. 3-in. pipe; riser to brine cooler
and pump, 75 lin. ft. 3-in. pipe; total pipe in the circuit, 10 coils of 2 in. each
1000 ft. and 304 ft. of 3-in. pipe.
The freezer room is to be maintained at 32 deg. F. and the brine will enter at
18 degrees and will leave at 22 degrees. The coefficient of heat transfer will be taken
at 1.7 B.t.u. for the piping. The amount of brine to be circulated, the friction
head loss and the horse power of the pump assuming an overall efficiency of 50 per
cent is desired. The arrangement of the piping is indicated in Fig. 290.
The amount of brine to be circulated may be found by the amount of cooling
surface.
Using a value of A; = 1.7 B.t.u., the total refrigeration becomes (10,000
22
18\
/
~
= 127,400 B.t.u. per hour where the factor 1.6
4-1.6) X 1 .7 X (32
)
floor of a
+
2
is
the
number
one
127,400
Wt. = 127,400
=
=
wt. brine
41,900
72.7
(0.76
4-
(62.4
gal.
76
X
X
sq.
ft.
of outside surface.
4.
4)
41,900
1.15)
lb.
584 cu.
ft.
per hour
per minute.
From
the chart it will be seen that at a velocity of 3.4 ft. per sec. a 3-in. pipe will
have a pressure drop per 100 ft. of pipe of
72 lb. (for water) and the friction head
loss in the cooling coils (7.3 gal. per min. in 2-in. pipe) will be 0.072 lb. per 100 ft.
The total friction head loss is then,
.
0.072
(2
108 -h 2
121
100
75)
1.3
0.72
10
1.3
Total
Add 20
fittings, etc.
Total
Work performed =
(41,900 4-60)
11,200
4-
16.0
33,000
= 0.935
1b.
5.69
= 6.63 1b.
= 1 .33
= 8.0 1b.
= 11,200 ft.-lb.
= 0. 340 hp. for circulating the brine.
= 0.680 hp. of the pump assuming
50 per cent efficiency.
This work performed is under the conditions of a balanced system for the brine.
Certain types and designs are shown in Figs. 290 to 293. When the open brine design
is used with sprays, the head on the pump is the actual lift plus the friction and the
velocity heads. The work performed is then much greater.
COLD STORAGE
404:
of the Industry.
amounts
to 258,549,000 cu.
cu.
ft.
ft.
packing
Of the
and 200,000,000
from 30 to 44
same authority,
is 543,600,000 cu. ft.
Of this. Armour and Company have 17,000,000
cu. ft. in Chicago, and 9,500,000 cu. ft. in Kansas City, requiring 4380
and 3120 tons of refrigeration respectively; Morris and Company
have 13,000,000 cu. ft. in Chicago and 8,000,000 cu. ft. in Kansas City,
requiring 3450 and 2100 tons of refrigeration respectively.
Published statistics by the Bureau of Animal Husbandry of the
United States Department of Agriculture, 1921, indicate that a total of
The
deg. F.
cu.
ft.
At
39,000,000 hogs.
least
meat
is
consumed
is less
is
is
very
held in freezer
storage.
applications of refrigeration.
the
chill-
ing of the hot freshly slaughtered animals and the maintaining of cold
or freezer storage. In general " forced " draft or the forcing of chilled
air
it
is
and because
and the
"
modified system using " sprays
is
duct system.
The use
is
One
is
found in the packing plant. Also the long pipe systems represent a heavy
investment of ammonia a large part of which would be lost (with a
-I 10 05
I
77
7
bC bC
'O'O
aS
.'K.S
300
2
3 3
X
aa
-SSE
<o
il
0)
a)
.2
465
COLD STORAGE
466
forced shut-down)
by accident
well as likelihood of
piping
is
necessary, a
When brine
is
When
cheaper.
is
friction only.
By
to
the proper use of the balance tank, the pipes are kept
to 25
lb. for
The
pump
has
This
is
have brine
defrosting pipes, in which case some form of concentrator should be
provided in order to conserve the salt. One method of removing the
called a closed brine sj^stem.
frost is to
arrange a slotted
defrosting
is
possible
2-in. brine
by permitting brine
to drop
from pipe to
pipe.
Heavy
frost
a time.
accumulations are very detrimental to heat transfer, and the refrigeris thereby reduced. At times one hears that as the outside
becomes larger the total transfer of heat must remain practically constant. The same argument would be true in the case of pipe
covered with magnesia or corkboard (as far as the outside diameter of
the surface is concerned) The brine flowing over the pipes must be kept
ating ability
of the pipe
is an advantage at times in
tank at a point best located to receive the drain
from the brine spray nozzles. The closed pipe portion also empties into
the tank and a booster pump supplies the extra pressure required for the
Any open
99
467
;;
COLD STORAGE
468
Chilling.
The best
practice at present
rooms
in the chill
is
have been
air is
F.,
a half
and an
attempt
The
made
is
feeling prevails in
ones
is still
permit
heavy
it.
cattle should
fore-cooler,
if
be 18
in.
it is
12
in.
favored by
many
apart in the
if
chill
space will
rooms, but
The
43 degrees
cooler
it
is
should be held at a
If
the
maximum
Pork
is air
degree
Mutton and
room which
temperature
is
is
rule of
is
two hours
not allowed to
The
The
thumb.
refrigeration
rise
at least),
and
is
same
hung
above 38 degrees.
as beef.
in a 32-
This room
Refrigeration.
by
first
^^ is
is
usually
number
of animals
slaughtered daily:
5 to 6 cattle at 700 1b.;
40 to 50 calves at 80 lb.
15 to 22 hogs at 225 1b.;
50 to 65 sheep at 60 lb.
1000 to 1300 chickens at 3
This
Where
the piping
Warm
is 2-in.
beef cooler
lb.
insulated.
requires
is:
469
rough rule requires one ton of refrigeration per 7000 to 12,000 cu. ft.
space at 33 to 38 deg. F. As an illustration of the working of these
rule-of-thumb rules, the following may be taken as an example:
Find the refrigeration required for 100 cattle daily killed, and hanging space for 400 cattle, 6500 sq. ft. of cooler space required with 33 ft.
ceiling or 143,000 cu. ft. of space; for 250 hogs daily or 750 hanging
space allowing 3000 sq. ft. at 18 ft. ceiling or 54,000 cu. ft. and a storage
for a total turnover in 60 days (storage for 1,500,000 lb. of meat product)
of
''|\~
V/"
Section A-
Fig. 294.
As a by-product there
will
ft.
of floor
be 10,000
lb.
and 200,000
cu.
ft.
of space.
lard daily.
Tons
143,000 cu.
ft.
of beef cooler at
10,000
lb. of
100,000 cu.
ft.
14.3
ft
12.2
1
ft
ft
tons of refrigeration
30
12.0
.
5.4
10.9
16.6
35
ft
Total
136.4
In all likehhood rough rules like the preceding have been satisfactory
inasmuch as the refrigeration supplied would be much greater than the
actual requirements in order to permit the installation of sufficient spares
to insure continuity of operation in the time of breakdown.
It seems
however, that in the future the refrigeration requirements will be
more carefuUy calculated, i.e., a determination of the heat leakage and
likely,
Brine sprays have been used in the packing plant for years with
varying success. The older designs used a semi-sohd spraj^ which provided circulation but was not
large
amount
of
steam
is
efficient.
thrown
off into
During the
the
air,
chilling process a
COLD STORAGE
470
loss of
an example
of the
Plan
Fig. 295.
The Spray System. The best results with sprays^'^" are obtained
with atomizing nozzles. With such sprays, hogs dressed at 225 lb. can be
chilled to inside ham temperatures of 36 deg. F. in 24 hours with 25 deg.
Beef can be
brine, using 30 lb. suction pressure at the compressor.
chilled to
from 34 to 36 deg. F.
(inside) in
36
hr. using
weak
brine or possi-
bly water sprays at 33 degrees and at a great saving in the shrinkage. The
great advantage in the use of sprays is the quick removal of the moisture
in the air, the rapid circulation
American Society
objection
is
471
Up
the meat.
chill
rooms
been
found
sprays of
has
not
and the
practical,
that
suit is
(NaCl)
In
re-
brine
salt
always used.
is
order
decrease
to
the hu-
the shrinkage
midity
to the
water in the
present,
kept as high
is
as possible, requiring a
low
concentration
salt
and
m=st
therefore
rela-
Bloom
Mr.
advo-
^"^
__""
"-L-
r--t"^t=_,
made
be
the loft
pro-
to the load,
portional
the deck
the width of
of
siders
should
it
never be over 6
than 2
less
ft.
nor
ft.
(because
of insulation difficulties
and
waterproofing
the deck).
of the
two openings
deck
the
should
equal to the
of
The width
in
be
loft height,
in.
of
waterproofed
be
very
carefully.
The
dirt
in
difficulty
the
with
brine
is
472
COLD STORAGE
PQ
THE SPRAY SYSTEM
brine pressure at the nozzle should be from 9 to 2
473
lb.
per sq,
in.
mini-
mum
if
30
ft.
The height
of
the
ft.
per
spray
above the deck and the velocity of the air are the determining factors
as regards the width of the deck.
To cool the brine the shell and tube brine cooler is the preferred
means because of its great flexibility, high heat transfer and relative
lack
of
resistance
to brine flow
number
are
if
the
of
passes
small.
The
shell
/I^f%~"^^^^'*
'^'^'"^
^"^"^ P.^'^P
Air separating
and tube as
brine
pipe
cooler
be watched
must
to
pre-
injury
due
carefully
vent
to freezing of
should
brine
pump
stop.
coolers
the
the
Inverted weir
These
when placed
made
be
vided
safe pro-
Fig.
a means of
is
of
the stopping of
pump.
let it
COLD STORAGE
474
D='
3="
0)
HDJ:
2
tu
k- 02
3
C
01 .21Q.
m
c
o
"to
3?:
will rise in
salt brine
temperature to 35 degrees.
The
will
be made use
38)
cal-
To
cool the
meat
50
750
0.77
475
(90
and
of.
1,501,500 B.t.u.
10.43 tons
culated
if
etc.,
kno\\'n
Total
were
2 09 tons
12.52 tons
Allowing 12 sq.
per animal there will be required 12 X 50 = GOO S(i ft. floor and
a room 20 ft. by 30 ft. will answer the conditions.
The usual distance between
ft.
rails is
in.,
ft.
The amoinit
Wt.
Wt.
0.892
of brine per
rail to
the floor 11
ft.
in. (Fig.
299).
foUows:
= 12.52 X 200
= 2504 B.t.u. (per minute)
minute = 2504 -^ 2.676 = 936 lb.
Using a specific gravity of the Lrine of 1.066, the gallons of brine required will ha
936 ^ (8.33 X 1.066) = 1C5.4. I i;der a head of 13. C5 ft. (6.0 lb.) the No. 30
Webster nozzle will deliver 1 gal. jer rr.in. and there will therefore be required
105 nozzles.
The maximum spacing cf the nozzles is 20 in., so the placing of these
four high on 10-in. centers, and 26 stands equally spaced horizontally (less than
14 in. apart), will be a good distribution. The height of the deck will be 3 ft. 6 in.,
and this will also be the size of the two openings in the deck. This will provide a
vigorous circulation of the air of about two changes per minute, there being no
choking at any point.
Lard and Compound Cooling. Lard weighs about 59 3 lb. per cu. ft.,
is from 0.5 to 0.6 depending on the fluidity, and the
latent heat is 90 B.t.u. per lb. The melting point is usually understood
to be 70 deg. F. for lard and 105 deg. for tallow.
Lard compound, a mixture of hog fat with beef fat and cottonseed
oil, has a specific heat of from 0.3 to 0.5 depending on its fluidity, a
latent heat of 90 B.t.u. per lb. and a specific gravity of
92 (57 5 lb. per
.
cu. ft.).
COLD STORAGE
476
and other fat parts of the hog are steamed in a rendering tank under
40 lb. steam pressure for some 7 to 9 hours. It is then mixed with
fuller's earth for a few minutes, and next filtered by passing it through
a filter press. The resulting hot, white lard is stiffened by adding not
more than 5 per cent of lard
then by cooling
stearine, and
mechanically.
fat,
Compounds
are
cottonseed
oil
In making such a
fined fats
made
using beef
and pork
fat.
compound the
filtered,
re-
and
The drum
the
chills
warm
fluid
compound.
and non-uniformity
revolving drum,
cooled with brine or ammonia,
freezes a thin layer of lard or comfreeze out first
=5:2
would
=
^sess
s
^ =^g s^
fe
tQ
jq
Sq "in "co
r^
JO
"-)
to
"r^
oo
The
CT>
after the
E E
E E E E E E
result.
^^^
adjusted
knife scrapes
surface.
The
it
off
the
semi-solid substance
Also
let it
handle 10,000
lb.
of lard in four
0.6
(80
30)
10,000
300,000
-^
90
12,000
=
=
=
size of
477
Adding 10 per cent for losses = 27.5 tons of refrigeration required. As the
10 deg. F., a zero degree boiling
compressor will be required to cool brine to
temperature of the ammonia will be required, and this corresponds practically to
15 lb. gage pressure suction to the compressor. With such a suction pressure there
would be required 4.63 cu. ft. piston displacement per ton of refrigeration per
minute using a volumetric efficiency of 0.83 and the piston displacement for 27 5 tons
Feed
Jacketed trough
line
Fig.
would be 128
cu.
per min.
ft.
of cylindrical drums,
it
2500
This
lb.
per hour.
The
roll
301. Assembly
of
Lard
Rolls.
will
Refrigerator Car.
It
The
less
than 1/50
in.
is
Mixing tank
Mixing tank
Chilled lard
//////^i///'/.
'Coolingcylinder
ing cylinder
Fig. 302.
Lard Manufacture.
For an average
of 70 degrees outside
and 40
corkboard.
^^
W. H. Winterrowd
^^
in.
of
COLD STORAGE
478
per sq.
2
ft.
The vahie
per 21 hours.
air spaces
for 3-in.
corkboard alone
is
about
rail
hangers^
Timber
Fig. 303.
refrigerator car
Overhead Conveyor.
comparable, however,
service.
Fig. 304.
Next
Air Circulation
to heat transfer
is
in a Refrigerator Car.
the
479
method
is the ice bunker at the two ends of the car, and the later design
embodies a brine tank built into the roof at each end of the car, the two
tanks being connected by pipes hung some two or three inches beneath
the ceiling and so arranged that check valves in the tanks which are
operated by the swaying of the car causes a positive flow of the brine.
Ice and salt, of course, are charged into the tanks.
The advantages
claimed are more economy of space, and more even car temperatures.
It is
car
is
is still.
TABLE
[By the U.
S.
Bureau
100
of Agriculture
Economics]
of
Carloads
Commodities
1920
1917
191S
1919
Apples
Asparagus
57,048
68,840
81,552
102,962
1,057
1,120
1,101
1,034
Cabbage
20,354
17,430
28,661
13,619
24,982
22,039
31,020
22,377
31,718
25,569
1,535
2,.540
3,410
7,412
6,449
9,308
12,483
3,895
897
680
1,025
1,870
3,711
2,757
4,306
136
Cantaloups
Carrots
Cauliflower
Celery
Cherries
Cranberries
90,498
101,780
746
40,065
29,917
127,505
36,395
25,839
1,987
14,151
10,624
3,991
4,714
2,447
2,009
Cucumbers
Eggplant
Grapes
300
30,349
8,018
20,874
30,923
10,158
1,170
913
3,125
3,222
4,430
8,898
9,254
13,725
144,656
1,278
169,462
2,422
15.065
14,115
15,471
181,277
2,957
8,105
14,503
16,254
179,149
8,804
11,933
20,302
30,860
11,468
Spinach
Strawberries
s
6,151
20,915
6,959
22,027
20,409
10,311
691
21,379
5,428
19,152
27,237
Lettuce
Onions
Peaches
Pears
Green pons
Peppers
Tomato'
1922
8,452
39,205
13,818
25,950
26,967
14,950
37,202
18,616
23,319
27,300
12,821
271
59,858
22,840
27,563
38,291
20,138
64,020
29,493
20,747
33,630
18,144
278-
2,322
2,687
8,490
15,556
19,071
219,426
4,924
10,095
17,199
Turnips
5,021
20,570
245,221
5,205
18,716
26,668
6,786
19,793
238,983
7,682
17,775
24,002
835
Mi.\cd vegetables.
Watermelons
Deciduous fruits:
31,503
12,740
39,255
15,810
40,403
Mi.\ed
19,676
47,000
24,016
35,405
8,009
8,998
14,182
19,150
9,875
8.668
74,948
Citrus fruits:
Grapefruit
393
401
5,C50
6,624
12,086
Lemons
6,913
8,823
Oranges
5,437
28,444
12,275
11,887
65,891
46,.526
3,351
49,321
3,024
9,718
53,041
3,902
5,716
2,088
489,236
580,026
050,179
718,784
844,191
Miscellaneous.
413,484
Incomplete.
860,317
480
COLD STORAGE
cases,
side, and when more cars than this number arrive in a single train, it is
customary, after splitting the train into two groups of cars which are placed on each
side of the dock, to ice the group having the surplus cars first, and then while icing
on each
the other group of cars on the opposite side of the dock, the switching crew
moves
into
place the hang-over or surplus cars, which are in turn iced without cessation of the
entire operation or delay in the work of the icing crew.
if
size,
the
required to ice vegetable or fruit train with cake ice varies from
2^ minutes for each car, according to the amount of ice required in each bunker,
while for icing of meat cars with crushed ice 2 J minutes per car is a good average
time because of the fact that additional time is required in draining the ice compartment of a meat car and working down the ice which may remain in the same,
preparatory to the reception of additional crushed ice.
1 to
The
latter
is
now
obsolete
on account
481
5..21
Fig. 305.
-^
for the tj'pes, the slatted design giving the better results as would be
expected since air can travel to the middle of the car whereas it becomes
The
is
The
the
is
general tendency
modern
trend.
COLD STORAGE
482
The
307.
board
is
In the paper by
is
usual.
W. H. Winterrowd
it
CT3
to
ao
OO:
QJ
:o O.QQ zE .2 <3
i^ J3
=3 .^
.m ao^
"
s:
483
American Association of Ice and Refrigeration, quotes some figures from railway
equipment register concerning the number of refrigerator cars in operation. The
figures are as follows:
U.
S.
Railroads
32,773
94,007
Meat Packers
18,650
5,855
Canadian Railroads
Mexican
6,093
Total
157,380
Installed in Service:
First 9 mos.
1923
1924
7,570
3,801
14,508
7,875
22,078
11,678
Railroads
Private
Total
first
number
nine
months
be quite an
Many
Mechanical Refrigeration.
with improved fan ventilation for cooling the water. This would enable
the water to be conserved and at the same time would permit better
heat transfer in the condenser..
Precooling of Fruits and Vegetables.
tables are shipped
carry.
If
by means
the fruit
freight car
it
down
when loading
into the
to a temperature of 40 to 45 deg. F.
is
and
in
warm
fruits
from three to
many
is
Most
of refrigerator cars
Bureau
is
of Plant Industry,
Department
of Agriculture.
484
COLD STORAGE
upper layers
have a secondarywith
as compared
the
spoiled, or
of packages
quality
ends of the
Not only
by the
car.
spoil
fungi,
but the
For example,
temperature.
is
it
the increase
same
in the
interval of time.
ment
volves the
in-
impor-
following
tant phases:
a.
The development
of a
Means
of
properly pre-
Economical
means
of
The importance
precooling
or
of proper
icing
or
both
can be well
brought out by
the history of the expansion
and
development
of
the
Pacific
Fruit
Express
pany as an example
Com-
what
done in
that respect in the last 20
the
years.
industry
has
of
Union
Pacific
485
owned 6600
Pacific Railroads)
refrig-
and which required for the purpose 1,600,000 tons of ice. At first a
large amount of the ice used in the car bunkers was natural ice, but this
was found to be uneconomical and not dependable, so that in 1921
about two-thirds of the ice was manufactured. In 1922 the Pacific
Fruit Express Company had a daily capacity of 3500 tons of ice making
and storage capacity for 230,000 tons located at 12 ice plants (that is
in addition to 5 natural ice plants
Side Elevation
Cross Section
Fig. 309.
ice
The standard
trains
are 14
icing platform
on each
ft.
The
side.
high and 14
and change
in loading
of engine
its
ment, receives
is
ft.
The
train
is
and caboose.
is
It is
the car
added to carry
it
in California (1924)
cleaned thoroughly
then sent to the point of ship-
ice is
wooden construction,
moved by means of an
as follows
salt.
is
The procedure
where enough
total of
a refrigerator car
and receives
of 46,000 tons,
is
is
and
is
made up
all
into trains
From
486
COLD STORAGE
PRECOOLING
487
show
ice
and
salt loading
Precooling.
The development
has been
means
of precooling.
(1927)
the
or
air
other-
After
wise.
the
proper temperature
is
loaded
precooled
re-
ing
been
iced
a,
sufficient length of
time previously to
cool the car prop-
The second
erly.
means
ing
is
precool-
of
the carriers'
precooling
By
this
that
is
the
loaded with
design.
meant
car
is
warm
are
cooled
mechanicallJ^ Such
-Railway car-
citrus
originates,
Sectional Elevation
Fig. 311.
fruits)
as
for
air.
Finally there
lettuce.
is
is
means of
method of pre-
cooled by
the third
COLD STORAGE
488
is
quickly.
In
is
In this
(NaCl)
locality salt
brine
air,
about 15
by 9
ft.
about 200
of
The usual
moves the
the
air
ft.
per min.
eliminator
then
is
overhead
designed for 1000
minute velocity.
Precooling.
ing
of
vided
versing the motor drive on the fan.
(Figs.
The
air
is
re-
through
Fig. 312.
by 9
ft.
ft.
passed
ducts
ft.
per
Reversis
pro-
usually
is
directed
by means
room, resulting in an
air circulation
was applied
of the crates of
is
Gay found
1" J.
1924.
known
that
W. Andrews,
The temperature
an average temperature
was
best as the
all
40 degrees.
36 deg. F.
The Carriers^ Precooler.
cold air
of baffle curtains
air pressure
Gay
freight cars,
333'jl^QP]^JP!^l^J'1%- 39'.4"
kElim.
chamber
5'
high>kr
.,,...
^^BR^'
Eliminator
FiQ. 313.
*"=^c"hamber''
To
MARINE REFRIGERATION
489
would permit a
loss of
need to be " balanced " as far as the pressure in the center of the car is
concerned. To do this a pressure fan as well as an exhaust fan is required
and adjustment is made so that on opening the center door no blast is
noticed in either direction although from 6000 to 8000 cu. ft. of air per
minute
is
and iced
in 5 hours.
The
ft.
The
brine itself
Gay system
Marine Refrigeration.
limitations imposed
the ship
is
on
in 1924.
Marine refrigeration
of air per
fully chilled
ft.
maximum and
itself.
It
is,
is
an application
of course, restricted
of the
by the
The
result
is
at
that refrigerating
need to be designed so as to take general cargoes, and the hatchways must be made large enough for the purpose. In general, a well
designed banana carrier (as far as refrigeration is concerned) will be
vessels
satisfactory also for cariying citrus fruits, but the longer the trips the
for carrying
chilled
for
for
Insulation.
Insulation
^o
usually
may
is
When the insulation is all cork, the sides and the overhead consist of an
exposed finished layer of wood boards, two layers of 2-in. corkboard,
one layer of boards and paper with the space between them, and the
ship's side filled with granulated cork.
Wlien mineral wool is used as the main insulation it consists of wool
between an exposed finished layer of wood boards and the ship's sides
For the intermediate and the weather decks the insulation
is placed underneath, whilst for the tank top or the floor of the hold it
has to be capable of carrying the weight of the cargo. In these latter
of the deck.
2"
COLD STORAGE
490
cases the insulation
and with a
Marine
is
usually from 5 to 6
in.
refrigeration
1.
in
2.
lated.
The cargo
ventilation.
3.
is
is
heavily insu-
minimum
which is heavily piped under the ceilings, and the meat to be supported
by the deck girders by means of the usual meat hooks running on rails.
As temperature changes are not permissible beyond a small limit, the
piping controls must be good.
4.
However,
this division is
other three.
Banana
carriers
require considerably
more
refrigerating
capacity
than meats and other cargoes because as a rule the banana is not precooled, but the cargo and the hold should be precooled whenever possible.
The ship should be capable of carrying apples and citrus fruits. The
temperature required for bananas is 53 to 55 deg., for oranges 42 to
45 deg., for lemons 55 deg., and for apples 32 to 33 deg. F., with particular attention to the ventilation.
air circulation
The
refrigerating
load consists of the heat leakage, the cooling of the cargo and the cooling
and to
keep the carbon dioxide content of the air in apple storage at 10 per
cent or less. Figure 314 gives a good idea of the methods used in such
work. Bunker rooms appear to be used entirely, contrary to the practice
in stationary work, where the water or brine spray is used frequently.
MARINE REFRIGERATION
eral survey
and summary
491
by a
scientific
expe-
A synopsis
of 1922,
although a record
in
point of the
num-
ber of cases shipped, was in some ways one of the most disappointing in the history
of the industry.
Of the
in
it
has been
fruit
Fig. 314.
sound
market value
for
of 250,000.
The
for
fruit at the
Tasmania.
This type of damage,
scientific investigation.
it
actual appearance,
by
(b)
(c)
poi't
its
COLO
402
Tlic cvidciH'c
UiuH
voyimc,
l.lifi.t/
lii<^
of
V(;nl.ilut,i<)ii
d;ing(!r of tlw-
ol)l,!i,i(ic(l
UuU. brown
irHJi(!H,t.(rH
hold, ;ind
jirnoiint, of
h;i,t,
.such
[)0!ir(i
!i,r(!
it,
(luit, ;i,lrc!i,(]y
Hhip
diirinji;
lh<'
pufjIiHlwd,
lioincwjinl
conilitionH cnn hf
a-gairiHt
(^ii;ud<'<J
and
ull
vi'iilil.'it
'I'lii.s
in
inii
fiisl
dipcndH
pl!u;(!
upon
ni;i,iidy
tJic
rale
<>!
upon:
()
'V\i(',
(li)
TIk! inlien^id,
re,s|)irat,ory activit.y of
on
iw <U;vf\()]H:<l
occurring; cliniiiKUcd.
di.si':isi''K
'I'lIK
TIk;
l,li(!
licurt,
llif
carbon dioxide
hy
.S'lXJRAGE
'J'he tcrn[)eni,t
t,h(!
difTfwerit, vari(^t,ieH);
The Hceond
variable,
aiiioiinl
tli<'
<(f
of
t.liesc;
v;diie,M of
iiilcnt ion.'il
largo,
'I'cwnperature,
DegncH
1''.
is
<l:iv
wiiiild
MioHpliiM't
nil
lo
licrcrdic
lioiil
Id
hy
wliicli
liy
lioiil
il
,sii('li
well l\no\\ii
is
il
propoil
Tlic
J.
Oh'
111'
of
llic rali' ol
in
ii^i'
(In-
ion, ;iiid
il.'ii
il
liold.
con
nil
rnoi,
'iiN
of iippics in slor!i^;f
lilV
ripcimif!,
piolon^i'd nioic or
is
trinprral inc.
I
mold dcvclopinciil
of
on
of
llic .skiii
of the
of the
lo
ii'^i,ard
he
fiiiil,
llic
'I'iiis
is
spores of
lar(i;cly
l>llll^;;
Icmpcral
lo Ml! de>;.
fiiiil
llicsc
wliicli
fiiiit!;i,
are
iiij^
arc Ihcreforc:
lire
lo
!''.
;i
aiKl
de^;.
wilh the
I'',
possilile
leasl
delay
with
ail
known. The
and the size of
almosl, solid
may
Mock
to
liiis
I'cmovcd
lie
to a carrying l('in|)eriitiire of
siil)se(iuentiy
at,
p!;cnei'ii.t.i'(l
li;i
iird
of
ij'i
dcy,.
!''.
-M
I<>
*\ii:[,.
I'.
hroiii^h-
IIk' V()yilK<'.
t.o
l.inii'
the
nieiiiiH of overcouiiii).';
licst.
Today,
hold employed.
llic
fed
ciiliic
liy
rcfrij.';c rated
and
I''.,
a.
is aliout.
voy;it!;c
as
urcii.t. lis
Ih.'il
his
space
is
7(1
<\r^!i.
I'.
of iiv<'rane length.
the amount,
say from
diiriiifz;
IIk'
liy
that,
of :ip|)lc cases.
155 dep;.
removed
\h'
any
and
dilliciillies
'aJciilatioiiH
of heat. whi(!h
on
llic ;i\<ra^'c
heinji;
Ihrcc or
four times as
lar):;cly
(.
iiof yet
is
sea.,
hroiin'lioii
dillicultics
Iliese
uniform lenipernl
of a
ial|^^,o,
diflicuil ies
approximal ion
the
iincciil
vcid
ii'niil.'ilr
siiniciciil..
lilnsplicrc iicr
results olilaincd
(i;real
lrii^;;lli
ol
The mainleiiancc
llic liulk
li("
II
)!;allicriiifi;.
'I'iic
I
(Icsidcrala wilh
('(Mtiinj!;
2.
oul
is
dioMdc
ii
tissues.
afler
Kills
'rioMi'i'iKAi'iiui';
a icdiK'lioii in
cliccUiii(i;
and invMilinn he
1.
II II
hold
lie
iiisl iiiiiicni.s
li\
loll
invnrialil.N' prcseiil
The
iiiiisl
|i((ccsscs.
ilal
lli.'il
loii.'ili'iy
A rclardal
1.
lip of all
list
f.l'
(.iilnui
'I'lic
nil'.
mIdhc hriiin
mKiij^c
l>
I'l
IktiiioiikIcim.
I'lioiii.i'.M
Irss
Ircsli
;il
1(1,(1(10 cil.
csscnliMl lo luixc
I
lie .'iccidciil
rc|(l;ic((l
lie
lir
Ill
iicci'ssMiy,
ln'
Kill hi: IS
;i|)|)i';irs lli.'il
indicilor
llic
is
1,1
il
li;i\('
iii.'iy
liiild
/\l
(III
(dlirr ciiscs,
Ill
in;{
loaded warm,
(j;rea,t.
'i'lie
lii.al.
liiil
.also
the
voyage.
'I'lie
const
riictinf!;
throughout,
was olilaincd
tliree-dimensional tcmpcral
tla^
voy.anc.
II
me
la
ii(.';e
of
carj^o
cmper.a
lo
lire
tin'
some
exieni hy the
nia|)s of
(he hold,
additional
iinliii'cl
at.
iidva,nlafi;e of
ion
over
111'
li.as
melhoil of
diffd'cnl
linicH,
yielding direct,
hold
(in
departure
reached a
Hl('a.(ly
st.!i,t.e.
'I'lie
results ohtained
Hynt,eins in
'I'Ik!
use atiain
a,
down
doiiht
is
tli.at
slip;ht
niodidcal ion
in
'i'lierc
coiisidcrahlc improvciiicnl
in
COLD STORAGE
494
this respect.
Each
technical problem
a problem
of detail.
own
particular
promoting both quick cooling and uniform temperature appear to be (1) roof grids
vertical dunnage or (2) high velocity, alternating, transverse, cold air draughts
with transverse dunnage.
and
Chilled meat
is
1^-16--^ Loss
Fig. 315.
in rail
capacity
meat by means
rails and piping.
of battens.
coils
The General Carrier. The general carrier must have space for
usual commodities, and be arranged to provide two temperatures.
all
MARINE REFRIGERATION
495
Mechanical Equipment. Lloyd's requirements specify sufficient tonnage to maintain the necessary temperature with 18 hours' operation.
The capacity of the refrigerating machine using carbon dioxide while
operating in the tropics
is
316 gives an idea of the ratio of the storage space to the tonnage required,
allowing for the reserve specified by Lloyd's, under nominal speed of
The kind of refrigerant used on shipboard is not
the compressor.
COLD STORAGE
49G
<y\
MARINE REFRIGERATION
497
rt
fc
E~^
COLD STORAGE
498
DISTRICT COOLING
Pipe
and
is
commission
district,
in order to pick
do not
lines
up the
The
load.
cannot be
new
central location.
The
result has
is
The
separate.
expansion.
The
is
to be used or a direct
and can-
The
all
the facts.
pipe
lines to the
when
it is
coils in
liquid
This
is
superheated
ammonia
is
employed the piping is usually designed for some 10 to 15 lb. per sq. in.
drop from the most remote box to the compressor. If operation requires
a boiling temperature corresponding to 25 lb. gage pressure, namely
12 deg. P., then approximately 10 lb. gage pressure will be had at the
DISTRICT COOLING
The
compressor.
499
10 degrees superheat)
ton of refrigeration
is
is
is
much
When
insulated.
and there
is
amount
is
made
either to
The
by
New
coils,
it is
life
or to the
interval,
30 seconds
all
the
in the street
is
divided into a
number
pumping engine.
As regards the
course, dependent
on the design.
The problem
is
is,
of
friction
6.0
1.23
8.33
33:000
22
A.
W.
113.5
= -2"-
COLD STORAGE
500
Piping.
The
full
if
ammonia system
third line for
below the
is
repaired.
ft.
It is
The
direct-expansion
necessary to place
all
if
line a
piping
possible
intersecting streets.
of pipe.
If
is
may
ment
of of
2.5 to 3.0
in.
to the expansion
should
air
all
maximum amount
shell
and tube
of brine flow.
The
is
efficient
and
easily cleaned.
is
the
The
number of passes of the brine varies considerably, and there may be two
or more up to (possibly) eight, but as a rule four passes of the brine
through the tubes are sufficient.
The type of insulation varies with the different installaInsulation.
tions. In Fig. 319 there are several methods in use. If a wooden box is used
The pipe conduit
the wood should be waterproofed (kananized treated)
or box
is
DISTRICT COOLING
Medium weight
3 Layers
rubberoid sealed
1"
&
501
3 Asphalt paper
,Hair felt
Brine return.
"
Creosoted block
Compressed
air or
vacuum
lines
Creosoted
casing
"
^^^^^^
Split tile
Granulated
cork & asphalt
conduit
I'Hair felt
i^^^^^sa^^^S
Drain
Supports
every 12 feet
tile
(d)
(c)
Fig.
Details of Piping.
502
COLD STORAGE
R. H. Tait2- says that
in St. Louis 59
per cent
of all connections
300 cu.
are of
capacity or
ft.
less,
600
cu.
14
ft.,
per
cent
ft.,
of refrig-
eration,
tice in
Boston, according
to F. L. Fairbanks,
2800
cu.
The
ft.
is
only
load on
amounts of freezer
and cooler space, as the
relative
freezer
refrigerated for
is
from 9 to 12 months,
whereas the cooler is under
load only about 6 months.
The larger boxes are usually charged according to
the refrigeration supplied,
REFRIGERATION IN THE
BAKERY
The modern bakery
100,000 loaves per
includes
2^
R.
Society
in
H.
of
its
Tait,
of
week
process
American
Refrigerating En-
gineers, 1913.
is
now
503
considered an eco-
room of
nomic
malt
and
milk;
shortening,
for
yeast,
floor
area
200
ft.
100
to
sq.
about
dough
water
the
to 40
of
temperature
for
lowering
the
tank
coohng
(b) a
degrees, or lower, on the basis of about 25 per cent water by weight;
(c) the cooling of the mixers either by the use of brine at 10 to 20 deg. F.
These include
necessity.
(a)
crushed
ice.
The water
air at
BBL
Ai
COLD STORAGE
504
l"
Water supply
line-N^
Ammonia expansion
Ammonia
suction
Brine jacket
'Water tank-
^
NJj^-^^-Brine drain
=Q
Water outlet
p^
to system
Water
pump-^
Arrangement
of Junior
Water Coolers
Air
to-Jn^
dough mixers
Expansion
Water
inlet -H
Air intake
Blower-5
-Thermometer
.^ir<
Water cooler
Fig. 322.
Such a
is
it is
lb.
and under 3|
size
35 degrees.
505
of water, cooled to
of air at 32 deg. F.
The problem
each mixer.
of the
maximum summer
pertinent
Granulated
cork
1"
fill
Water
inlet
1"
Brine outlet
Brine inlet
Z'Water outlet
Fig. 323.
As an
factors.
an idea
of the larger
refrigerating quantities:
Problem.
is 75 deg. V.
250 = 240 bbl. per day = 30 bbl. per hr. At the rate
of 20 min. per batch there will be an average of 30 -r- 9 = 31 mixers in continuous
service.
The air requirements will be: 3^ X 750 = 2500 cu. ft. per minute to be
cooled from a wet bulb temperature of 75 degrees to 32 degrees. The volume of
The capacity
lb.
of air
is
is
60,000
12.47.
2500
2'
In
-r-
all air
-=-
12.47
(37.8
11.8)" = 5220
B.t.u.
may
be used.
COLD STORAGE
506
Assuming that the
initial
water temperature
no X
3^
(80
is
35)
80 deg.
F.,
^^^
=
=
6045 B.t.u.
30.2 tons.
is:
^^^
20
Total refrigeration
As the preceding
calculation
is
liberal it will
requirements of the storage rooms for the waxed paper, the yeast,
shortening, malt and the milk. In fact, plants of this capacity in and near
the vicinity of Milwaukee use about 20 tons of refrigeration, but possibly
with a longer day than eight hours, in which case the calculated capacity
would be reduced in proportion. Figures 321, 322 and 323 give details
of
bakery
refrigeration.
CHAPTER XV
THE COOLING AND CONDITIONING OF AIR
One
is
be
of the
made
of mechanical refrigeration
air,
which, being a
fluid,
can
Examples
of
An example
its
of this last
is
it
In cooling
air is forced
507
508
water passes.
Moisture Content.
is
In
air cooling
pecuhar to the conditions, are used. The wet bulb temperature is that
temperature obtained when a thermometer with a wetted gauze is ex-
Elevation
Fig. 324.
Method Employed
in
155.8 grains at 80 deg. F. per 1 lb. of dry air. The "dew point" temperis that temperature at which air is saturated with moisture and
beyond which any further reduction of temperature will cause a pre-
ature
Incidentally, the
cipitation of water. ^
If
that
pi
P3
= P2 = MBT;
= MxBT;
tJierefore
M
Ml
P2
pz
= 10;
= the weight in lb.
B = the gas constant;
T the absolute temperature
Fi
where
in deg. F. abs.
or the humidity
is
The
relative
the
is
if
509
volume
of air to
This value
The Psychrometric
Chart.
Fig.
such a point as
"A"
In the diagram
it
will
be noticed that
F. dry bulb
temperature and 60 per cent relative humidity. Lines sloping downward to the right are lines of constant wet bulb temperature, and "C"
is
the temperature (56.7 deg. F.) of the wet bulb and "i?"
air,
as
is
the
dew
"A"
of
is
drawn through "A." In the diagram the total heat measured from
is given by the curve (marked "total heat").
It has been
found by experiment that the heat removed in the cooling of air can be
obtained by getting the difference in the total heats correspond to the
wet bulb temperature at the beginning and the final conditions. For
line
deg. F.
example,
tion required
of heat,
i.e.,
it is
generally necessary to
Pr losses),
all
make allowance
to be maintained at a temperature
and 60 per cent relative humidity (Fig. 327). Its cubical contents is
204,300 cu. ft., and it has 1248 sq. ft. of glass and 908 sq. ft. of wall surface exposed
to the Sim's rays, and 2154 sq. ft. of glass, 1863 sq. ft. of wall, 2728 sq. ft. of partition and 12,770 sq. ft. of floor area subject to heat leakage.
The outside temperature of the air will be taken as 95 deg. F. maximum, with a wet bulb temperature
of 76 deg. F. The infiltration loss will be assumed as a complete change of the air
of the room in five hours.
The maximum number of operators will be taken as
500 persons at any one time, and the illumination will be taken as 39 250-watt
of 65 deg. F.
lamps.
*
It
is
required to find the total refrigeration, the size of the fan required to
1911.
American Society
of
Mechanical Engineers,
510
i^
i^
CM
^air>
CSJ
rr
Lo
CNJ
cvj
u-i
CSI
punod Jdd
U^
CZJ
lo
punod 9uo
ssjej o\
pajmbaj n
^^
u->
CNJ
)99j oiqnQ
C3
\r>
jie Ajp JO
CD
CD
C3
CD
CO
0>
jo suiejj)
C3
CD
^ O
LO
'g
to
-o
*<a-
csj
csj
csi
511
the water
is
to be heated
512
^:
0.46 X
0.075 X
0.09 X
2,728
0.08 X
12,770
Total heat leakage
Total heat leakage
X
X
X
X
2,152
Glass.
Wall.
1,863
Partition.
Floor.
(95
(95
(95
(95
per
per
=
=
=
65)
=
65)
=
hour
minute =
204,300
Infiltration.
39
250
65)
65)
65)
42.4
Illumination.
7,370
B.t.'a.
per hour.
379 B.t.u.
j)er
minute.
746
Total sensible heat per minute
5 per cent for contingencies
Estimated heating effect of the
5,350 B.t.u.
267 B.t.u.
272 B.t.u.
circulating fan
Total
This amount of sensible heat, 5889 B.t.u., is the total heat entering the room
all the sources tending to raise the temperature of the air in the room, and this
As refrigeration is to be accomis the only factor affecting the capacity of the fan.
plished by means of water sprays in a spray chamber it is necessary to move enough
air through this chamber so that heat will be absorbed by the water at the rate of
from
5883 B.t.u. per minute. This air so circulated leaves the room at 65 deg. F. and
reenters it again from the sprays at 50 7 deg. F. In other words there is a rise of
temperature of 14.3 degrees, and the ability of the air to absorb heat will depend on
If the specific heat is taken as 0.245
this rise of temperature and its specific heat.
B.t.u., then the number of pounds of air to be circulated per minute will be
,
5889
- =
1680
lb.
04T3}X 0.245
As the
13.03 cu.
ft.,
and the
total
1680
Refrigeration Required.
ft.
be
per minute.
will
13.03 =v21^890^u.;
volume required
As a matter
the air
is
of fact it is only
about one-half of
renewed, and a certain amount may be recirculated. In this problem 10 per cent
will be fresh air, and 90 per cent will be recirculated, and will be cooled from the
conditions of 60 per cent humidity and 65 deg. F. dry bulb to 50 7 degrees. The
.
be cooled from 95 deg. F. dry bulb and 76 wet bulb to the san e temperature of 50. 7 degrees. The total heat in either case will be found by going upwards
fresh air will
'
in
Chapter \T.
..
PROBLEM
IN AIR COOLING
5L3
from the wet bulb temperature, 100 per cent humidity Hne, to the total heat
total heat from the corresponding point on the scale.
line
The
The
The
1 lb.
be
0, 10
3.45 B.t.u.
Mi:t nozzles, about 5
sq, in.
per minute
ft.
B.t.u.
24.20 B.t.u.
20.75 B.t.u.
per
500
Vel. air
17 95 B.t.u.
lb. of air
"
B.t.u.
20. 75 B.t.u.
air
The
The
38 7
wet bulb
wet bulb
lb.
21 9U(J Cu. ft
water pressure
^'f P^f
min
\Temperature air-50.7^
100%
Water drain
humidify
to troughs
ft.
To centrifugal pump
Plan
Fig. 328.
The
certain
amount
0.90
much more
This
will
is
204,300
5
The volume
to 13.98
of
1 lb.
(0.82
X60
681 cu.
of air at 95 deg.
0.42)
F.
14.32 cu.
ft.
per minute.
When
relative
humidity
room
is
equal
it will
be
514
681
(108
55)
14 32
of the air in the
= 0.360
these
excess
lb.
7000
room
is
0.90
To
The
0.360
1060
is
344 B.t.u.
=
=
=
1,350 B.t.u.
=
=
10,186 B.t.u.
must be added:
0.9
500
3.0
(estimated) at 5 hp.
Total refrigeration
5 per cent for safety
212 B.t.u.
50 B.t.u.
509 B.t.u.
10,695 B.t.u.
or 53 50 tons
.
The water
of
pounds
in the spray
of
chamber
water required
10,695
is
will
be
(8.3
8.0)
and the circulating system should be designed for at least ISO gallons per minute so
as to carry any overload for a short time should occasion demand it.
The Spray Chamber. Having found the refrigerating load for the room to be
53 5 tons, the amount of air to be cooled to 50 7 deg. F. and circulated to be
21.900 cu. ft. per minute and the amount of water to be pumped through the
sprays to satisfy the conditions of the problem to be 180 gal. per minute, the next
step is to determine the amount of surface reciuired in the spray chamber and the
sizes of the various pieces of apparatus to be used in the spray chamber.
First,
however, it should be said that with the temperatures required in this type of problem
water is always used for cooling the air, and a form of spray nozzle is used that will
atomize the water. Cooling coils in the spray chamber may or may not be used
(kept wet by means of flooding nozzles) in order to assist in the cooling of the air.
In this design the sprays only will be used, and the eliminator plates (provided to
remove the surplus water carried in the air) will be provided with special flooding
nozzles in order to keep them clean, and to increase their efficiency. The smaller
air cooling plants may have a Baudalot water cooler directly underneath the spray
chamber so arranged as to be flooded by the water passing out of the spray chamber,
manner
in a
similar to the
515
Spray Nozzles.
it
will
180
180
-e-
1.8
17
lb.
Id.
or
8 o
.
be arranged in two banks, each of 50 nozzles, spaced not more than 20 in.
less than 6 in. between centers in order that a satisfactory "curtain"
A the velocity of the air in
of cold water is provided for the air to pass through.
this part of the system must be not more than 500 ft. per minute, the cross-sectional
area becomes 22,000 -^ 500 = 44.0 sq. ft. If the head room limits the height of
in.
Assuming
in., then the width becomes lift.
the chamber proper to 4 ft.
that the nozzles are to be 12 in. on centers horizontally, then 10 stands will be
required of 5 nozzles high.
Evidently some arrangement, say using 10 stands
These
will
apart,
and not
spaced 13
in.
in.
satisfactory spacing.
TABLE
101
Spray Nozzles
Capacities in
Pounds
of
Diam-
516
of the spray
chamber,
The ehminator
it is
surface
is
ft.
1000) X 19.5 =
430 sq. ft. of surface is wanted. The Carrier eliminator construction is one with
crimped gutters set vertically on l|-in. centers, each with six corrugations at 60degree directional change of the air, each corrugation about 2| in. wide, and arranged
so that the first three will have smooth sides and corners and the last three will have
side only) of surface per 1000 cu.
stamped
lips for
ft.
minute or (22,000
of air per
The Webster eliminator is designed for four corrugations, with 30-degree deflection of the air, made up of two plates: the rear staggered with respect to the front,
the separate plates spaced about 3 in. on centers, and 5 in. wide. The Webstei
practice
20
5
less
per sq.
lb.
than 4
in.
ft.
and
in
lb.
and to place
These sprays use about
addition "mist" nozzles are used at
is
them not
ft.
made with
ft.
These are
stamped lip. The eliminator
and designed on the basis of
of air per minute, spaced 1 in. with 35-degree deflection of the air.
ft.
ft.
and a
final
row spaced 3j
in.,
The spray
is
in
The
required
(132
-f-
amount
is
U) X
427
sq.
X
ft.,
2.63
--
or there
is
12
617
sq.
Ij-in.
centers,
ft.
the requirements.
The Baudalot Cooler. The figure shows the design with the water cooler directly
below the spray cooler chamber. In cooling water great care must be exercised to
safeguard the pipes against freezing, and so the Baudalot cooler is used instead of
the double-pipe cooler or the shell and tube type which would be preferred usually
when cooling a non-freezing liquid. Such Baudalot coolers are usually designed on
the basis of 35 lin. ft. of l^-in. pipe per ton of refrigeration. The problem requires
a refrigeration of 10,560 B.t.u. per minute, or 52,8 tons. The surface, then, is
35
It is doubtful
52.8 = 1850
ft.
of U-in. pipe.
ft.
of stands becomes 1850 -^ (8 X 14) = 16.5, and this can be arranged for
on 6- or 7-in. centers. Figure 328 gives a good idea of the entire spray design.
The problem has been worked out for the simplest design, i.e., a self-contained
Baudalot cooler for the water, using direct expansion in these pipes for the ammonia;
Without
the entire spray chamber being located inside the room to be cooled.
question the spray chamber could he placed in any convenient location and the
Baudalot cooler could have been cooled with the use of carbon dioxide or brine
could have been pumped in from an adjacent building.
In general, for processes using the spray chamber,
Cold Air Ventilating Ducti<.
number
easily
it is
PROBLEM
COOLING
IN AIR
517
and yet to air dry enough to prevent the surface of the product from having
moisture condense on it. This means the selection of the proper operating temperature, relative humidity and corresponding dew point temperature, as has been
cool air
outlined already.
It is necessary to
total
head required
In order to calculate the friction head due to the flow of air in ducts it is convenient to use a chart as is shown in Fig. 330, showing the resistance to the flow of
air at a
The
pipe.
ducts
is:
LP
ha
= /-T X
A
V^
2g
where
ha
L
P
=
=
=
=
=
=
y2
loss of
loss of
coefficient of friction;
velocity head;
2g
V =
da =
dw =
g
As
it is
formula
may
be expressed
as:
^
12
da
VZdaLPV^
duAIg
dw
which
is simply an expression for the ratio of the densities of the two substances.
Therefore the second expression gives the loss of head in inches of water. Losing an
average value for /of 0.0036 for air velocities of from 1000 to 3000
and with L = 100 ft., the formula becomes
12 X
= ~
0.075
62.4
and
for
round ducts
P/A =
h
(where
is
X 100 X
X 64.32
= 0.000323-^
XA
0.0036
P^,
V^
'
ft.
per minute,
518
is
stitution, the
if
Q =
and,
519
the duct
Q =
6678/13
is
round, then
2625h''S
(for
a duct 100
ft.
long,
In the figure it will be noted that the quantity of air (in cubic feet per minute) is
represented by the horizontal lines and that the resistance to the flow in inches of
water per 100 ft of length is given by the vertical lines, whereas the different sizes
of
by the
lines sloping
work dealing with the flow of fluids, the terms total, static, and velocity
The static pressure is that which exerts a bursting pressure on the walls
of the containing vessel, and is the amount necessary to overcome the resistance to
the flow of the fluid. The velocity pressure is that pressure which would be produced
by the velocity if the air were brought to rest without shock or impact and which
has to be used to produce this velocity. The total pressure is the sum of the two,
i.e., the static and the velocity pressures.
The velocity pressure, coming from the
velocity and the density of the air, is given for 70 deg. F. by the following and from
In
all
are used.
Fig. 329.
TABLE
Velocity in Feet
per Minute
102
520
it will
and
this increase
is
Using the chart and the figure of the duct layout, Table 103
TABLE
Section
103
is
obtained.
It is well to
given at 70 deg. F.
521
of value:
TABLE
Temperature
of the Air
104
522
1900.
It consisted
deg. F. at atmos-
air.
The
claims
made
furnace can work with greater regularity, and that a reduction of 12^
per cent of the fuel required and a gain in 10 per cent in the production
of the furnace
possible
is
phenomenal gain
in
^A^
= 1.0
Sq. pipe
Round pipe
1.25 V. P.
0.85 V. P.
Pressure loss
V. P.
= 0.15
V, P.
Main
^Branch
Angle OC
Pressure loss =1.0
small pipe
15
V. P. in
30
45
60
Fig. 331.
Pressure Loss
0.09 X V.
0.17 xV.
0.22 xV.
0.44 xV.
P. in
P. in
P. in
P. in
branch
branch
branch
branch
and the
blast
may
The compressed
lb. gage.
previously heated by the exhaust gases from the furnace, until the blast
30
air is
temperature has become nearly 3000 deg. F. The refrigeration has been
supplied as a rule on the suction side of the blowing engine, and therefore under these circumstances it will take place at approximately
atmospheric pressure. The air cooled to 25 deg. F., with a uniform
523
water content of 19 5 grains per pound of dry air, is then passed to the
compressor which is reduced in size thereby, on account of the increased
.
density of the
air.
The manner of cooling the air at the Isabella Works of the Carnegie
Steel Company, but not operated since 1912, was to have two large
bunker rooms with ammonia direct expansion piping in each, but so
arranged as to permit the air to pass through one and then the other of
these rooms by the operation of large butterfly valves, the reversal of the
direction of flow thereby permitting the frost accumulation on the pipes
to melt off in a
manner
stage and
first
by
This
latter process,
332.
in
tile
air
same weight
of water content.
20 lb. gage it has been found
necessary to cool the air down only to 46 deg. F. in order to secure
the same weight of moisture as would be secured by cooling the air at
atmospheric pressure down to 25 deg. F. In this case water can be used
in the
any necessity
brine.
air to
would be required
for reconcentration as
Refrigeration
is
not be
will
in the case of
The principle underlying the liquefaction under pressure is as folTake a condition of air, saturated with water vapor, at 41 deg. F.,
lows:
at one atmosphere.
=
=
=
=
14.69
Volume
Now
let
of 1 lb.
up
to 10
lb.
0. 127
of dry air
air
0. 127 lb.
14.56
37.87
12.62
lb.
cu.
ft.
the mixture
is
dry
1 lb.
new
gage or 24.69
all
the time.
lb.
0.13
7.49 cu.
ft.
Then 24 69
The new
air
volume
12.62
14 56
ftt-f^
24 56
.
24 56
.
lb.
524
The condensation
of the water
37.87
vapor occurs
X ^1^ =22.45
in the
same
ratio or
grains.
Exchanger No. 2
Exchanger No.
.i|ii||{*|-Spray
To
refrigerating
lb. g.
201b.
10
lb.
Olb.
water at 70F.
Warm
air from
blowing engine
machine
To sewer
or
cooling tower
30
Conditioned air to
stoves and furnaces
525
and
manufacture of ammonia.
Theatres and Public Buildings. Mechanical
The Cooling
of
refrig-
not be greater than 60 per cent when the temperature in the theatre is
80 degrees and 65 per cent when the air is 72 degrees. In none of these
cases is the air cooled more than 10 deg. F., and the result is a feeling
of
of chill.
ment
The procedure
for ventilation
and cooling as
for heating
is
spray chamber
ducts.
Tests reported to have been performed by the Board of Trade on the SS.
Castle indicated that no discomfort was experienced when the entire charge
Braemar
of carbon dioxide
in
any manner.
was released
in the
526
The
of 55 degrees
Dr.
Room
Wooden house
P^l
with fixed
Vent Fan
1-^,^ louvres
"*5T
i>t5^
Louvre
Damper
Section Thru Dr
Room Showing
Vent Fan
l,!,,,,,!l,,-,,lt
Fig. 333.
which
mushrooms
by the use
of ceiling registers
527
supplied.
in either case
The
fresh air
air
is
ft.
The
air is cooled
Some
on the nozzle.
static pressure
lb.
1 lb.
of
water per
of air per
ft.
of air.
1 lb.
If
the
26 and 29
lb.
per sq.
in.,
whereas a
i-in.
opening
From Table
will deliver
it will be
be seen that the Sturtevant and the Webster nozzles have about the
same capacities. The details of the spray chamber are the same as in
the previous problem.
lb.,
Problem.
It is desired to install
101
summer
conditions of 90 deg. F. dry bulb and 60 per cent relative humidity outside conditions,
dew
The heating
point temperature.
effect
B.t.u.
a.
b.
c.
d.
=7.0
3000
=
=
=
=
21,000
27,410
3,000
1,500
1,910
If the specific heat of air at 63.0 degrees, saturated with moisture, is taken as
0.2472, and the rise of temperature of the air is 17.0 deg. F., the heat capacity of
the air will be 17
X 2472 = 4 20 B.t.u. The total amount of air to be circulated
.
by the fan
1 lb.
is
is
13.43 cu.
ft.,
The volume
of
THE COOLING AND CONDITIONING OF AIR
628
per minute, which would have to be removed from the air if all of it were to be
recirculated.
As one half is to be recirculated and the other half is exhausted into
the atmosphere there will be 17,980 B.t.u. per minute of refrigeration required for
Flooding nozzles 5 'wa";cr f reosure
Eliminators
Air at
dew
point
Overflow
temperature
&
drain
Check valve
Gate valves
Pump
discharge'
Pump
suction
Centrifugal
Water pipes-.
Drain for
Baudalot coils
Strainer^
.^
Jverflowi
Cooling Air by
Fig. 334.
Means
Air Cooling
of Spray
Chambers
Chamber with
The
chamber at 90 degrees
and 60 per cent relative humidity, which corresponds to a dew point temperature of
74.2 and a moisture content of 127 grains per pound of dry air. The refrigeration
529
required to cool this air to the temperature of the spray chamber, taken from the total
heat curve is: 40.9 28.0 = 12.9 B.t.u. per pound, the total refrigeration is
-=2 X 12.9 = 42,090 B.t.u., and the total demand on the refrigeration equipment becomes 42,090 + 17,980 = 60,070 B.t.u. Adding 5 per cent for safety, the
amount becomes 63,070 B.t.u. per minute, or 315 tons of refrigeration.
6526
from the calculation that the recirculated air, for the conditions stated
less cooling efTect than does the fresh air from the outside,
and that the amount of recirculation affects the load on the machine very decidedly.
Therefore the operator has some reserve capacity in the machine available, on a
It is clear
in
pinch,
by
recirculating
more
air, if
as, for
example,
20
40
60
80
100
315
945
gal.
total
per
160
120
Fig. 335.
minute.
the
pump
Usually there
will
=
-4- 500
175.2 sq. ft. of cross-sectional area, and if the spray chamber is limited to 10 ft. in
The arrangement of the nozzles, the
height the width would need to be 17.5 ft.
amount of evaporating surface for cooling the water, the amoimt of eliminator surface, etc., will be found in a manner similar to that in the previous problem.
per minute for the air in the spray chamber there will be required 87,640
According to
above sea
^
F. A.
of Mines,
level
is
located in the
head 2770
ft.
ft.
its pit
530
where the rock temperature was recorded to be 118 deg. F. and the
wet bulb temperature was from 90 to 95 deg. F., thereby making
Calculations
operating conditions very difficult for the workmen.
showed that at a mine depth of 6500 ft., in order to insure not more
than 81 degrees wet bulb temperature, the initial dew point temperature
of the air would need to be 45.5 degrees, which would correspond to
COj suction
header
CO2 Liquid
header
End Elevation
Fig. 336.
50 grains of water per one pound of dry air at 27 4 in. of the barometer.
These calculations were based on a 34-in. barometer, a wet bulb temperature of 81 degrees, and a moisture content of 110 grains.
The plant selected was based on a fan capacity of 80,000 cu. ft. per
minute and the air to be cooled to a dew point temperature of 43 deg. F.,
which represented a removal of 100,600 B.t.u. per minute, or 500 tons of
.
refrigeration capacity.
The
CARBURETOR TESTING
at those times
less
531
The method
In this
air,
with a
of cooling
The rock
the air was brought into contact with a film of chilled water.
Some
cold temperature
room
in
sometimes
The
is
refrigera-
10 degrees
Engine
Per cent
4
friction
Radiation
40
27
25
Exhaust
Jacket
Useful work
Even with
dynamometer
Q =
(0.04
+ 0.04 + 0.25 X
/47.5
30.7
60
=
8
^
0-40)
/624
15 \
0.05
90
(0.05
60
42.4)
10
60
(^^^^^^
11.9 tons.
0.732
1b.
532
amount
of refrigeration
which
in the selection of
a fan are
developed at the fan discharge; and the horse power required to drive
the fan. Each type of design has its own characteristic curves, and these
are dependent on the curvature of the blade tip which
The
50
60
70
80
90
100
110
may
be
120
130
140
radial,
is
the
150
Fig. 337.
The
driven.
any
It is
is
is
steam engine
extent.
The
It
full forward tip fan has a high outlet velocity but is noisy.
has the slowest tip speed for a given tip velocity of any design, but the
power required increases rapidly with the speed, and it requires an
oversized motor to prevent danger in the burning out of the motor
windings.
The
full
SELECTION OF FAN
capacity and then drops
satisfactory^ in
ofif.
The
efficiency
is
533
high and this design
is
After the type of design of the fan is selected the size and the speed
must be chosen. Previous calculations will have determined the total
pressure, and the fan catalogue will show the ratio of the static to the
total pressure, the static pressure can then be calculated and the
problem reduced to the selection of a fan for a known capacity and
static pressure at discharge.
seldom give
be found from
will
may
the following:
a.
The blade
tip velocit}'^
The
minute.
static pressure
The power
get
the
534
PhO
C
LO
+3
--0
o
c
3
o
u
o
g
o
>
Q
S
O
<1
ti
SELECTION OF FAN
2
cc
CO
Si
PhO
c
1
-IN
CO
535
I1
536
2?
tn
OS
s
o
O
o
3
K
O
fe:
iS
1-5
CC IN
<;
oQ
^ o
o t-
o
<
00
SELECTION OF FAN
02
CO
'is
c
CO
537
538
CJ
^?
a
o
t-H
1
o
z
3
l-H
>
<
a
o
pa
H
0^
T3
J o
o
o
<;
<
lO
SELECTION OF FAN
oo
d
1
CO
539
540
of "
Dimensions
"
Am
107
5 Anchor bolts
It!
set
8 Fresh water
sizes
3^ above foundation
i'\
Drain to sewer
Fan
SELECTION OF FAN
TABLE
"ABC "
108
541
542
^
H
SELECTION OF FAN
543
oooo
oooo QOQ OQQ DGQ QPQ QQQ QQCQ
COr^OOO)
or^ooo) O'^c^co i-Hcim I'lOto t~ccos 0-H(N
C0'<)<i'5
ooo
ooo
OOOO
qqo_ o_o_qo_
oooo oooo
ooo
ooo
ooo ooo
oooo
ooco ooo
ooo
ioo_o oooo oooo '*"*^. 'H'^.'R
to o"??
00"<M
i-i-HtN
(Nc^iM
cocctji
<j<ioio
icooo
r-t^t-00
i-l
rH(N(N
MM-*
T}<i/3iO
^COW
t>0000Oi
'i<00'-i
Mt>-^
C<IOO
I-H003
T-iTl<00O
Mt^-^C^
U505O
tJ<00i-(
COt^"-!
INCOO
rHinOS
>-iT(i00O
"5
w^-
oso-
Tf
1^
M oi
cococo
MTjiTji
Tfrji-t.
loioifj
oooo
oot-t-
rH(NM
coM^
Tf-^io
lomo
ooo
r-t^t~t~
Mcc^;
-i'-i'-v
ioloo
ooo
oot-t-
t>-t>-t^t>.
inimco
coto-i"
-^mio
ooo
ot^t-
t-t-oooo
ro"^i-'5
i^iot^
t-t-o
ooo OOOO
loiomio
immm
Mr-t^
t~t>.o
ooo
oio>o
mmioio
O-HO
544
CHAPTER XVI
MISCELLANEOUS APPLICATIONS OF REFRIGERATION
Some of the applications of refrigeration are very special, and it
seems best to bring these all together into one chapter. In some of the
following there is no established method of solution, while in others,
for example, in the case of the problem in shaft-sinking, refrigeration has
been abandoned, practically, as a modern method, but some of the
devices outlined, however, may be useful in solving other problems not
mentioned specifically in the text.
SKATING RINKS
The skating
rink
is
similar
in
most respects
to
it
is
an
It
from commercial
ice
has been found that the best surface for skating is one that is very
is not wet on the surface and has at the
larger spacing
is
not used.
The
brine system
545
546
skating rink.
most satisfactory results, as it has been found that if the ice is too cold,
and hard, it does not wear well but forms snow easily a condition that
The
There is nothing standard in regard to the supports for the pipes. The
Vancouver, B. C, rink is built on lumber, while the Duquesne Garden
was built on a wooden floor with some three or four feet of open space
beneath it. The Winter Garden, Pittsburgh, is laid entirely, and the
Seattle rink, partly, on concrete.
The Chicago Arena, the Cleveland,
the Portland (Oregon), and the Victoria rinks were laid directly on the
floor.
The
is
is
The amount
ature rise of from two to four degrees only, should be permitted, and the
Finished floor
"
Bnne_
'pipes'
*C3
Ply waterproofing
4Cork
Structural floor
lT"Pipe-4"0.C.
Typicaf Section
Tiirough Arena Floor
ench
Typical Section Through Brine Maif
Fig.
339.Sk
Rink Details
(.-..iri
547
SKATING RINKS
winter into the spring,
is
it
1^-7'-
9'^- 7'
9'^^9>
gi'.g"
&
Fig.
338.Skating Rinks.
may
summer time.
The average cost of rinks has been $1.40 per
The usual allowance is 20 sq. ft. of ice surface
the
ft. is
sq.
ft.
of ice surface.
is
548
TABLE
110
Linear
Feet of
Feet of
Feet per
1-In.
U-In.
Pipe
Pipe
Square
Foot of
Ice Surface,
Square Feet
System
Floor
Nicholas
14,400
Chicago (arena)
Berhn
Washington, D.
Duluth, Mich
33,900
St.
53,000
72,000
15,750
44.000
106,200
26,900
82,000
23,600
96,000
19,350 (90X215)
52,000
Ice Surface,
Square Feet
Tonnage
3.35
4.57
3.06
3.13
3.05
4.06
2.69
Brine
Direct exp.
Brine
Brine
Brine
Direct exp.
Brine
Ton
Duquesne Garden
23,600 (90X262)
135
175
Brooklyn
15,285
80
80
100
65
100
130
215
191
180
236
246
160
158
175
156
St.
Nicholas
14,400
Washington, D. C
Spokane
Toronto
Cleveland
Chicago (arena)
Portland, Oregon.
.
23,600
16,000
16,000
20,500 (86X240)
33,925 (115X295)
27,300 (85X321)
158
The
may
chilling
The
of the
transfer of heat,
itself readily,
yet
soft
549
action of brine
is
different as the
gas film does not seem to be so marked as in the case of the water.
If
oil is
to the brine.
a
a
o
Q
Compressorpj^^^3
n^
-Brine cooler
Hot brine
Engine
Room
Cast
Steel
Pearlite-soft
less hard
9% C
marlensite
ft.
use
steel is
ft.
irori
annealed state
Tfoostite
500
Elevation
300 400
line
Refrigeration Building
Elevation
550 -900'
500
line
Cold brine
0.9% C and up
to
20% C
it
is
Martensite-liard
along
20
3.0
4.0
cm
line
5.0
Fig.
is
340. The
the salt giving the required glass hardness expected in the manufacture
The following is taken from the John Deere Plow
of plowshares.
Company
records:
Problem.
The
and
is
is
castings
The
brine
is
to
550
The
density of
The
115 as 0.843.
45500
(1650
50)
taken as
0.169
unavoidable losses
for
0. 169,
refrigeration required
and
of the brine of
is
113.9 tons
22
136.7 tons
it will be seen that the brine lines are quite long so that a
needs to be used for the losses. The brine required per minute will be:
1,640,000
60
M
Taking the density
minute will be 349.
= 3242
of the brine at 1
0.843
lb.
(55
45).
per minute.
115, the
number
aqueous
soils
is
some years
and quicksand.
The
about
15 deg. F.
coil to
is
apart.
An
details
Frequently the
lb.
per cu.
made when
the
dry solids is
heat at 0.2, and the average water content in
The frozen ring may extend 1^ ft. outside,
ft.
specific gravity of the
and 3 ft. inside the center of the line of pipes, but the ground is cooled
5 ft. beyond the frozen zone. For calculating the time of freezing, an
average value of 85 B.t.u. per sq. ft. of pipe surface is recommended,
and 33 per cent is added to the total calculated refrigeration for losses.
The total time of freezing usually is from 5 to G weeks.
of liquid air
some use
55,000 cu.
ft.
of refrigerating processes is
For example,
in
one
551
solution.
of refrigerating
where
upward through
The
column
down through
trickles
The vaporized
liquid
apparatus
the
is
coils.
The
The Joule-Thompson
The
p-^r
atmosphere drop
is
given
by the expression
/273\
is
pi
the
and
initial
temperature
in deg.
C. abs.
and
and
552
The
is
and
is
is
system of rectification
is
O,+ 60% N,
N,(99|9&)
Regulating
':i^02
valve
Liquid O2
135 Atms,
Vaporizer-
4 Atms,
Pressure
=4 Atms.
Linde Double
Column Separator
Fig.
Claude's Separator
The Production
34L
of
Column Separator
shows the Claude system details to some extent. The power required
in liquid air plants is approximately 30 to 33 b.hp. per 1000 cu. ft. of
THE
ICE
is
The
ice
in
55c
refrigerating
TABLE
111
Temperaturo
in
Milk
554
is
dangerous for
all
(and cream) by
them
is
kill
satisfaction by,
first,
holding the temperature for 30 minutes (Fig. 342). The latter is the
more usual method, as there is less heat to be removed from the milk
and
less likelihood of
This
is
F., in the ordinary container, during transportation it was found that ice
formed around the sides and at the bottom of the cans; the central core contained most of the casein, sugar, and other mineral ingredients, while most of the
fat was found in the top layer of the liquid portion.
"When milk which has been frozen gradually, without agitation, is thawed out
clots will be found floating in the liquid (composed mostly of albumen and fat,
which may be dissolved by cooking); on the other hand, if the milk is preserved in
a frozen condition for three or four weeks, these clots will be very hard to dissolve,
10.5 deg.
first
and the
them
is
'
is
in
Tests at Macdonald College (Ag. Gazette, Canada, 1917), claim that 152 deg. F.
required to
make
coli
bacteria non-virulent.
555
with water, and the brine performs the cooHng from about 80 degrees
to the final temperature of 40 degrees. Too low a final temperature is
not desired as the milk is likely to foam during bottling. After bottling,
usually
is
Fig.
making,
etc.
The
There are
same
in
most
dairies other
of Milk.
making and the storage room by one machine and the milk cooling by
Frequently, however, the problem works out nicely by the
another.
combination with a brine tank, and by cooling the brine down to
10 deg. F. or lower sufficient refrigeration is stored up so that a smaller
compressor can be used, and the machine may be operated for 8 to
12 or more hours out of the 24. Such a brine storage is well illustrate i
by the following problem:
Problem. Find the refrigeration required to cool 5000 gal. of milk in three (3)
hours from 75 to 40 deg. F. by the use of brine. Also find the size of brine storage
required to enable the compressor to be operated for ten hours with the pasteurizer
Take an average value of 0.9 (Fig. 343) for the specific
in use three (3j hours only.
heat of the milk and the specific gravity of the milk at 1 .032 (Table 112).
556
The
refrigeration required is
O2
<i)
= 5000 X
for losses
8i
1.032
35
0.9= 1,355,000
B.t.a.
135,500 B.t.u.
1,490,500 B.t.u.
557
Therefore the capacity of the compressor is 1,490,500 -4- (10 X 12,000) =12.4 tons.
If such a sized compressor was in use the brine storage would have to carry what the
machine could not deliver during the 3 hours that the milk
1,490,500
If brine at zero degrees
is
(12.4
rise to
for 1
Q =
1,044,000
^/
lb.
To
store this
of brine
of brine
volume
12,000)
is
pasteurized for
1,044,000 B.t.u.
Volume
1,044,000
73,500
-^
14.2
(62.5
(ti
=M X 0.71 X
it
was
heat
.2 specific gravity, and the volume required
M XcX
and
h)
0).
73,500
1b.
(20
1 .2)
ft.
specific
980
in.
cu.
ft.
high would give the volume required, but for safety one 11
in.
ft.
Outlet
Outlet
Outlet to
pasteurizer
Vr
ml
Milk outlet to
\]')]}i'';]'fi
bottle filler
r]!f).fj'tj;fj
'9
Outlet for coW
pasteurized milk
Fig.
Cooler.
The
ice required in
Fig.
and Cooler.
nor does
it
558
for,
of ice
1 lb.
manufactured.
TABLE
113.
CREAM MAKING
ICE
New Method
Old Method
Cream, Cond. whole milk, Cond. skim
whole milk,
milk,
butter.
water
_c:
Stored
*No.
in
Cans
Cold
in
Room
*No.
Stored
in
Clarified
Pre-warmed
Clarified
Sugar and
Stabilizer
in
regenerative cooler
Mix
idded
Heated
in
direct
steam
iniection
or
Drawn
into
145 temp
Reduced
va(
to proper
or
Viscolized at
2000*
Homogenized
at
3000*
down
to
in
55^5
down
Aged
in
to
^1
gam
viscosity
and
plants.
^4
Tested and Standardized
Centrifugal type
is
liflixed
*No.
in
55-45
Common
preferred
to
45")
acidity
many
*2
i^
Measured
in
batch measure
freezers.
(^rozen in brine cooled or direct
expansion machine
to
25''-27'F
and
Bulk
Salt,
cartons by machine
10 F
Shipped
The
When
the milk
is
not very
much
the air
possible.
is
it
room
loads.
unless the
imately 40 degrees until the time arrives for loading on the delivery
wagons.
The milk
by 14^
in,
<^J^
559
^
i;
:Regenerativez3
Regenerative
cooler
To wet
air
pump
About 23
\ vacuum
cooler
Weighin,
C)^
tank
0=^=^
Hot wells add
sweet butter,
"0
Scales
removed)
Drop tank
Vacuum pan
Temperature of
tnilk
45 F^
supplied
To storage and
aging tanks
For milk
-Jacketed
- ,-_-_-_-_-_-_-~_1L^-^-L.-_- JH
Brine
glass lined
Brine
i:zz:^z.-z^^-^---^JZ
out
Drop tank
Brine
Fig. 346.
Brine
Fruit funnel-
coil
Fig. 347.
560
by 10
in.
The weight
of the case is
about 14 lb., the weight of 12 one-quart bottles is 22 lb., and the weight
of the milk in 12 bottles is 24 lb., making a total of about 60 lb. The
Fig. 348.
heat of glass
the storage
room
is
load.
Weight
Fig.
in
349. Weight
of
of cream.
Cream.
of ice
561
346 gives an idea of the steps in preparing the mix before the
Fig.
accomphshed by means of
These may be 40 to
to 5 or
100-qt. capacity, and may be brine cooled with brine from
10 deg. F., or by means of direct expansion, using pressures from 15 to
20 lb. gage, but brine is much more easily controlled. The mix enters the
freezer at about 40 to 45 degrees and is beaten by the paddles, absorbs
freezing process.
In
brief,
the freezing
is
/u
60
50
-c
S
j=
."*
"40
a>
E
s
'i
20
10
s.
E
2
-10
.9(1
562
arranged as shelving in the proportion of 1 ft. of Ij-in. pipe per f cu. ft.
of room space. Still air is usually employed, with an allowance of about
150 to 400 cu. ft. per 100 gal. ice cream capacity, and a corresponding
floor
area of 15 to 35 sq.
ft.
The time
of storage
is
usually from
to
3 days.
Brine
Fig. 351.
The
pump
Brine Circulation System
Brine Circulation
in
a Creamery.
Temp.,
Time,
in
in
degrees
more
like
F.
minutes
Fig.
352.The
as
shown
*
H. F.
in Fig. 350.
Zoller, A. S.
R.
and Hardening
of Ice
Cream.
pound
to
20 degrees.
of the
563
in
Spray ponef
d5
5"
Fig. 353.
is
'
T-
^\^
Coal
^Zl^
temperature to another
II
^D
C)
Storage
Salt
Ice Storage
Compressor Room
Water pumps
|^
pumps
m
^_
^^^^^
Brine
Switchboard
Ice Storage
Fig. 354.
Machine
Shop
80
16
64
B.t.u.
per
lb.
If
the
half-frozen
cream
is
now
564
is
lowered to
removed
is
130
in the
hardening room
80
50 B.t.u. per
lb.
The swell
Problem. 1000 eal. of ice cream is to be manufactured per day.
be assumed to be 60 per cent. The mix enters the freezers at 40 degrees and the
deg. F.
ice cream is kept stored in a hardening room kept at
If 1000 gal. is the amount of the finished product, then the amount of the mix
If the specific gravity of the mix can be taken as 1 10,
is 1000 -=-1.6 = 625 gals.
then the weight per gallon would be 5 7 + lb. (of the product) and the total weight
would be 1000 X 5.72 = 5720 lb. The refrigeration required of the brine in the
will
=<:
R.R.
=T-
-I
I-
-I
Truck Space
Repairs
"'
1=1
Elevaton
Women
Can Storage
Ice Storage
=o=
Can washer
Lock
Brick
Can conveyor
o
Carton
ODDaODDDSi
Freezef
Illlllllllll
T
Bulk Hardening
Dept.
Room
Hard
Bulk
&
brick conveyor
lit;
I-
FiG. 355.
mix enters the freezers at 40 deg. F., would be (80 - 24) X 5720 =
deg. to 10 deg. F.
320,300 B.t.u. The brine for the purpose would be at from
Adding 10 per cent for leakage and other losses gives a total of 352,300 B.t.u. of
The refrigerating work in the
refrigeration required of the freezers per 8 hours.
hardening room would be (130 - 80) X 5720 = 286,000 B.t.u.,. or 314,600 B.t.u.
freezers, if the
losses.
If
the cream
is
packed
in 2^
and
5-gal. cylindrical
in.
'
565
Hopper
Ash conv.
Wash
&
lockers
1l
Office
II
General Office
Office
Sufi,
trans:
Ice
Making Room
Ice
dumpsi
Office
Holding
Vault
&
Mixing
Room
no
"
^ Syrup
&
ON. UP.
'Homogenizers
Flavor
Sup't.
&lab.
Fig. 356,
Fig. 357.
Ice Cream
Manufacture.
566
is,
= 0.0352.
U
1
JJ)_
1.4
1.4
0.296
622.9
Therefore,
Q =
0.0352
- (-
[90
10)J
= 2200
Such an excessive temperature difference would not be found during the night time
Frequently the insulation will hold the
hardening room during the night time without more than 3 to 5 degrees rise of
temperature.
except under very unusual conditions.
TABLE
114
Temperature
of
Mix 70
deg. F.)
CHAPTER XVII
HOTEL AND APARTMENT REFRIGERATION
Mechanical refrigeration
is
now
the same extent that the ice cooled box was a few years ago.
hotel or club has a large
number
The
larger
indefinite
lin.
ft.
outside temperature
is
Q =
390
2.5
(80
36)
567
568
to which will be
live load,
of
transfer of
^34
2.90
2.0
24
X (36-20) =88
=
TABLE
0.307 ton.
115
Rating
Baker Shop:
Ice cream.
Pantry
.
Pastry.
Lunch box
Pantry
Refrigerating box:
Nurses,
officers,
private
Kitchen:
Corned beef
Pastry counter.
Dried
Fresh
fish
fish
Freezer
Garde manger
Meat-cooler
Meat
cut
Oysters, five
Oysters, in tubs
Pantry
Poultry and Game.
0.36.
is
569
and
it
indicates that
the tables and curves are calculated liberally and are conservative, so as
to allow for all commercial factors of construction
evaporating partly
fills
is
and operation.
It is
ammonia
(or
carbon dioxide)
It
of
about 40
sq. ft.
with
in.
to 2
in.
Such
corkboard.
now
is
used,
refrigeration
necessary.
is
i.e.,
Without
one constructed
leakage loss through the construction of from 0.15 to 0.18, with the
2-in.
and the
1-in.
The
live load
on the basis
is
of
sq.
warm
ft.
must
.7 B.t.u. as the
value of
/v.
If
pipe
made up
of sheet iron.
Most
570
Piping.
The
is
usually
Typical
The
Snowmound Connections
Fig. 358.
shell
and
coil,
the shell and tube and the double pipe brine cooler
may
is
is
11
PIPING
571
amount of the brine in the system is small. The doublesystem allows brine of practically the same temperature to enter
each box, and the system is not limited to any maximum number of
boxes per riser, but the first cost is much greater because of this greater
required as the
riser
amount
of piping.
The
w;
1
'//////////////////////////////////////////////////-
Minimum Dimensions
-/////////////////////////A
572
o3
<
Corridor Plan
Refrig.
_.
Elevation
floor line
PIPING
57^
tank design the head is due to the friction head and the velocity head
This may be calculated as in the problem on brine piping, Chapter
VIII. Allowance for the fittings should always be made in calculating
only.
^^E
Globe valve
Dram plug
Horizontal
Fig.
361. Apartment
Piping.
the total head on the pump. The pressure on the brine tank or the
piping at the pump is the " total head " plus the static head due to the
elevation of the balance tank above the pump. Figures 350 to 361 give
574
06313006
m^
-.^
mm
m
m
\M^
'.m
i^a
a
K
ffis
:^
-..m
m
m
:su^
:^
;^
'^
mf]
SI
\m
ma
m
K,
,
^imm
^H
mm
[t^-]
^^a
^^^
tsnk
si^s
_<=d
i:x:J
Bslance tank
fi
fl
-ffl
-ffi
.^
=si
sn_-ffl_=a ril
!S =ffl_-SL-B
JS
im 1-^
-tfi
-#i
^^^ a
^L.=1I3
N,,,^
i-
1 -1
^ ^^
i-^[i ;i
362. Brine
^L
a
J^- a
=a
^m ^ ^
Fig.
Piping.
L=1I3
575
water system, as the use of the ice cooler is neither convenient, economWith drinking water systems the water may be
nor hygienic.
ical,
Automatic
air
valve
Balancing tank
insulation
Pipe connections to
fountains on
between are
>.
(U
in
Z3
all
floors
identical
Fountains.
f-
^f-
-f-^
-X
all
Thermometer
/^Bypass
-^
i-M
12 R-
'
^Thermometer
GaugeQ_,
<-+18^
-rix)-
Wash
out to sewer^
Fig. 363.
filtered, is
HiV
p. W.
Tank
LD. W. Pump
insulation (6)
may
be
designed with convenient fountains for the use of the workmen or the
office force in
office.
576
tank of one
to keep
constant circulation throughout the system, a balance tank
a make-up valve and float so as to replenish the water
of a water-cooling
the water in
and, finally,
pump
Balance tank
160'
Fig. 364.
supply as fast as
tank.
Problem
it is
-J
in
The water
circuit
must be complete
at
all
times.
By
this
is
meant
that from four to five times the water consumed, and wasted, must be
577
leakage
times.
The
to cool the
than 200
ft.
-o
per minute.
The amount
cult variable to
of
account
for.
is
It naturally is
Hotels and
V.|fM
diffi-
depend-
workmen.
water outlet
having an outlet in each
room should be designed on the basis of 07ic gallon Fig. 365. Drinking
Water Cooler.
per person per day.
Figure 368 shows the amount
of water consumed in one of the St. Louis hotels.
This plant was laid out to take care of a demand of 1000 gal. per hour
or
office buildings
In
all
amount
would have been sufficient, or on the basis of j gal. per faucet per hour.
So it would seem that the rule of one gallon per person per day of eight
hours is very liberal, although it will always be safe. Stores and office
buildings providing outlets in isolated places in aisles or corridors
may
have these in use continuously, and they should be figured on the basis
of a half pint per minute per fountain.
In factories it is good practice to
use one-half gallon per person per hour, and in offices one-quarter gallon
per person per hour. These figures are much higher than those used in
578
the Federal Buildings/ which are designed with the uniform rule of
one pint of water per person per hour irrespective of the kind of service
the building
may
The number
be called upon
for.
The attempt
is
depending as
made
this does
on
in their location to
to
tank
Throughout to be Water
UTight.
Tested to 100*Pressure
2'-6fDia.
-J
2'-ll"Dia.
>|
Section A-
Fig. 366.
occasion as
little difficulty
first
workman, and
workman
is
to
work on
preferable to the
In consequence, good practice will allow one fountain per 100 operators
1
Nelson
S.
Office,
Treasury Department.
/I?
HP
Motor
-pM-fn
-4
^
Engineers office
Fig.
367 Hotel
Ref'
on,
579
The kind
of insulation used
is
also very
point of the heat leakage, and Table 116 can be used advantageously for
ice
felt
The heat
TABLE
in.
thick
temperature per
116
liour.
580
Q =
l-in. line.
225
0.160
(95
47.5)
= 6840
i-in. line.
Q =
160
0.167
(95
47.5)
1270 B.t.u.
\-in. line.
Q =
220
0.178
(95
47.5)
1860 B.t.u.
Total
The amount
of
riser)
temperature of
rise of
9970
2216
lb.
=
=
4.43
gal.
1.11
gal.
=
=
=
per hour
4.5
Make-up
3.0
water.
10
183
15.88
gal.
per min-
Refrigeraiion required.
8.33
The
friction
60
11.45
(80
45)
Total friction
(2.6
(15.88
gal.
225)
15.88
8.33
per min.)
(2.3
head
46.0
14,050
80)
size of the
motor
will
be 0.425
210,400 B.t.u.
17.6 tons.
(Fig. ISO):
= 2.6
= 2.3
= 2.3
(2.3
water per
water per
of water per
in. of
ft.
in. of
ft.
in.
ft,
220)
= 1275
= 46.0
in. of
lb.
water
per sq.
in.
is
2.31
14,050
42.4
-r-
0.5
83,000
The
9970
is
f-in. line
1-in. line
The heating
= 0.850 =
ft.-lb.
per min.
1.00 hp.
Figure 365 gives details of a small water cooler and Fig. 366 gives
the construction of a typical water cooler using carbon dioxide as a
refrigerant.
The carbon
refrigeration in a hotel.
and
demand
of
1000
gal.
is
always
demand on a
a single day
per hour.
maximum
10
11
12
pm.
10
11
Load Curve
for Hotel
TABLE
an,.
^.^^
Fig. 36S.
12
581
Drinking Water.
117
For Refri
10
11
CHAPTER
XVIII
is
will
play an
chemical industry.
Mechanical cooling
it is
may
air or to secure
As a
temperatures.
as
it is
method
Low Temperatures.
secured by the use,
of solution.
In
first,
America
which uses
two-stage
in their process
ammonia
work a
low
of the absorption
compressors.
60 deg. F.
about 100 lb. per sq. in. with carbon dioxide, whereas with ammonia
it would be only 5.5 lb. absolute.
Cooling Corrosive Substances. Corrosive substances can be cooled
best by the use of brine. This brine piping can be designed for slight
outstanding success.
The
is
unit pressures
or even of glass.
best
NaNOs,
at 90 deg.
C,
582
583
is
The
refrigeration.
10,000
Problem.
be cooled from 68
lb. of
deg:.
Strong
solution
in
=^
Brine out
+ 20 F
68 F
Brine in
+ 5F
1st.
Fig. 369.
tank
2nd. tank
and
finally passes
in liquid level or
The
first
to give
by means
economy
of action
left) is
by the
it is
practical to
attempt to
use.
As the crystals will tend to form on the cooling coils it is necessary to provide
some means of continually scraping them, and this is done by the wire brushes
attached to the vertical shafts, as shown in the figure. The crystals settle into the
conical part of the tank and are drawn off into other tanks, the upper part of which
is separated from the lower by means of wire screen so that what liquid passes
along with the solid potassium chlorate will pass through the screen.
To precipitate the potassium chlorate there will be required 146 7 B.t.u. of refrigeration per pound of salt formed. Referring to the chart (Fig. 370), (7.4 2 2) =
.
584
5.2 grams of salt is precipitated per 100 cc. of water, or 5.2 per cent of the weight
of the water is the weight of the salt removed from solution, therefore 520 lb. of salt
crystals will be produced per hour.
During the process in the first tank the weak
solution will be heated from 14 to 60 deg. F., and the heat absorbed, taking the specific
heat of the solution at 0.85 will be:
Q =
10,220
0.85
(60
14)
400,000 B.t.u.,
will lose
By
trial
Grams
OIL REFINING
585
the action of the rotating brushes, and the propeller will keep the licjuid agitated.
A value of 50 to 75 for the coefficient of heat transfer is justified if all the surface is
effective,
but as half
mean temperature
is
it
will
mean)
400,000
A =
810
sq.
is
= ^ X
ft.
40
1295
ft.
12.35
of 2-in. pipe.
The
586
leakage, etc.,
cooling the
and
oil.
The weight
of oil per
hour
is
1000
8.33
0.87
7,250
lb.
B.t.u.
a.
b.
c.
d.
To
To
To
To
0.9
0.1
cool the
wax
7250 X (80
0.1 X 7250
0.5 X 7250 X (60
0.6 X 7250 X (60
0.5
X
X
X
-
60)
125
20)
20)
=
=
72,500
90,600
130,500
resulting clarified
31,100
=342,100
The
17,400
=311,000
Total
10 per cent for safety
Add
Total
=
=
28.5 tons.
oil,
distillate at
it
to
warm up
80 degrees
to 40 deg. F. or more),
is
oil
cooler
designed at times using the two uppermost pipes as such an " exchanger." If such a device were used, the refrigeration saved could be
is
expected to be:
0.9
7250
(40
0.5
65,250 B.t.u.,
X 245,750
:r^y^^
,
22 5 tons of refrigeration.
20)
_^
,.
But the
oil
ammonia
The
distillate chilling
is
made
of 4-in.
and
2-in.
pipes as shown, the brine being in the outer and the distillate in the inner
of the pipes. The amount of the cooling surface is more or less empirical
as, for
lin. ft.
587
OIL REFINING
W^^VW
588
chill
20
gal. of distillate
degree brine.
(80
5)
Im
(20
80-5
log,
20
mean temperature
0)
difference
is
41 .6 degrees
^1
00
with a
rise of
5 deg. F.
Using a value of k of
= A X 25 X 41.6.
A = 298 sq. ft.
= 298 X 1.6 = 478
becomes
311,000
to
. .
OIL REFINING
The value
of 25 for k
is
when
possible only
589
the surface
is
kept carefully
make a
372 and 373 give details of the
scraped of the wax, which means that the screw conveyor must
good
fit
P'igures
Table 118 contains the constants for the more general sub-
process.
TABLE
118
ature,
Deg. F.
Alcohol, ethyl (C2H6O)
Alcohol, methyl,
Specific
Specific
Latent
Heat,
Gravity
Heat
B.t.u.
per Lb.
32
104
176
CH4O.
1.26
Mutton
tallow, fresh.
CeHg
Freezing Melting
.547
0.64S
0.769
60
0.45
.
0.900
0.965
0.908
Beeswax, yellow
Beeswax, white
Beef tallaw, fresh
Benzol,
Temperature, Deg. F.
22
144.0
146.0
91.4
93.0
144.0
146.0
109.4
110.5
97.0
116.6
0.576
0.92
50.0
0.31:3
[Solid!
59
104
149
212
Butter, fresh.
Cocoa butter.
Cocoanut
Nutmeg
oil.
885
68
CioHs.
solid,
JO to 68
85
1.1.52
140
200
Nitric acid
petroleum
100 to
200
Pa
Japan.
Russian
0.977
661
0.79 to
82
0,88
81
86
96
83 to
87
83 to
base
Oil, lubricating.
0.87
93 to
94
turpentine, CjoHig.
0.50
0.51
50
0.45
43
40
0.40
40
palm, soft.
palm, hard.
palm (okn
0.47
31
0.38
32.0
41
0.87
castor
Paraffin, hard.
.
i.O
0.48
0.51
0.43
0.905
69,8
75.2
100 4
Paraffin, soft.
Water, sea.
.334
0.41
-4.0
176
Spermaceti
47
91
320
Oil,
Oil,
Oil,
Oil,
45
0.314
.
91
California.
93.0
76.0
111.0
Milk, cows
Oil, cottonseed
Oil, olive
Oil, linseed
1.27
658
0.92 to
0.94
1.028 to
1
035
Naphtha
Oil,
69.0
91.4
Leaf lard
Oil, crude.
Oil, crude,
Oil, crude,
Oil, cru le,
Oil, li(4uii
88.0
Hexme [CeHu]
Naphthalin,
42.0
SG6
0.89 to
0.91
.
butter.
Glue
Oil,
0.340
423
C 482
55
87 to
0,88
0.88 to
93
70
86
100.4
107 6
100 to
125
130.0
88 to
0.94
1.026
112
0.938
590
stances.
Unfortunately,
substance
is
a fixed compound.
gasoline,
etc.,
including a
little
ethane,
all
lines to
compressors
Plant intake
Water separator
Fig. 374.
is
the
then
Gasoline Manufacture.
is
allowed to throttle
is
compressed
and
an engine.
methods but to a much greater degree in the case of the expanding cyUnder, and the gasoline fractions are condensed out during the fall of the
temperature. A third method is when the gas is chilled by the use of a
refrigerating machine and a suitable exchanger.
Raw casing head gas emanating from producing oil wells is pumped
by vacuum pumps to a central point at which it is picked up by a compressor and compressed to a pressure varying from 5 to 40 lb. or more.
sion cylinder of
After this operation the gas passes through a series of water cooled
OIL REFINING
591
an accumulator tower 30 to 90
ft.
high
filled
with
wooden
tile,
The
oil
to spread
oil in
the thin
coming into contact with the upward passing gas absorbs the
gasoline content of the gas.
This oil passes from the bottom of the
tower into the heat exchanger, thence to the pump, which forces it
through some water cooled atmospheric coils, thence into a still where
the gasoline content is driven off by heat. The denuded oil then passes
film state
s team,
Warm
salt
'^'''
""
"^'"
water
Automatic pressure
(egulator, 160
70
pounds
f.
Blended
"ctn'rano
'-'''
P'Sssure accumulatot
product.
Fig. 375.
Lr_
Oil filter
Gasoline Manufacture.
the gas.
efficiency of extraction
oil,
Even then
it
is
ft.
of gas.
592
In these plants
cool the
oil
down
it
l)y
is
sufficiently
machinery.
oil
absorbent.
Therefore,
the absorption plants the lighter and more volatile gasoline fractions
are not condensed as they are driven off from the
still,
bu.t
pass through
Brewery Refrigeration.
first
was the
important appli-
number
of years it
is
required for
tlie
following
purposes
(a)
To
about 70 to 40 deg. F.
(6)
(c)
(d)
To
To
To
38 deg. F.
hop
stores, etc.,
kept at 32 to
SOAP MANUFACTURE
To
Q,
40 degrees requires:
BX W XdX
593
C X {t-
40) B.t.u.,
where
B =
To
The
number
of barrels;
To
the
= B X
265(40
32).
action of fermenting
C12H22OH = 4C2HGO
Qs
= B X
is
0.91
4CO2
(b
&i)(259
6)
lb. of
maltose.
280
100
where h r.nd b\ = the specific gravity of the wort and ready beer by
Balding saccharometer (about 1.055 and 1.015 respectively).
To
This
is
etc.,
are nominal
is
and the
usually 30
lb.
result
is
that
gage or higher.
In the manufacture of " boraxine," a flaky soap, the hot soap arrives
at the refrigerating apparatus at about 212 deg. F.
device
lard
is
the
roll,
The
usual chilling
and compound rolls (Fig. 300). When brine is used for cooling it
and leaves at about 18 deg. F., and if direct expansion
enters at 10 deg.
is
soap
is
scraped
off
refrigerating load
is
is
roll
by means
of a knife.
The
large
594
About 15
lb.
gage
The Manufacture
mill rolls
of
Rubber.
In
the
manufacture
of
rubber,
refrigeration
is
surface of the
rolls.
The
two
rolls
through
'fnsulated box
Fig.
376. Chilling
of
Bar Soap.
which the rubber passes is 1 1^-; the variation in speed being required
The hne shaft is
to effect the kneading or milhng which is desired.
attached to the faster roll, and the rubber sticks to the slower one.
The operator cuts the rubber off the roll and returns it to the hopper
for more kneading. For this purpose the rolls usually are
:
Nearly
shell thickness of
16
in.
20
24
in.
in.
all
in.
is
or,
595
roll
of roll face.
1 in.
requiros
.30
kw.
What
refrig-
required?
is
^,.
Refrigeration
^
30X0.85X0.9X1.34X42.4
=
^^ ^tons.
6 52
.
200
Formerly refrigeration was used for making it possible to cut block rubber into
had been frozen. This method is obsolete at the present
time.
Glue.
Both
The
refrigeration to 50 or 40 deg. F.
lb.
in.
by 9
in.
is
by 36
sometimes
in.),
by means
of
pans containfed on to
may be
Refrigeration in
Gas Warfare.
Refrigeration
(d)
The
The
The
The
in gas warfare ^ or in
CO
by
was
pass-
The Haber
oil
Process.
of atmospheric nitrogen
sure, using a mixture of
2
A.
M.
Ammonia
May,
1919.
596
is
of 10 tons per
day
(1925).
during the
According
4 cents
used in
process.
Problem. 90,000 cu. ft. per hour of permanent gases (SHa N2) at 60 deg. F.
and 1 atm., under 100 atm. and 10 per cent ammonia content leaving the catalyst,
is to be cooled in two coolers, one to 10 deg. and the other to 40 deg. F.
The
liquefied
ammonia
manent gases
will
be trapped
at 100 atm.
off after
each cooler. The value for Cp for the perFind the refrigeration required.
to be taken as 1.0.
is
Pi
Psaturated
p2
1470
lb.
ammonia
r Ppermanent
gas,
but
therefore,
1470
147
47 lb.
77 63 deg. F.
1323,
and
<NH3
at
Liquefaction.
Fi
At 10 degrees
At 40 degrees
Volume
of
~ ~ 38.51
^^
/>i
77"
=
= Vi
10.41
1470
Vi
2 62
.
= 0.709
Permanent Gases.
deg. F.:
14.7
1323
Frederick Pope,
460
+ 77.6
=
+ 60
1035 cu.
ft.
460
deg. F.:
14 7
'
Ammonia
460
10
90,000
Weight of
Ammonia
At 77.6
Present
F.:
14.7
1460
460-40
460
732 cu.
ft.
60
(lb.)
Total volume
deg. F.
597
-h specific
volume
of
NH3 =
1033
= 508
lb.
lb.
2 034
,
At
10 deg. F.
^
83.3
114
7.304
At -40
deg. F.
=
732
24.86
Quality of Vapor Leaving Refrigerating Coils.
At 10
114.0
deg. F.
At -40
29.4
deg. F.
-^
-r-
= 22.45
508
= 26.3
114.0
Taking the
specific
volume, 3H2
- N2 =
44.24 at
NTP,
90,000
2034 lb
44.24
Ammonia
"""
At 77 6
.
deg. F.
20
per cent.
29.4
lb.
598
In the
refrigerant,
first
would be at 15
lb.
gage, whereas
it
ammonia
would be at 8
lb.
as the
absolute
15
14
13
12
11
1 10
DO 9
TO
I
Q-
8
7
4
3
2
CHAPTER XIX
SAFETY DEVICES AND FIRE PROTECTION
Because of the nature of the refrigerants used, the operating cycle,
and the pressures encountered, a number of special regulations have
been devised for refrigerating plants.
These regulations consist in
means for prevention of excess pressures in the discharge lines from
the compressor, the condenser or the liquid receiver, or (in special cases,
fire) of discharging the whole of the refrigerant into the
atmosphere or a suitable mixing chamber.
The Safety Valve. The safety valve for ammonia is simply a pop
valve ground to its seat, whereas the carbonic valve has a thin metal
as in the case of
pop valve.
The valve
is
best piped to
discharge into the low-pressure side of the system and should be placed
on the
type brine cooler, the shell type condenser, and the liquid
shell
If
back into
service.
When
the discharge
When
the compressor
is
is
is lost.
electrically driven it is
devices to stop the compressor should the pressure into the discharge
line rise to
ammonia.
an excess:
presses a spring
trip
which
250
lb.
in the case of
is
Should a cylinder head break, or similar trouble develop, a noncomparable to those used in steam boiler headers would
be very valuable, and such valves are installed in large plants in order
to prevent the loss of the entire charge and the consequent vitiation of
the compressor room and the vicinity. A hand-operated valve is shown
in Fig. 379, and this can be modified to be operated by means of a push
button. In either case a remote operation of the stop valve is possible.
Helmets. Every plant above the fractional tonnage size should be
provided with suitable gas masks or helmets in good working order.
I'eturn valve
599
600
Fig. 378.
Note
Arrows show flow when
used on suction line.
Flow Is reversed on
discharge
Fig. 379.
line.
all
601
times.
Open Flames. With ammonia, ethyl and methyl chloride and the
hydro-carbon refrigerants no flames, arc lights, gas jets or any apparatus
employing a flame except internal combustion engines with internal
ignition should be permitted.
It will be seen in Chapter VII that the
refrigerants listed are explosive with certain limited mixtures and, as a
matter of
fact,
several
laid to the
door of
ammonia.
Inspection of Refrigerating Plants.
4.
to the
Safety pop valve must be located between compressor or generator and first
stop valve and arranged for seal and set at 250 lb. for ammonia compressors and
1500 lb. for CO2 compressors.
8.
9.
ammonia machine,
air.
shall
shall
maximum working
than
lb.,
diameter, and set for a pressure arrived at by computing the material and construction of each apparatus according to the rules applied thereon. Liquid receivers must be equipped with a ^ in.
less
h in.
602
pop safety valve, and a stop valve between safety valve and
valve so
it
receiver.
Arrange stop
outside of building.
Steel
Semi
steel or steel
Antimonial lead
--Steel
Steel nickle plated
Semi
steel or steel
Antimonial
lead
Semi
steel or steel
^Standard
iron
pipe plug
Fig.
Relief Valve.
The Mechanical
refrigerating
10
Scope
This code shall apply to every refrigerating equipment employing fluids which
and liquefied or compressed in their refrigerating cycle and is intended
are vaporized
^
I,
Section
6,
con-
sponsorship of
and inspection
603
of refrigerating systems,
The purpose
of this
It shall
is thereby secured.
When the safeguarding of specific types
covered by other approved codes, these codes shall be given preference.
as equivalent protection
of
machines
When
is
specific
methods which
SECTION
20
Definitions
(o)
Refrigerating Equipnienl.
"refrigerating
equipment" or
"refrigerating
is
a'.
A standard
ton of refrigeration
is
(288,000) B.t.u.
h'.
of refrigeration
is
at the rate of
two hundred
The
temperature of
(2)
The
five
degrees (5) F.
15 C).
is
These pressures are measured outside and within ten (10) feet of the pressure
imposing element, measured along the inlet and outlet pipes, respectively.
(c)
Working Pressure shall be understood to mean the maximum allowable
working pressure.
(d) Pressure Imposing Element is that part of a refrigerating equipment which
draws the refrigerant from the low-pressure side and discharges it into the highpressure side of the system, such as a compressor or absorber and generator.
(e) Machinery Room is one in which is located any pressure-imposing element,
a.'.
is
pressure at a predetermined
maximum
difference of pressure.
604
b'.
Automalic By-Pass
narrow
is
Fusible Plug
material,
d'.
is
a device which
will,
determined temperature.
Rupture Member is a device that
will
of pressure.
(i)
in
the
suction and discharge lines, respectively, adjacent to the pressure imposing element.
Service Valve is a valve located in the refrigerant circuit which
(/)
operated only by a specially constructed service key.
SECTION
may
be
30
General Requirements
and pressure limiting devices shall be made of material suitable
employed and, where practicable, their working parts shall be
non-corrodible and shall be set, marked and sealed by the manufacturer.
(b) Automatic by-passes shall be of such design as to operate within five per
cent (S'y^) of the pressure for which stamped, irrespective of the outlet pressure.
(c) If rupture member devices are used, they shall be rupturable by a direct
pressure. The rupturing pressure shall be legibly marked on the rupturing member
or on proper attachment thereof.
(d) There shall be no valve between any pressure relief devices and the receivers,
condensers, evaporators, or other vessels which they protect or between automatic
by-pass devices and the main suction line. There shall be also no valve between
any rupture member or fusible plug or other pressure limiting means and the part of
the equipment protected thereby, except that service valves may be permitted on
Class C Equipment.
(e) All piping, and liquid receivers containing the refrigerant, shall be so installed
(a)
Pressure
relief
as to be least liable to
(/)
Electrical
damage
equipment
in case of accident.
shall
Electrical Code.
(g)
In Class
and Class
all
equipment there
shall
control of which, properly labeled, shall be located outside of the machinery room,
where
(h)
it
THE MECHANICAL REFRIGERATING SAFETY CODE
SECTION
605
30
Operating Precautions
(a)
place, as
(b)
Commerce Commission
When
refrigerant
is
it
shall
be discharged to the
refrigerant.
regulations.
charging.
Repairs to refrigerant lines or apparatus shall not be made while they are
if)
under pressure. Tightening of bolts or flanged joints shall be done at a reduced
pressure.
ig)
In testing systems with air pressure care shall be taken to prevent the tem-
perature at any point rising above one hundred and thirty degrees (130) F. (hand
warm).
Part
Ammonia Systems
SECTION
100
Every part
system
shall
be designed for a
(200)
(a)
maximum
Every
be marked with
maximum
SECTION
Class
A "Class A Equipment"
is
A Equipment
Rule 1100.
(o)
proper
pounds
of
ammonia
or over.
Every equipment
size,
110
SAFETY DEVICES AND FIRE PROTECTION
606
imposing element, to relieve excessive pressures into the low pressure side, on either
main suction stop valve; or, as an alternative, shall be provided with one
or more pressure relief valves of proper size discharging, during the period of excess
pressure, to the outside atmosphere (see Rule 1103 (a)), or to the low-pressure side
when a pressure relief valve is installed thereon discharging to the outside atmosphere.
These pressure relief devices shall be so designed and installed as to prevent pressures
The
in the high-pressure side exceeding the maximum allowable working pressure.
proper (nominal pipe) sizes of such devices shall be as follows:
side of the
For equipment
(b)
of
from
Every equipment
30
60
100
175
250
450
to
f in. device.
in.
device.
in.
device.
in.
device.
two 2
in.
devices.
shall
directly responsive to pressure, to stop the action of the pressure -imposing element
of the pressure
stamped on the
in the discharge
(90%)
line
Rule 1101.
liquid receiver, shell type condenser and shell type evaporator, which
can be isolated, shall be equipped with a one-half (5) inch automatic by-pass set
to discharge at a pressure not higher than the maximum allowable working pressure,
and connected at the highest point to discharge to that part of the low-pressure side
of the equipment protected by an emergency relief device. As an alternative, a pressure relief valve discharging to the atmosphere may be used. (See Rule 1103 (a).)
(a)
Each
Rule 1102.
(a)
The
operated
relief
equipment
ammonia
in
shall
case of
phere, to a suitable
(6)
follows;
Rule 1103.
is
1,000 to
1,800
lb.,
use one
1,800 to
3,000
lb.,
use one
in.
valve.
3,000 to
5,250
lb.,
use one \\
in.
valve.
5,250 to
7,500
lb.,
use one 1|
in.
valve.
7,500 to 13,500
lb.,
use one 2
in.
valve.
13,500 to 27,000
lb.,
use one 3
in.
valve.
f in. valve.
1
Refrigerant Discharge.
When
THE MECHANICAL REFRIGERATING SAFETY CODE
607
point of final discharge, including the diffuscr, shall be such as not to impose a
more than ten (10) pounds per square inch on the discharge side
resistance head of
Such piping
of the valve.
shall
be used only
ammonia
for
become
discharge and be so
Outlets from
above the roof of any building within fifty (50) feet.
(6) Outlets from atmospheric pressure relieve devices shall connect to the discharge pipe specified in Paragraph (a) of this rule, or a similar pipe.
(c) In localities where the discharge of a refrigerant in case of fire comes under
the direction of the fire department, the hand relief valve shall be located in a locked
box, which can be opened only by members of the fire department by means of a fire
department key. The door on this box shall be on the public thoroughfare side of
the building wall. If this is impracticable, the door shall be in a vestibule having
glass panel doors, which provide easy access from the street. The door of the box shall
be at a height of not more than five (5) feet nor less than two (2) feet above the street
or vestibule floor level. In either case it shall be in a place as remote as possible from
any exhaust vent or outlet from the machinery room. At the discretion of the fire
department, such box may be equipped with an auxiliary door, also locked, to be
opened only by such persons as may be duly authorized by the fire department to
located that the gases discharged are not liable to
ignited.
diffusers shall be
make
repairs.
The protecting box shall be plainly labeled "For Fire Department Use Only."
The emergency valve shall be labeled "Ammonia." In case the ammonia is to be
('/)
"Do
(e),
is
(e) When the local fire department requires that a refrigerant be discharged
through a mixer into the sewer, there shall be provided a check valve and a standard
fire department connection through which the fire department supplies the necessary
water under the proper pressure. A stop valve shall be installed inside the building
in the refrigerant line leading to the mixer hand relief valve for use in repairing same.
This valve shall be sealed open, except for and during repairs.
The fire department shall make at least an annual inspection of valves,
(/)
At
Helmets or Masks.
least
attendants,
who
shall
Helmets or masks
machinery room.
(b)
Rule 1105.
Open Flames.
(a)
Rule 1100.
(a)
Electrical
All current
hundred
i^'OOO)
Equipment.
carrying devices,
volts shall
have aU
be provided
608
(b)
ice
making or
separated therefrom, preferably by unpierced walls, ceilings and floors of six (6) inches
All conduit ends and wall openings for
of reinforced concrete or its equivalent.
conduits entering the vault
Code.)
Note E: The
outlet
Where
lour
times
it
is
th(^
"B"
wherever possible
impossible to
area
ot
make
water
the outlet
inlet
under
the outlet
sue of
shall
be sealed.
(See also
THE MECHANICAL REFRIGERATING SAFETY CODE
Vertical
(6)
609
of gases to other
parts of the building, which are not a part of the refrigerating plant, shall be sealed
or provided with close fitting self-closing door.
(c)
to the open
by means
is
easily accessible
shall be
either direct or
air,
of the
machinery room.
Every equipment
(a)
shall
pressure side.
SECTION
Class
''Class
B Equipment"
is
120
B Equipment
a refrigerating system of
pounds
of
less
fifteen (15)
ammonia.
Rule 1200.
to a pressure in
of the pressure-
imposing element, shall be provided with a one-half (2) inch automatic by-pai<s
connected between each main discharge stop valve and the pressure-imposing ele-
ment
to relieve excessive pressure into the low-pressure side on either side of the
main
suction stop valve; or as an alternative through a one-half (5) inch (standard pipe)
pressure relief valve discharging as specified in Rule 1203 (a), or to the low-pressure
side.
These pressure
pressures in the
relief
high-pressure
maximum
allowable working
pressure.
excess of the
Rule 1201.
Each
liquid receiver, shell type condenser and shell type evaporator, which
can be isolated, shall be equipped with a one-half (l) inch automatic by-pass, set to
discharge at a pressure not higher than the maximum allowable working pressure,
and connected at the highest point, to discharge to that part of the low-pressure side
(a)
of the
relief device.
Rule 1202.
may
As an
be used.
alternative, a pres-
Every equipment
SAFETY DEVICES AND FIRE PROTECTION
610
(h) Class B Equipment containing less than one hundred (1001 lb. of ammonia
and so designed or provided with devices as to prevent the existence of pressures in
any part of the etjuipnient in excess of the maximum allowable working pressure
may be protected by one pressure relief valve.
(c) Class B Efiuipment containing less than one hundred (100) lb. of ammonia,
in
of the pressure-imposing
maximum
element
is
pressure.
Refrigerant Discharge.
Rule 1203.
(a)
ammonia
shall
be conducted by
continuous piping to an outlet turned upward and equipped with a suitable diffuser,
designed to mix the ammonia with air. The piping from the pressure relief device
to point of final discharge, including the diffuser, shall be such as not to impose a
resistance head of more than ten (10) pounds per square inch on the discharge side
of the device. Such piping shall be used only for ammonia discharge and be so located
that the gases discharged are not liable to become ignited.
shall be above the roof of any building within fifty (50) feet.
(c)
When
the
ammonia
is
ammonia contained
in the
equipment
the tank.
Provision shall be
made
pound
be maintained in
from freezing without the
shall automatically
or, if it is of
shall
it
horizontal dimensions of
pressure relief devices shall be so attached as to discharge the refrigerant at the center of the bottom and that portion of the pipe within
the tank shall be of lead with a one-sixteenth (re) inch vent hole above the water
The tank shall be securely supported and firmly braced. There shall be no
level.
opening in the tank below the water level and the water level shall be at least six
(6) inches below the top of tank.
Helments or Masks.
Rule 1204.
(a)
At
least
one
(1)
in
accordance with
the requirements of the United States Bureau of Mines for ammonia, shall be kept
in operative condition and available for the immediate use of responsible attendants,
who
shall
be trained
in their use.
Helmets or masks
machinery room.
shall
(6)
Rule 1205.
(a)
be kept
in
Ope7i Flames.
fire,
fiame open to the atmosphere of the room; any device intended to adequately isolate
the
fire,
arc light, hot surface ignitor or flame shall have been approved
may
be started
in the usual
by a com-
manner.
THE MECHANICAL REFRIGERATING SAFETY CODE
Rule 1206.
(a)
611
Electrical Equipment.
All
cuiTont-carryinp;
shall
devices, including
have
above
six
all live
Extensive electrical equipment other than that essential to the ice making or
machinery room.
(c) Transformers with primary or secondary connections above six hundred (600)
volts shall be in locked vaults which, if adjoining the machinery room, shall be separated therefrom, preferably by unpierced walls, ceilings and floors of six (6) inches
(6)
All conduit
Rule 1207.
Every equipment containing over one hundred (100) lb. of ammonia shall be
provided with pressure gauges; one for indicating the pressure in condenser or highpressure side and one for indicating the pressure in evaporator or low-pressure side.
(b) Refrigerant level gauge glasses, if used, shall have automatic-closing shut-off
valves. Such glasses shall be protected by enclosing them in metal casings having
longitudinal slots in two opposite sides. The walls of the casing shall be at least
one-sixteenth (rg) inch thick and so supported that impacts on the casing are not
(a)
liable to
be transmitted to the
Rule 1208.
glass.
Exits, Ventilation.
(a)
hall
closing door.
(6) Vertical and horizontal openings that permit the passage of gases to other
parts of the building, which are not a part of the refrigerating plant, shall be sealed
shall
by means
Every equipment
shall
pressure side.
SECTION
Class
Class
ammonia
is
C Equipment
or less.
Rule 1300.
(a)
C Equipment
130
It is
in excess of
the
(10)
pounds
maximum
of
ammonia
allowable working
recommended that only such safety devices which have been designated as
by a competent disinterested laboratory be used.
SAFETY DEVICES AND FIRE PROTECTION
612
act directly responsive to the discharge pressure. There shall be no valve, except
necessary service valves, between this device and the pressure-imposing element.
Pressure-limiting devices shall be
(c)
set,
working pressure, or
maximum
allowable
shall
Rule 1302.
Electrical
All electrical
(a)
Equipment.
equipment
shall
Electrical Code.
Part
SECTION
200
Every part
(a)
maximum
pounds per square inch gauge pressure. A factor of safety of five (5) shall be used
in all designs, except for gauges and control mechanism.
(b) Every vessel in the system, except connecting piping, shall be marked with
the maximum allowable working pressure and shall be tested hydrostatically to one
and one-half (I5) times this pressure marking, such tests to be conducted in accordance with the "Unfired Pressure Vessel Code."
SECTION
Class
A Equipment"
"Class
is
210
Equipment
Rule 2100.
Pressure-Imj)os%ng Element.
Every equipment shall he provided with one pressure relief valve of proper
size connected between each main discharge stop valve and the pressure-imposing
element to relieve excessive pressures, during the period of excess pressure, and discharge into the machinery room. These pressure relief valves shall be so designed
(a)
be as follows:
(
\
y
(6)
Every equipment
shall
\ in. valve.
f in. valve.
1
in.
valve.
(90%)
of the pressure
stamped on the
THE MECHANICAL REFRIGERATING SAFETY CODE
A cushioned or other satisfactory check valve shall be placed
between the pressure-imposing element and the condenser.
(c)
line
Each
(a)
(5)
in the discharge
Rule 2101.
and
G13
shell
maximum
maximum
In place of each
(i)
The rupture
orifice for
shall
be not
less
than one-quarter
inch in diameter and the orifice diameter shall be legibly stamped on the outside
of the rupture
member
]:)ody.
In place of pressure relief valves mentioned in Rules 2100 (a) and 2101 (a),
(c), and (d) combination devices consisting of a rupture element and a relief valve
(g)
(6),
may be
used.
These devices
The dimensions
maximum
allowable working
same as specified
and ruptui'e members, except that no rupture element in a combination device shall have an orifice less than one-half (h) inch in diameter. The relief
element may discharge into the machinery room. This combination device shall be
pressure.
Rule 2102.
(a)
is
relief
Every equipment
shall
if used, shall have automatic closing shutSuch glasses shall be protected by enclosing them in metal casings having
longitudinal slots on two opposite sides. The walls of the casing shall be at least onesixteenth (pe) inch thick and so supported that impacts on the casing are not liable
to be transmitted to the glass.
off valves.
Rule 2103.
hall
Exits, Ventilation.
(a)
SAFETY DEVICES AND FIRE PROTECTION
614
(b)
shall
room
floor level is
follows:
(1)
Where
the machinery
(2)
(4) feet
by means
below
of doors or
Where
be employed, provided:
a'.
b'.
(3)
Where
room
Rule 2104.
floor level.
Charging.
Every equipment
(a)
.shall
pressure side.
SECTION
220
Class B Equipment
"Class
B Equipment"
is
Rule 2200.
Presfiure-Imposing Element.
imposing element, shall be provided with one pressure relief valve of at least onehalf {\) inch (nominal pipe) size connected between each main discharge stop valve
and the pressure-imposing element to relieve excessive pressures, during the period
This pressure relief
of excess pressure, and discharge into the machinery room.
valve shall be so designed as to prevent pressures in the high-pressure side exceeding
the
maximum
THE MECHANICAL REFRIGERATING SAFETY CODE
Liquid Receiver, Condenser and Shell Type Evaporator.
Rule 2201.
(a)
and
615
Each
shell
half (2) inch pressure relief valve set to discharge at a pressure not higher than the
maximum
The low-pressure side of every equipment containing more than five hundred
pounds of carbon dioxide, except where the low-pressure side cooling surface
is entirely submerged in a liquid, shall be equipped with not less than a one-half (5)
inch pressure relief valve set to discharge at a pressure not higher than the maximum
allowalile working pressure.
(c) On equipments containing less than five hundred (500) pounds of carbon
(b)
(500)
may
ber may be employed and its discharge side piped to the outside of the building,
except that in equipments containing less than five hundred (500) pounds of carbon
dioxide, the rupture member may discharge into the machinery room. The rupture
member
shall
it is
maximum
connected.
(e) Piping from rupture members may bejoined to a common pipe and thence
piped to the outside of the building. No piping from rupture members shall be less
than one-half (|) inch iron pipe size and for each one hundred (100) feet of run the
pipe shall increase one pipe size. The free end of any pipe shall be protected by a
shall
(j)
The rupture
orifice for
shall
be not
less
than one-quarter
inch in diameter and the orifice diameter shall be legibly stamped on the outside
of the rupture
member body.
(h)
(b), (c),
In place of pressure
and
(d),
functioned.
Rule 2202.
(a)
Every equipment
shall
SAFETY DEVICES AND FIRE PROTECTION
616
Rule 2203.
hall
Exits, Venlilation.
(a)
follows:
(1)
(2)
WTiere the machinery room floor level is not more than four (4) feet below
grade, natural ventilation, to outside atmosphere, by means of doors or
Where
employed, provided:
a'.
b'.
(3)
room
floor level.
(c) On systems containing less than five hundred (500) pounds of carbon dioxide
and where the combined machinery room floor space and adjacent floor space
approximately on the same level, communicable by door, is not less than two hundred
(200) square feet floor area, no mechanical means of ventilation need be provided.
Every equipment
(a)
shall
pressure side.
SECTION
C Equipment
Class
230
pounds
Rule 2300.
(a)
Every Class
C Equipment shall
maximum
member
by the equip-
ment.
"*
It
is
as
THE MECHANICAL REFRIGERATING SAFETY CODE
(h)
Every Class
617
of
carbon
allowable
(d)
of the pressure-imposing
Rule 2301.
(a)
Electrical
\]\ electrical
Equipment.
equipment
shall
be installed
in
Electrical Code.
Part III
SECTION
300
SECTION
Class
"Class
B Equipment"
is
320
B Equipment
a refrigerating system of
pounds
less
fifteen (15)
of sulphur dioxide.
Rule 3200.
to a pressure in
of the pressure-
imposing element, shall be provided with a one-half (^) inch automatic by-pass
connected between each main discharge stop valve and the pressure-imposing
element to relieve excessive pressure into the low-pressure side on either side of the
main suction stop valve; or, as an alternative, through a one-half (i) inch (standard
pipe) pressure relief valve discharging as specified in
by-passes or pressure
relief
Rule 3203.
These automatic
maximum
618
Rule 3201.
can be
Each
isolated, shall
Rule 3202.
Every equipment
pressures in
pressure,
(c)
dioxide, in
of the pressure-imposing
maximum
element
is
is
impossible,
may
Rule 3203.
(a)
The sulphur
either to the
(b)
dioxide passed
by the pressure
relief
When
by continuous piping
designed to mix the sulphur dioxide with air. The piping from the pressure
device to point of final discharge, including the diffuser, shall be such as not
to impose a resistance head of more than ten (10) pounds per square inch on the
discharge side of the device. Such piping shall be used only for sulphur dioxide
diffuser,
relief
discharge.
Hehneis or Masks.
Rule 3204.
(a)
At
least
one
(1)
in
accordance with
the requirements of the United States Bureau of Mines for sulphur dioxide, shall be
kept in operative condition and available for the immediate use of responsible attendants,
who
five (25)
shall
be trained
Rule 3205.
(a)
in their use,
when the
pounds.
shall
be kept
(100)
pounds
of sulphur
in con-
THE MECHANICAL REFRIGERATING SAFETY CODE
denser or high-pressure side and one for indicating pressure
in
619
evaporator or low-
pressure side.
(6)
Such
valves.
if
two opposites
longitudinal slots in
sides.
The
one-sixteenth (ys) inch thick and so supported that impacts on the casing are not
liable to be transmitted to the glass.
Rule 3206.
hall
Exits, Ventilation.
(a)
closing door.
(b)
Vertical
of gases to other
parts of the building, which are not a part of the refrigerating plant, shall be sealed or
provided with
to the
Every equipment
shall
pressure side.
SECTION
Class
Class
C Equipment
sulphur dioxide or
Rule 3300.
is
330
C Equipment
less.
shall
There shall be no valve, except necessary service valves, between this device and the pressure-imposing element.
directly responsive to the discharge pressure.
(c)
marked and
.\11
electrical
equipment
shall
be installed
in
Electrical Code.
6
It is
SAFETY DEVICES AND FIRE PROTECTION
620
Part
IV Ethyl
SECTION
400
(a)
Systems using
/
I
Every low-pressure
Methyl Chloride,
lb.
in.
gauge pressure.
as follows:
Systems using
/
I
all
and
control mechanism.
(b) Every vessel in a refrigerating system, except connecting piping, shall be
marked with the maximum allowable working pressure and shall be tested hydrostatically to one and one-half (1^) times this pressure marking.
Such te^ts to be
SECTION
420
Class B Equipment
"Class
B Equipment"
is
pounds
fifteen
(15)
of refrigerant.
Rule 4200.
Pressure-Imposing Element.
on either side
of the
main
suction stop valve; or, as an alternative, through a one-half (5) inch (standard pipe)
pressure relief valve discharging as specified in Rule .4203 (a)
These pressure relief
.
ing the
maximum
pressure not higher than ninety per cent (90%) of the pressure stamped on the relief
valve.
Rule 4201.
Each
liquid receiver, shell type condenser and shell type evaporator, which
can be isolated, shall be equipped with a one half (|) automatic by-pass, set to discharge at a pressure not higher than the maximum allowable working pressure and
connected at the highest point, to discharge to the low-pressure side of the equip(a)
THE MECHANICAL REFRIGERATING SAFETY CODE
ment.
As an
be used.
atmosphere
may
(a).
Rule 4202.
(a)
G21
Every equipment
shall
(5)
valve connected to the low-pressure side of the equipment, set to relieve excessive
manner
pressures in a
specified in
maximum
B Equipment
Class
Rule 4203
(a),
and
shall discharge at
a pressure
by one pressure
Rule 4203.
Refrigerant Discharge.
(a)
When
relief valve.
continuous piping to an outlet turned upward and equipped with a suitable diffuser,
designed to mix the refrigerant with air. The piping from the pressure relief valve
to point of final discharge, including the diffuser, shall be uch as not to impose a
of more than ten (10) pounds per square inch on the discharge side
Such piping shall be used only for refrigerant discharged and be so
located that the gases discharged are not liable to become ignited. Outlets from
diff users shall be above the roof of any building within fifty (50) feet.
(b) Outlets from atmospheric pressure relief devices shall connect to the discharge pipe specified in Paragraph (o) of this rule, or a similar pipe.
(c) The fire department, if any, shall make at least an annual inspection of the
head
resistance
of the valve.
equipment.
Rule 4204. Open Flames.
(a) In machinery rooms there shall be no fire, arc light, or flame open to the
atmosphere of the room; any device intended to adequately isolate the fire, arc
light, or flame shall have been approved by a competent laboratory, and the
administrative authority.
Rule 4205.
(a)
Electrical
Equipment.
etc., shall
have
all live
rings, brushes,
ing covering.
{h)
Extensive electrical equipment other than that essential to the ice making or
if
machinery room.
the starters,
etc.,
may
See
also,
and wall
the National
SAFETY DEVICES AND FIRE PROTECTION
622
Rule 4206.
(a)
Every equipment
shall
for indicating
off valves.
Such
if
longitudinal slots on
two opposite
sides.
used, shall have automatic closing shutby enclosing them in metal casings having
The
sixteenth ixs) iJich thick and so supported that impacts on the casing are not liable
to be transmitted to the glass.
Rule 4207.
(a)
(6)
Exits, Ventilation.
Each machinery room shall have direct exit to the open air.
The machinery room shall be independently provided with means
for
adequate
air.
The
machinery room.
(d) When windows are used, such windows
of the
five (5)
shall
least
Location.
is
by fireproof enclosures.
Machines containing from 100 to 1000 pounds of refrigerant located in congested districts, shall be installed only in fireproof buildings of not more than one
story in height, and shall be located on the grade floor, which shall be of unpierced
The machinery room shall be cut off from the rest of the
fireproof construction.
(b)
building
by unpierced
open
air shall
be provided.
All
Rule 4209.
(a)
Charging.
Every equipment
shall
pressure side.
Rule 4210.
(o)
Precautions.
"No Smoking"
SECTION
Class
"Class
C Equipment"
is
430
C Equipment
of refrigerant or less.
Rule 4300.
(a)
that
^
Every Class
may be
It is
maximum
allowable working
THE MECHANICAL REFRIGERATING SAFETY CODE
pressure,
by the action
623
pressure limiting device to stop the action of the pressure imposing element.
(b)
shall
necessary service valves, between this device and the pressure imposing element.
Pressure limiting devices shall be
(c)
set,
marked and
of the pressure
or shall
Electrical
All electrical
Equipment.
equipment
shall
be installed
in
Electrical Code.
Part
V Hydro-Carbon
SECTION
Systems
500
Every part
follow'ing
maximum
j
Systems using
Every part
system
shall
lb.
per sq.
in.
lb.
per sq.
in.
lb.
per sq.
in.
lb.
per sq.
in.
gauge
gauge
gauge
gauge
pressure.
pressure.
pressure.
pressure.
maximum
Systems using
lb.
per sq.
in.
lb.
per sq.
in.
lb.
per sq.
in.
lb.
per sq.
in.
all
gauge pressure.
gauge pressure.
gauge pressure.
gauge pressure.
and
control mechanism.
{b)
Every
marked with
maximum
SECTION
Class
A Equipment
ETH.\NE
"Class
A Equipment"
is
510
propane
Rule 5100.
tb*-
SAFETY DEVICES AND FIRE PROTECTION
624
side of the
or
These pressure
relief
For equipment
of
from
Every equipment
(6)
| in. device.
device.
in.
IJ
in.
device.
1^
in.
device.
in.
in.
device.
devices.
(c)
Rule 5101.
liquid receiver, shell type condenser and shell type evaporator, which
can be isolated, shall be equipped with a one-half (5) inch automatic by-pass set to
discharge at a pressure not higher than the maximum allowable working pressure,
Each
(a)
and connected at the highest point to discharge to that part of the low-pressure side
As an alternative, a
of the equipment protected by an emergency relief device.
pressure relief valve discharging to the atmosphere may be used. (See Rule 5103 (a).)
Fire Emergency Devices.
Rule 5102.
The low-pressure
(a)
operated
(6)
relief
side of every
equipment
shall
relief
mechanism
(c)
shall
hand
1,000 to
1,800
lb.,
use one
1,800 to
3,000
lb.,
use one
3,000 to
5,250
lb.,
use one l\
5,250 to
relief
valves shall be as
follows:
Where
Rule 5103.
the charge
| in. valve.
1
in.
valve.
in.
valve.
is
7,500
lb.,
use one 1|
in.
valve.
7,500 to 13,500
lb.,
use one 2
in.
valve.
13,500 to 27,000
lb.,
use one 3
in.
valve.
Refrigerant Discharge.
When
point of final discharge, including the diffuser, shall be such as not to impose a
of more than ten (10) pounds per square inch on the discharge side
Such piping shall be used only for refrigerant discharge and be so
located that the gases discharged are not liable to become ignited. Outlets from
diffusers shall be above the roof of any building within fifty (50) feet.
resistance
head
of the valve.
THE MECHANICAL REFRIGERATING SAFETY CODE
625
(b) Outlets from atmospheric pressure relief devices shall connect to the discharge pipe specified in Paragraph (a) of this rule, or a similar pipe.
(c)
The
fire
department,
if
any, shall
make
equipment.
Open Flames.
Rule 5104.
(a)
atmosphere
of the
or flame shall
authority.
Rule 5105.
(a)
Electrical
Equipment.
etc., shall
have
all live
commutators, collector
rings, brushes,
ing covering.
Extensive electrical equipment other than that essential to the ice making or
machinery room.
(c) All starting equipment, including switches, automatic starters, etc., if placed
the machinery room, shall be of the oil immersed or vapor-proof type.
(f/) If standard open t3'pe starting equipment is used, it shall be installed in a
(h)
in
All conduit
Every equipment
shall
(h)
valve.
Such
Rule 5107.
(a)
(h)
glasses shall
Exits,
Ventilation.
Each machinery room shall have direct exit to the open air.
The machinery room shall be independently provided with means for adequate
When
(d)
When windows
air.
windows
shall
least
SAFETY DEVICES AND FIRE PROTECTION
626
Rule 5108.
Location.
(a)
Machines
(6)
shall not
be installed
in
all
in
congested
districts.
Rule 5109.
Charging.
Every equipment
(a)
shall
pressure side.
Rule 5110.
To
(a)
Precautions.
facilitate the location of leaks,
it is
refrigerant be
slightly odorized.
"No Smoking"
(6)
SECTION
Class
"Class
capacity,
povmds
B Equipment"
B Equipment
propane
ethane
is
520
freezol
butane
a refrigerating system of
less
or containing less than one thousand (1000) pounds and over twelve (12)
of refrigerant.
Rule 5200.
Pressure-Imposing Element.
imposing element, shall be provided with a one-half (!) inch automatic by-paps
connected between each main discharge stop valve and the pressure-imposing element
to relieve excessive pressure into the low-pressure side on either side of the main
suction stop valve; or, as an alternative, through a one-half (5) inch (standard pipe)
pressure relief valve discharging as specified in Rule 5203 (a). These pressure relief
devices shall be so designed as to prevent pressures in the high-pressure side exceeding
the maximum allowable working pressure.
(b) Every equipment, except that which cannot be subjected to a pressure in
excess of the maximum allowsble working pressure by the action of the pressureimposing element, shall have an automatic pressure-limiting device, acting directly
responsive to pressure, to stop the action of the pressure-imposing element at a pressure not higher than ninety per cent (90%) of the pressure stamped on the relief
device.
Rule 5201.
liquid receiver, shell type condenser and shell type evaporator, which
can be isolated, shall be equipped with a one-half (i) inch automatic by-pass, set to
discharge at a pressure not higher than the maximum allowable working pressure
(a)
Each
and connected at the highest point, to discharge to the low-pressure side of the
equipment. As an alternative, a pressure relief valve discharging to the atmosphere
may be used. See Rule 5203 (a).
Rule 5202.
(a)
Every equipment
shall
(5)
valve connected to the low-pressure side of the equipment, set to relieve excessive
THE MECHANICAL REFRIGERATING SAFETY CODE
627
pressures in a manner specified in Rule 5203 (a), and shall discharge at a pressure
not higher than the maximum allowable working pressure.
(b) Class B Equipment containing less than 100 pounds of refrigerant and so
designed or provided with devices as to prevent the existence of pressures in any
part of the equipment in excess of the maximum allowable working pressure may be
protected by one pressure relief valve.
Rule 5203.
Refrigerant Discharge.
When
to point of final discharge, including the diffuser, shall be such as not to impose a
head of more than ten (10) pounds per square inch on the discharge side
resistance
Such piping
of the valve.
shall
(h)
Open Flames.
Rule 5204.
In machinery rooms there shall be no fire, arc light, or flame open to the
atmosphere of the room; any device intended to adequately isolate the fire, arc light,
(a)
authority.
Rule 5205.
(a)
Electrical
Equipment.
have
etc., shall
all live
ing covering.
Extensive electrical equipment other than that essential to the ice making or
machinery room.
(c) All starting equipment, including switches, automatic starters, etc., if placed
in the machinery room, shall be of the oil immersed or vapor-proof type.
((i) If standard open type starting equipment is used, it shall be installed in a
(fe)
etc.,
Transformers
room, shall
of six (6)
Vje
Gauges, Gauge
Every equipment
Glasses.
shall
SAFETY DEVICES AND FIRE PROTECTION
G28
(b)
Such
valves.
two opposite
longitudinal slots on
used, shall
if
by enclosing them
The
one-sixteenth (^t) inch thick and so supported that impacts on the casing are not
liable to be transmitted to the glass.
Rule 5207.
(a)
(6)
Exits,
V enlilation.
Each machinery room shall have direct exit to the open air.
The machinery room shall be independently provided with means for adequate
When
is
minutes.
The
of the
in five (5)
machinery room.
{d)
Rule 5208.
used, such
(5)
windows
shall
least
one
Location.
is
by fireproof enclosures.
Machines containing from 100 to 1000 pounds of refrigerant located in congested districts, shall be installed only in fireproof buildings of not more than one
story in height, and shall be located on the grade floor, which shall be of unpierced
fireproof construction.
The machinery room shall be cut off from the rest of the
refrigerant are isolated
(b)
iiuilding
by unpierced
open
air shall
be provided.
All
Rule 5209.
(a)
Charging.
Every equipment
shall
pressure side.
Rule 5210.
(a)
To
Precautions.
facilitate the location of leaks,
it is
refrigerant be
slightly odorized.
(6)
"No Smoking"
SECTION
Class
butane
A "Class C Equipment"
is
530
C Equipment
isobutane propane
refrigerant or less.
Rule 5300.
(a)
erant that
'
Every Class
It is
C Equipment
in excess of
the
(S)
pounds
of refrig-
629
pressure,
There
shall be
no valve,
except
necessary service valves, between this device and the pressure-imposing element.
Sprinklers
Sprinklers
///,Mri>iin /111 //)>///!/>/ J rrfrfrfj/jj/f///>
Water supply
^City pressure
jj^jj/^^/f f////////^zzzzzzzz^
'A''^//////^////////^^
{///^//////:>//^^/^^-'''''->''-'-'/^^''^^ ^^^^^^^''''^/
y^
Xy;
'/////////A>////////)}^jfifj/M //f/f/A\f/jj/,//(\
Lij
m. ^i
!i
^ V//////'/'////////// /////J//////777>;^^Szzzzzu
>//////////y/////^//^/^j^j^^//^ ///////////////
^
Fig. 382.
(c)
marked and
Electrical
All electrical
Electrical Code.
Equipment.
equipment
shall
be installed
in
630
Fire Protection.
Complete
fire
alarm service, inside protection, including a gravity or pressure water tank and an outside protection which must needs be the city
water supply (if under sufficient pressure) or a separate fire pump
sprinklers,
installation.
deg. F.,
Fig.
first
is
air.
number
in
Table 119.
TABLE
Diameter of Pipe,
119
FIRE PUMPS
Fire
Pumps.
Every
fire
30
under
if
two
which must be automatic with a
water works,
631
pump
service.
lbs. of.
"
^.granulated
'I
/.calcium
'.'chloride.'
8 Iron perforated
^ on ,1'
^I
i i
j i
iii
y iM riiii^
i
centers
^y>^!
By -pass
To pressure tanks
lr~^
I
1
FS^
It
'g
Pressure
regulator
set at
Drip
chamber
40
for
lbs
t>
^
To
dissolved calcium
-^
sprinkler
chloride
system
Air compressors
Fig. 384a.
Fig.
Fig. 384&.
CHAPTER XX
COSTS OF REFRIGERATING MACHINERY AND EQUIPMENT
The
except in a
sviperficial
manner.
with the price of pig iron and steel as well as the economic conditions of
increased from 1913 to 1919 and 1920, but have since dropped back, and
in 1927 they
and
fittings),
call for
The
weight and
all.
TABLE
120
Size,
Inches
Tonnage
R.p.m.
3X3
3X3 (double)
(single).
4
5
6
X
X
X
6^X
7hX
8
9
10
X
X
Weight,
Price,
Pounds
Dollars
255
875
258
214
1,075
1,375
192
2,050
5
8
10
170
2,625
170
2,975
15
165
4,300
20
25
35
173
5,700
6i
7i
8
9
XIO
'..
Above includes
gages, bolts
and
155
7,575
1920
158
10,800
2930
632
$425
510
590
720
880
920
1200
1460
AND EQUIPMENT
633
634
COSTS' OF REFRIGERATING
TABLE
122
Size of
Compressor,
Inches
TABLE
AND EQUIPMENT
635
123
Ammonia Receivers
7 in. diameter
5-ton receiver,
10-ton receiver, 10
in.
diameter
25-ton receiver, 16
in.
diameter
50-ton receiver, 24
in.
100-ton receiver, 24
in.
diameter
diameter
TABLE
Ice
X
X
X
X
X
9
8
ft.
long
$ 73
ft.
long
104
ft.
long
ft.
long
12
ft.
long
160
275
325
124
per ton;
manufacturer.
TABLE
125
Capacity,
636
TABLE
AND EQUIPMENT
126
Size of
Compressor,
Inches
TABLE
AND EQUIPMENT
127
Duplex
Belt Driven
637
638
TABLE
128
AND EQUIPMENT
TABLE
129
Ammonia Separators
Horizontal
Size of
Pipes,
NH3
Separators
AND EQUIPMENT
639
MO
AND EQUIPMENT
There
be 7
will
Rectifier:
ing 37 sq.
in.
coils
diameter by 16
made
made
5 runs
1 coil,
in.,
ft.
surface in coils.
of
of surface.
ft.
ft.
of 2-in. pipe
18
in.
diameter by 7
in.,
ft.
containing
ft.
Weak Liquor
Cooler:
1 coil,
5 runs
made of
2-in.
and
3-in. pipe,
containing 60
s(i. ft.
of surface.
1 vertical tubular spira-flo condenser, 26| in. diameter by 8 ft. 4^
containing 315 sq. ft. surface in the 72 2-in. No. 12 gage seamless steel tubes.
Absorber: 1 tubular absorber, 35 in. diameter by 14 ft.
in., containing 706 sq. ft.
Condenser:
in.,
Aqua Pump:
J-
by
capable of deliver-
12,
apparatus.
Receiver:
12
by
in.
ft.
in.
in.
by 4
ft.
in.
aqua
receiver.
Insulation: Necessary magnesia black, plaster and canvas for generator and
exchanger shells.
Water Connections: Necessary pipes and fittings for water connections on machine.
Steam and Exhaust Connections: Necessary pipe and fittings for steam and
exhaust connections on machine.
Aqua and Anhydrous Charge: Necessary aqua and anhydrous to charge machine.
Generator:
There
will
1 coil,
Rectifier:
76 sq.
ft.
made
of 2-in.
and
ft.
surface in coils.
Containing
surface.
Exchanger: of
405 sq.
6 runs
sq.
ft.
shell
and
24
in.
diameter by 10
ft.
in.,
containing
Weak Liquor
Cooler:
coil,
8 runs
made
of 2-in.
and
3-in. pipe,
containing 96
Condenser:
1 vertical
ft.
ft.
of surface in the
46
gal.
12
by
by
12,
capable of
per stroke.
apparatus.
Receivers:
Insulation:
12 in. by 8 ft.
in. anhydrous and one 24 in. by 8 in. acjua receiver.
Necessary magnesia black, plaster and canvas for generator and
exchanger shells.
Water Connections: Necessary pipe and fittings for water connections on machine.
Steam and Exhaust Connections: Necessary pipe and fittings for steam and
exhaust connection on machine.
Aqua and Anhydrous Charge: Necessary aqua and anhydrous to charge machine.
AND EQUIPMENT
641
There
will
Rectifier:
coils
Weak Liquor
ft.
of
ft.
surface in coils.
shell
and
\\-m. helical
29
diameter by 9
in.
in.,
containing
3-in. pipe,
containing
ft.
coils.
made
of 2-in.
and
surface.
Condenser:
diameter by 13
1
ft.
IJ
in.,
2-in.
made
in.,
ft.
of 2-in. pipe
of surface.
ft.
144 sq.
72
made
6 runs each
coils,
Exchanger: of
593
diameter by 18
in.
be 11
Absorber:
ft.
Each
shell
has
steel tubes.
tubular absorber, 54
in.
diameter by 16
ft.
in.,
ft.
Aqua Pump:
pump, 14 by
by
16,
capable of
High and Low Side Connections: Necessary to connect various pieces of apparatus.
Receivers: 1 12 in. by 12 ft.
in. anhydrous and 1 30 in. by 6 ft.
in. aqua
receiver.
Insulation: Necessary magnesia black, plaster and canvas for generator and
exchanger shells.
Water Connections: Necessary pipe and fittings for water connections on machine.
Steam and Exhaust Piping: Necessary pipe and fittings for steam and exhaust
connections for machine.
Aqua and Anhydrous: Necessary aqua and anhydrous to charge machine.
100-TON Absorption
45
Generator:
the
coils.
There
2
Rectifier:
in.
will
coils,
ft.
diameter by 21
ft.
in., containing 1252 sq. ft. of surface in
be 11 coils made of 2-in. pipe return bends.
6 runs each, made of 2-in. and 4-in. pipe, of vertical type, con-
surface.
ft.
coil type,
Weak Liquor
240
2 shells 24
in.
diameter by 10
ft.
in.,
containing
made
of 2-in.
and
3-in. pipe,
containing
surface.
Insulation:
exchanger
by
18
in.
shells.
Water Connections: Necessary pipe and fittings for water connections on machine.
Steam and Exhaust Piping: Necessary pipe and fittings for steam and exhaust
connections for machine.
642
AND EQUIPMENT
a
36j in. diameter by 13 ft. l^ in., containing 1025 sq. ft. of surface in the 149
No. 12 gage seamless steel tube. The selling price of this will be $1255.00.
The nearest to 100-ton cooler we have is one rated at 106 tons, having a shell
46j in. diameter by 11 ft. I5 in., containing 1375 sq. ft. surface in the 236 2-in. No. 12
gage seamless steel tubes. Selling price of this will be .$1640.00.
These prices are for condensers complete with distributors, cast iron columns,
liquid level gage glass, but does not include any valves.
TABLE
131
Tons
TABLE
AND EQUIPMENT
132
^^
Size of
Compressor,
Inches
643
644
COSTS OF REFRIGERATING
TABLE
133
CO2 COMPIIESSORS
Tons
Tt<0 CO
-iCM CM
S o
if =3
to
2^
"J
o
-a
Is
1'^
^
3
AND EQUIPMENT
(Uo
646
AND EQUIPMENT
AND EQUIPMENT
fe
Tt<Tt<00
CO CO >o o
(N IM
* *
(N (M CO 00
.-H i-H
CO CO
lO iQ CO CO
CO CO IM CM
CO fO 0> 05
CO COIN (N
CMTtiOO
^%
bJO
h-l
bE
h^
00 CO lo lo
lO o -* "*
CO OOC<1(N
CO CO 05 05
(N (M
ioo coco
cocoes
* -^
c^
fe
j_r CO
bJD
O 05 lO lO
CO
coco CO CO
^J
bC
TfH
,-1 ,-H
t^t^
-<J<
ooo
CO CO c^ CM
I-H t- t--
05 05
>-<
CO CO CO CO
Is
1-1
0 0
CM
C^l
00 CO
OOC<l
-*-<iH
-3
CM
coco
Oj
O CO -*
Tt<
05
'-H
r-
CO CO CO CO
13
|!l
Ks
add
d d d
.s.s.s.s
.S.2.S.9
CM CM CM
C<1
C<1
CM CM CM
647
648
AND EQUIPMENT
E o
AND EQUIPMENT
649
650
TABLE
AND EQUIPMENT
140
$1 37
5-in.
pipe
j-in.
pipe
54
1 -in.
pipe
60
1-65
1-68
Ij-in. pipe
IHn-
pipe
pipe
-in.
88
99
2.17
2-in. pipe
-in.
pipe
an additional foot of
all fittings
to be
141
Size of
Tons
pipe.
TABLE
TABLE
AND EQUIPMENT
142
Brine Strainers
List Price
Ij
and 1^ in
and 2^ in
$4
in.
in.
15
Sin
22
30
4 in
TABLE
Raw Water
Size of Ice
6
8
143
Can:
List Price
X12 X29, 50
X16 X32; 100
1b
lb
lU X22 X32,
200 lb
lUX22iX45, 300 lb
Hand type core sucker
TABLE
144
in.,
12
in.,
20
in.,
pulley.
TABLE
145
Calcium Chloride
Solid (650-lb. Barrels)
1 ton
2 to 3 tons
Per ton
$45
42
4 to 8 tons
40
9 to 15 tons
16 tons and over
38
36
651
652
TABLE
AND EQUIPMENT
146
Heavy Wrought
3 in
2i
2
$1.70
1 50
1.20
1.00
.
Uin
$0.90
.80
.70
.60
3 in
2h
2
1
$4.85
4.20
3.55
3.00
Uin.
1
..
.$2.60
.
2.25
1.95
1.75
;i.83
Uin.
1.68
1.43
1.98
.88
.78
1.18
.68
.58
$5.98
4.83
4.18
3.53
lin
li
$2.58
2.23
1.93
1.73
AND EQUIPMENT
TABLE
147
Random
Pipe
Size
Black
I in.,
J
and
butt
I in.
5 in.,
butt
I in.,
butt
to 3
in.,
butt
butt.
37
43
48
52
54
Galvanized
4
16
33
39
41
and
I in.,
5 in.,
butt
J in.,
butt
to I5
2 to 3
25
butt
31
37
42
in.,
in.,
butt.
butt.
butt
44
45
in.,
lap
653
654
TABLE
147a
Random
Pipe
Size
Black
i in
J
and
J in.,
f in., butt.
butt
f in., butt
in.,
butt.
I in.,
butt.
to 1^
and
5 in.,
butt
J in.,
butt
to 1^
in.,
in.,
lap
butt.
On
+27
Galvanized
application
AND EQUIPMENT
TABLE
AND EQUIPMENT
1476
Size,
Inches
655
656
TABLE
Ice
Quantity
148
AND EQUIPMENT
^
CD -a
"-I
AND EQUIPMENT
657
658
AND EQUIPMENT
v/yv/XXXXX wwXXXXXX
^XXXXXX XXXXXXXX XXXXXXXX
X^-,."'""'""'*"'^
miyjv^N^XXXX
H-H,_''"'^"''^-'"
HH"'^"'^"'-"'"-^-^
w|aDlo'^l-'^l-*l-'*I-*
|ge(^l5^,'-|-'~l-.*l-.*t--l-.
rXgorWwn-n-*!-.*!-.-]--!-.
iM-^-^iOiOCOeO
^rt^'^00DOC0
rt<-i-000':DOOOO
^,HS"K:l::^:
^.Hi:^^:^:
lO CO CO OO OO Oi OS
Q>5
:i:3:-K-Cd2d:
O CD 00 OO
-^ lO lO CO CO 00 OO Oi
xr^xxxxx
^ lO "^ (O t^ Oi
O O <M iM
^ >0 CO t- Oi Oi
CO CO lO lO
-^
e:-
e<3
5J
11,-Hil,-tT-H-tCqN
rt*
t-li(,li-Hi
0 CO r- t OO QO
ira
xxxxxxx
CO
r--
IMMCM
'-
xxxxx:
O OO CI
IC CD
t--
i-Hr-lT-H,-HC^C^ClCJ
1^ CO 05 o>
XXXXXXX
oo
o
o o c
^ , o
(M C^
o
O
-^ '*
^ 0
^ lO
^ iC o o
i-Hi-H
-COOOOO
(MClt^OOOOOOiO
-^
"^
"^ -^
COCDOOOCDCCD(M
fC00OCDiC"^IMCs
lO CD t^ OO GO 05 Oa
ra
O O O (M <M
(=>
P-
CO t^ CO OO Ol
ra
-< i-H
-t C^J
0iOO'-"-<
(M
* -^ lO *0
CO
CO CO -^ -^ -^ -^ 00 00
lOi'tOOiCiMiOCO
OiCiCl-^CMCDCOCO
ig
,-1
(M CO -^
""
'MC1COOOO00'-H
S
-^
T-i
OO
c^l
"^
Tf<
^Tt^iOcOCOt^O'-H
ss.
-^
0^03C0O00COi-<
T^COTj^iOiOCDOiO
CO -^ 0 b- OO CO
C3000000050CO0
1
05
'
on Cs "^ 0 (3
-^lOcOcOt Oi-t
to
5I
<
-^ OO OO CD
-t^
00 0> O CO
> OO O -^
OO
O
QO
f5
COtJH0OCD050
CO
oo
OO oc
>o o
*< -^ OO 00 CD
''J^
o r^ 00 CO
OOOOOSiO'^t^'^
i
^H
<
<:
O lO
O
CD CD CD 00
05
Cfl
ooooosiO'Tj^r^'^
CO 0
CD t-
"^
O !>
CD
O
O CO
st^OOOO
CD
)
t-JO
P^
*
r^
r>.
r<^ r*^
cc QO
^ ^ -^ lAin
en -^
^ lA u-M>
IN,
CO
CO
sO^O
rqrs
rsr4>0'0
fNfNvo
1.
c3
0(^ sorsi
TT
rN,
5r< =
fc-
c3'^.
S-j;
oo r<M^ oo
o -^ ^o
"<-
in CO rq
rN.
o^ fNin
(Nj PS
o^
oo o^
mm
m
m
u-t
I.
rt t-.
oo
fSfnrriri-i'"
-^oo
rA r^ m QO
O O^
S
m
(N (^ m -^
in in
o^-or^-fA
<5^
-5-
r>.
(*^
r-.
r^
r>.
osor^ ^o
"^ m
r^
o
p^ oo oooo mrn
O
m
oo so o^in QO
m
en ^ ^ in m
r*.
u-^
inoomhN,
csn-.
1I.-I0C50CDCDC"
CO CO CO -^ -^ lO 0 CO
CO
ooc
i-Tt^
go.
sO 00
-^ -"T
"lOO-^CDCD
Tt^iOiOr-CDcDcDC
3T3 a
r^ ON CNj
ro. fTj '.J-
-fc^
S3
^1
^^Nr-^u-^oou
rx ^O O^
r^ (^ fsj
o^ sOh*(^
n m
rs n o O in
o
ooaMj^fnfAfNfs
O
(n
m ^o o
o fA
inmrN, o^r-jr^O
^-CNrsr^mmm ps
r^ in m m ^r -^
cNfNfsrnm'^'^in
-"T
ca
^rt-
u^ oo
fn r^
'T ^O
O". GO .^ rr o^ -^ vo r>.
o
"^
oo r^
o^
en
rgrsf^
OO <N -^
O -O /^
.^
.^ w^ r^
fsrN(Ncnm
>-vi
fAr<Ninoom
u->
ro r^
'I
-TfiiO
icior-cDoocooDTf
OOOu
cor cdoocdootJ"'^
'
-^ 0 iC CO CD
o o
o o o o o o
r- oi
ioocor^a:r^a;c
oooooooo
oiocDr^Oir^Oico
(M'^COOOO<>J"<*<CO
(Mrt'CDOOOCSI'^fCD
C^'^CDOOOlM'^CD
lO o CD
t-' cjs
^r^i<oocDOTt"-^
AND EQUIPMENT
HS'-P-i:.Ce:':^:32
i::^:^::^:
ooi:oo<ooooc
00 05
OiOcD':DQOOOOOC
CO 00 00
o lO CO 00 00 00 00 00
o o CO 00 00 00 00 00
CO 00 00 00
^ COOO 00 CI O O O
00 05 Oi
* CO 00 01 Oi O (O o
SOOOSOiOOO
OOOiOlOi
659
660
AND EQUIPMENT
,S^
ejb
Q5
aj=
"
CD CO 00 00 oo'oo 00
iC OO 00 OS
^ (^ O O
COCDOOOOOOOOOOO
0 00 00 OS
OOOO
CDCOOOOO
00 OS OS
ai
C-]
<M -*
-rt*
<*<
OO GO
CD CO 00 OO 00 00 So So
0 OO OS OS
(M (M (M (M
oooo
'rt<
C<J
C^ CO CC CC CO
C^ CO CO lO o
GO OO
'Tt*
OO
=;.S a = 3 ^
p.
HS'
5 c
jc^<Ncoc^(roco
xxxxxxx
O
GO
M
*-H
;*<
xxxxxxx XXXX
00CtCiO00
lO I^ 0> Oi CQ t-^
iC xO
OO
^
d>- 05
oooomoiOio
OO 00 CX) ?D CO CO CO to
oooof:iiooio
o>i^ri>o
'^^b-OiOt^OOCO
-^^b-CiOb-OOCO
O O CO Oi < lO Oi
O
iO
00 OO Oi CO O 1
I
"B
t-H
1 03 CM Cq <N
rj*
CiOlO-lTt^iOC-ICOCO
0 Oi 1-H CO C^ lO C
.-H ,-H CO OO CD
C
f-H i-
^H CM
O CJ
C-l
O
O O CO Oi
00 OO 05 CO O
r-H lO
1-H .-H
05
lO
i-t(N<NC<I(M
Ot^CiC^I-^irstMCOCO
iC Oi 1 CO c
1 , CO OO ID C
1-1 (M CS
.
<
^w
r- cs
obc^i'
]
-^(MOO
O O Oi
-^
C^)icCOiO
<r>
o CO
CO o o r^
OO
-iCOiO
'-'
ooovnoooo ooomoooo
jr^
r^f
r^
^r^
o o
-^-^o^u^
fSfsirsi^o
__
rq
r>4 rsi
m o^
r^ u
(N
. .-.,^.,
OSOSCOCO>.<COiO
i
^^^
t^
^ M C^ ^ CO
OS CO CD Oi ^
b^ t cq oi
r^ OS
OOCO'^C-IOO^CO
-<
t--
OC CD CO OO O
-i^^^c
-
oommoooo
(N(NfNrs|
'
r>.
(NsO\0 fsrsifses
fS
<
CO.(..oc
'^^OMn
fSfNfSsO
^ ^^cs cq c^<
3
O O O CO i ,ii-HOi
OOOcOi-i,
i Oi
C^l c
^^^^
1
O
.-i^c^(M
.^ (M
oooioioiooio
OO 00 CO CD CO CO
00 CO lO
^H .-( (M
(N.
C<l
CO CO CD CO
aco
<-( t-H
lO 0 iC lO O O
O
lO t^ 0> M
t^
co(Mcooor--^co
CO
00 OO 00
sS-
Tt* <:0
oo
c o CiO o
^
lO t^ Oi Ci (M t^
cic
^ u^
irt
_
(n (n
cs)
"^ -^ o^
r^fNjvOo
.-..-.
rs|
03
u-\
ffl
rvi
O CO
.(=:
a a-e
Ln rO O^
CO C^
i^
O^ O
Ou- -^ O
O
sO t^
ooo^
"J^
_ o^
-^OO -^
4 r^,
O -^
OI^OOtNOtNu
I-
r>. rsj
r>*
-^^os
OO "^ sO O '^
O oo
-^ sO ^
^ -^
^o
LO -O \0
CO
i^
-r\
r>.
^'i-or^^
ON
o^ -r
-^r
r>.
mO
m o
!>
r^.
h**
u-v
r^oo
r^ in
r>. r>*
CT*
o^
o OO ^O^ OO ^
m vo O rs
00 OO ^ o
nO
O
rsi
"^ in \0 r^ r^ oo o^
r^,
f<>
IN.
fN.
On
\0
o OO
sDrr,infS On
O
^m
no
OO c* O^
-^ ON OO in
^ c^ no
o
TT -^
nO r^ OO
(T*
'jrN,oom'j-r^,
oo
nO ^o t>. 00 o^
O
O O^ O fN lA
O
"^ o oor^ ^
(N
^m
vo
OO
O^ f>.
in r^ o^
tn so -o 00
r^ninr>.
ococo ''t-O
fs
^r o^ -o OO
r<^
\0 t^oo OO
r^)
000 rs
m 000'<1-0
-^ o^ 00 in
o
n Ln \o r^ r^ 00 o^
Bo
nO
fN sO
OO
OO
OO CO
rs
O^ sO
r>.
>roa^
LOO^Ov
"^ ^
H^
-"I-
r>.
u-\
r^,
t>
"=0000000
OQOO
^OOOOOOO
)OOUOQO
CN]0
r^ iM
CM
^
o
(M '^ -^
r- '^
OO CO CO '* lO .j.
ooiocDi>-b-t^t^
3
O
O O "O o ^
CO r^ 05 b- Oi CO
r-
OO CD *0 "* -^
(M M< CO OO
^1
O (M
-*<
CO
CO CO
'
lO lO 0 b-
noioiocor^r
o
o o o o t^
o O lO
Oi CO
lo ic CO t^
c?>
1-H
OO CD lO "^
cq -^ CD 00
Tt<
O Cq -^ CO
COCNl
GO "^ *0 lO
-rp
r--
oi
trg
Tj<
OOGOTfTfiOCCDt>-
iLOiococDr-i>.t-t>-
oooo
o
oooo
locob-cs
o
o
^^
00 CO
Tt<
wt*
o
o co r^ os b- os co
b- 1 00 CO lO
-^COOOO
CCl
-^
b^
1-H
O 00 O ^ <o
Cfl
'
AND EQUIPMENT
661
j'C-C:X:ifX
?D CO QO 00 00 00 00 00
loooojos
00 o CD
^ -^OOQO
:iz:it:t'StTX'3it.
OOQOOOOOOO
a; c:
-*
'f**
i-h
o o o o o cc
'^
uO 00
<**
10
^^
00 OO 00 00 OC ^^ ^h
00 00
00 00 00 00 00
05 Oi OS
O O CO CO
OS Cs
OOO
Oi Ci
0000
xxxx
^
xxxxxx
c^C'icococo
c^jc^c^cocococo
c^c^)c<ic^cocococo
ooo
CO OO 00 00 GO
lO
C-]
- C-l
--t^
rf
^ 0 00 O O
OO
10 iC lO lO
O
10
Ci M (M
00OiO'0C'OiO
CO CD CD
kOCiCC0
00 00 CO CO CO
UO 0 uo
5CDCDCOCOCO
o 00 r^ o- CD
o Ci
'COiO
OOSCOCO
1'-*C^(Md
CO^O.'.-'lO
icc*-
wcsc^icocococo
Mc^coeoco
t-- 1--
co -^
Tt*
.-.-<.(C^(rJCOCO
I^CICI
C^iOuO(000
CDCOCDCDCO
ooit
CiCD- (T^Ci"^-^
iiOC'5^-'tOCOCO
i"iI,(>5C<ICOC0
OS00t^r>-CD
lOCit^b^i-i**'<:J<
t-^ i CO 'J' -^
tJ^COCO'<C000
10
COCCCO'^a^Tt*
<M<MC^C0C0C0C0
>"OCOOOCOlMCl
CIW'MfMCO'*'*
OS 1
osoob-t^cD
lo
o t^ 1 tH
lOOb-'-'CO'^-^
^ -*}<
(M
r^ h- c^ OS t-
1-
SCOrPdOO-^cO
1-. ^ W (M Ol CO
^-('Mt-0OcDCDO0'-
JUOb-OOO
liOb-OOO
OlOiOC _
"*^
!>.
^COC^liM
* -M C5 (M CO
(
>oooo
rsi
r^
r>4
cs<Mcococococo
^ ^ o^ o^ m
-^
(NfSrvjfN
fSKN'O^O
00* r^i o (^ lA
^r^
ON ^ r>* CO u^ "^
r<^
c^
^ ^r u^ ^D
r>.
00
r^
UOOb-I--'iTt*-^
O t^ < CO -^ -^
<
c?s
b- r- .
OiOfMCDOOOOS
TOcor^C^]''^H
iCiCiOiOO
CO coco CDC
1 00 -^ "^ 00
COCO'Itit^
UOI>-C
3C^)
f-Hr-(C^C^CO
r^OO'^'^OO
t^ 0 IM ^O C^
(MiOT-Hr-HCO
COCO'^Tt^iO
0 OS OS CO
<
rNrsrg
tnu-MTioooo
r
"^m ^ -^ nD ON
5^
^or^co-^f^o
^NOrxcooN
\0
r^
O
^o
in r<^ sO
^A u*> Csj
00 o-
rsrqr^
"^"^
rsjcsTt'^
nOnOvO
>
r>*
rsj
CO
4-^
r-j
oov-or.rN.oooN
"OC^lCiiMO
i"<**OSOtM
iiO>i^C0000
lOiOiOiiO^COO
CD CD CO CO CO CO CO
fs)
"<r
__
_
O^'OfAmfNrs
--
nO
onoi^conO
ON hx CO On m CO
r^co^OrN.^
^u-^ -o
00 ON o
10
f*^
00
m^
h*.
co o^
Tj-
-^^ooi^O^
NO
r"^
O^ ON
"^-^
>0 sO ^"^
<Nrsi-^
_ rs
ON t^ 00 ON
c^co-Or^-^mfA
^
o
._ _-
On
tt
r> !>
._^CMrs
rN. lTn
sO
hN.
\Or>*r>iONO^O'^
r-x
rsj-^fiA"*r
OOoO-^m
-rt^
iOt~^t^CO*-iTt*CD
0 t-^
05 CO "^ "
0 !> b- CO i
'
o^
'^ '^
<M CI
r^
es
fs ^
(nj
PS On
ON 00
in
ON fN
r>.
nO r^ 00 n
ON
On
nO nO 00 CO
r^i
-.-.
r^oooN
CO
00000
____
r^i
rq
fSr^rsicN
'^-<^
cn rs rs
^tr
r^
ON
(NO
Tj*
OCOl^CiOC^.
vO^O
^^j-
r>.\D*^\ONO>-
O
m m
'
ociio-^oocio;
i-^*-
r^j
-Tj-
"^
On r^ On On CO
\0 -^ so no
On r^
sO r>. CO ON
fN,
sO "^ nO "O lA
ror^
^o r*. 00 ON
CNf*^
(^
o 00
O^
00 ON r^ <c 00
00 On O (N
rsi
r>*
r>j
fN,
o o^ r^ On in 00
no r^ 00 ON o
ONrN.iriNO'^NO
^
mr^rsrr\
0000
(^
Omm
'^^
ir-
On
O ON ON
On
r^j
oon mm o
On On rA rn
O
o^ Ov (N
PN^
nOnOOOoOO O
r>.
cNj cNj
CO ON o^
m cm o^
r^
(N
u*^
"^ TT
CNi
r^ (N
(Nc-jon
\0 t> fx On On
c^
IC b- b- CO i
sOnO
.
O
ocoooooc
^ CO
*^
iOb-<OOs
O-'0000CO<MiO
"^t"
.iiiC
OO 0
fN ON O
cnicao^ou^
r^ O OC^
ON o
o- -^r
m
r-H
1^ 00 CD
.^ tl^ Oi
Ot~^b-COT-H-S<CO
10 l>CI CO -^ Tj<
COCOiiiICO0 00
a CO CO CO Tt< -^
On -^ fN
NO
-n-i
^i>.i.iccoio
-^
coo or>.
r--
-^r-iiT-.iocoo
-*."C^iMC^COCO
vOrAfNrO f^r
-^insOr^ooo^o
-^u-^sot^oo
infNjTt-(vi
'^^^<^
CD CO CO CD
b- r 00 CD
CO
o
o
OiTI"'OCl"^C
Oi
u^mooo Lnr\ooooo
sOsDnO
r^
C^
>J^
rr
coo^^^^^D
00 ON ON
rs
nO
cA
t^
o r^
o On
fA fS lA
O
^^<^Q(NGO0Oln
"^ m O
CO On
-^
rs fN
'"
^m/M>*r^
fN
no
^Nt^
oo
r>
c^cqcococococo
iCiiOOOOO
r^
sO r^i 00 fN -^
mt^coovn
t>.^u^
oco
00 ON ON
Mnm
\o
^
l~-
5U0OOOO
'^0^0^
sO nD -^
OOO
t--
- rvj
h-,
CD 00
xxxxxx
^H^^H^<MC^C^CO
1-HC^OOOC^
Tt<
xxxxxx
CC^t-^**C^C<J'^CO
Di-'^-OOOOOC^C>
C^COOOOlCDcDOi-^
1^
O 05 O O O CO CO
00 O
CO -^ 0 CD CO
OOO
^i?5uOOiCOO
r^ h- c^ C5 1- 1^ -^ CO
-''"C^I<MC^
1-H
-rf
!>
cOCO':OCDeO
00 CO 00 00 00
lO eO CD
xxxxxx
"3 JO uO 10
lo ^* OJ ':^ iM t^ t^
O O O CO CO
'^ CD 00
O 00
O
^ 00
^^^
^ (M
O)
r-i .-
*- '<
t>. hN,
r> r**
r--.
lO o
3CDI t--0000
10 CD CD cb lO
COCOt-b-OO
0000000>0 OOOOiO
OOOOiCO0
OOOOUOOUO
00000
...-i-
>^,^i^,
.^.^..
,
..
kCcDI>.CS'^
UO
CO b- OS^1^
t^ OS.-*
CO
cor-cst-^cico
uocor^cf^
W3OCDt^OSb-CscO
*a<t^.lOOcouo-^Tj^
eg
ri<
00
rj
* o
...
^H 00 CD lO
-1i00cOiOrr<"^
_-.
'OocDuo-^^
l^
'OOcDuO-^
b*-oocoio
***
Tt<
CNl
Tf CD
- lo- lo.-t-^ lO--r^
5 CO b- b- b- 00 00
Tt< CD lO lO b- iC t^
CD CO l>- t^ 1^ 00 00
OOOOii^iO^O
._
uocor-ot^osco
CD O O lO O lO
O
CD
ocDt--.ost^osco
OS r- OS CO
o
r-ioocoj^Tr"^
t--
i^<oocDr5^*<'*
b00 CD 0 -^f -^
662
1
02
AND EQUIPMENT
AND EQUIPMENT
^OOCOCCCOCO
00
O O O CO CO CO CO
OOCOCOCOCOCO
O O OO
QOO0>1^-.i,-.iO
QOGO^Hi"-^.'0
OOCOCOCOCOCD
Cr>
CO CO CO CO CO
O O W <M
C5 -^
C^
OO
XXXXX
CO CO CO CO CO CO CO
CO CO CO CO CO CO CO
CO CO CO CO CO CO
Tji
-^J*
C^l
XXXXX
M
OJ
t-lCs)
CO CO CO CO CO CO CO
<M
<N <N CM CI
C<I
OJ (M
iC lO
<M C^ (M
O O CO CO CO iC CO
OO
C>1
CO -^
C-l
CO CO CO CO CO
rj<
^H (M (M c^ CM
CO CO CO CO CO
^^
663
664
AND EQUIPMENT
5
u.
J>
AND EQUIPMENT
665
666
AND EQUIPMENT
iC^OiOC>0000*0>OOO^OOiOOO000
'P
'!"
2 2
i S S
oooooooooooooooooooooo
O
I.
CO
C3
(u
ro
c3
t^
12
M I 3 S
o ja 2 0)
C
o " g
;:^
PL,
E-i
.o
>
oooooooooooooooooooo
MMCCC<5P5COC<3C<5TOMC3C5CCC5MC<5COCOC<;CO
AND EQUIPMENT
,-l.-i.-<(NClC^i-ir-i^lNIN(NINC<IIMININiMINNNINClMe<5eOC>5COMCO
667
668
TABLE
AND EQUIPMENT
154
Centrifugal Pumps
Type "A"
Size
of
Suction
Pumps
TABLE
Operating Labor Costs
155
in
[Pow-r, 1925]
Plant
Num-
AND EQUIPMENT
669
670
TABLE
An
Plant
Number
156
in
TABLE
AND EQUIPMENT
671
157
Number
2
6
7
13
17
Running
Yearly
37^
42
15
113,605
4,929
0.0434
18
165,050
6,787
.0411
82
48
52
58
41
430,000
7,320
.0170
23
120,000
4,080
.0340
36
37
403,000
8,497
481,800
10,309
.0210
.0214
36
21
1,271,400
15,224
.0120
57
650,000
10,236
.0157
38
23
365,000
5,648
.0155
19
24
27
Kw.-Hr.
Produced
per Year
Total
Average
Unit
0.246
672
-SHi^coocoooto
E^
o u
So
t-
17
CO
O o
d>
1^
(S
aj
^ -S
r^
15
_
O
Tt*
(M "#
TtH
bC
tH
j;
C!
tc
rn
t-i
-*^
73
<B
H|Jg^O
bO
O 05 1^
CO
^ Oo
oj'CO o
h-
Ph
ao
O-
w
ij
i^
kO
<-!
lO
AND EQUIPMENT
TABLE
Depreciation of Ice Plants
AND EQUIPMENT
673
159
G.
Per cent
10
Boilers
Pipe work
Brick building
5
2 to 3
Electric machinery
General machinery
20
Automatic equipment
Delivery equipment
Country ice houses
Office furniture and fixtures
Tools and implements
TABLE
10
20
10
10
160
to October, 1926
Investment
All electric
equipment including
installation
$25,000 00
.
Fixed charges:
Interest, per cent
Depreciation, per cent
Insurance and taxes, per cent
6
4
2
12
Total
Supplies and repairs:
25c. per ton X 30,000
Total
20,500.00
1 Electrician at 30.00
3 Oilers and ice pullers at $25.00
$3,000 00
120.00
$2340.00
3960. 00
1560 00
3900. 00
.
11,760.00
7,500 00
.
$42,880.00
1 43
.
674
TABLE
AND EQUIPMENT
161
Two
Two
$26,000.00
33,000.00
7,000.00
$66,000.00
Fixed charges:
Interest, per cent
6
8
2
Total
16
$10,580.00
Fuel:
11,700.00
1,650.00
Labor
1
2
1
$2340. 00
3960 00
1560 00
Total
Supplies and
30
c.
$13,060.00
repairs:
per ton
Total
5200 00
30,000
9,000.00
$45,990.00
1
53
TABLE
AND EQUIPMENT
675
162
10,000-Ton
200-Ton Plant
Storage and
125-Ton Plant
Cost
Total
Cost
Total
per ton
cost
per ton
cost
Plant labor
Tank-room labor
Day
storage-room labor
Power
Ammonia
Water and other
supplies
Maintenance
$1.68
0.10
0.10
0.06
0.45
0.05
0.05
0.15
$4,200
SI. 55
$38,780
2,500
0.14
0.14
0.10
0.47
0.05
0.05
0.15
3,500
0.15
3,850
2,500
1,500
11,250
1,250
1,250
3,750
3,500
2,500
11,750
1,250
1,250
3,750
0.088
0.40
0.30
$69,850
Saving
*
t
On
On
in
$2.79
.5
4,000
3,000
$75,480
$3.02
basis of
2,200
CHAPTER XXI
SPECIFICATIONS
The
object of specifications
completely,
may
all
is
to set
down
be pursued.
and
what
desired
is
in the apparatus or the machinery, and material entering into the con-
struction
for
no guarantee.
formance.
and leave
an important
and ask
of the accessories
of per-
the manufacturer
making
is
tests or of
no value. As a rule
it is much more satisfactory to specify standard equipment, for in such
cases the price is usually considerably less than would be the case where
new patterns and possibly special machinery must be provided in order
proving that the guarantee
is
lived
up
to,
makes
it
of
withstanding that the power requirements are greater for carbon dioxide
than for ammonia and that these increase with the temperature of the
" liquid " from the condenser, yet the excess
ammonia
is
of refrigerant should be
power
for
carbon dioxide
only nominal.
The
made because
and
less,
and
for over
75 tons, either the horizontal double-acting type or the vertical singleacting machine with the open frame.
CONDENSERS
are evidenced
by the use
677
specified.
Speeds
over 100 r.p.m. require careful machine design as regards the type of
valve and the valve opening, stresses in the frame, reciprocating parts
and bearings, and very particular attention to the lubrication. The old
paclving house design, steam engine driven, has become obsolete and the
synchronous motor drive (where electric power is available) and the
uniflow or poppet valve medium speed steam engine and oil engine driven
compressor are replacing it. Experience has shown that the essential
point to be considered in any case is the perfection of the lubrication
which must be positive and sufficient in amount.^ The use of stage
compression should be specified for evaporating temperatures of deg. F.
especially where the condenser pressure is 150 lb. gage and
Multiple effect compression has certain Hmited advantages in
over.
and lower,
special cases
and
it
will
is
70 deg. F. and
higher.
full.
The
gas flow into and out of the compressor should be as direct as possible.
much
less friction
2
^
See Chapter
II.
for
ammonia
are the
SPECIFICATIONS
678
common
atmospheric, the drip type, the double pipe, and the shell and
tube.
efficiency
shell
and
the water
is
used where
is
small installations.
modified submerged
coil
twelve pipes are economical. The number and the spacing of the stands,
the piping arrangement of the headers and the liquid drain, the kind of
fittings,
is
4|
in.
If
the
or over,
of
full
steel pipe,
liquid receiver should be tested before shipment with a 500 lb. air pres-
amount
The volume
of the
(see
amount
in the
Fittings
may
The
the use of steel flanges particularly, as well as steel fittings and valves
because of the ease in welding, especially in the case of carbonic refriger-
ation.
of the valve
The
may be
is
specified,
BRINE
The
679
eration, although
is
wrought iron
is still
full
weight pipe.
There is no standard
a number of manufacturers
weight and extra heavy pipe is
specified.
side, as
Likewise both
full
It is
usual to
much
The "
as possible.
fittings are
is
dispensed with as
now used
in
many
cases
The tubes
drains.
If
a brine cooler
is
be
and
which is approximately | in. thick.
tanks and 4, or even as many as 8, passes
pump out, oil drain and liquid gage con-
are expanded
is
single pass
and the
amount
The
and
size
of cans, the
amount
Brine.
left to
magnesium, and
it
of thawing,
Such brine
should be of
manner
the manufacturer.
is
is
specified for
usually best
when
The
sizes of
standard equipment.
5
some idea
of
and
SPECIFICATIONS
680
-3
in
bD
3
g
3
Pi
BRINE
TABLE
6-TON Distilled
Water
Ice
681
164
Flooded
Making Plant
(300-Lb. Cans)
Weight,
Items
Pounds
230
5,040
410
400
1,220
450
40
Distilled
Float tank, 15
by 24
in.
210
580
100
115
380
75
trough
in. dia.
160
1,000
2,880
gal.
600
4,750
1,950
5,900
11,000
per min
in.
ft.
long,
liX2
in.
weight galvanized
2 Distilled water filters, 24 in. dia. by 5 ft. long with charcoal to charge.
in. iron, with
1 Distilled water storage tank, 7 ft.X4 ft.X3 ft. 6 in.
68 ft. extra heavy 2 in. pipe
Distilled water pipe connections, galvanized
full
480
1,230
Horizontal return tubular boiler complete, 54 in. dia.X 14 ft. long, 60 hp.
Boiler feed pump, steam driven, 9 gal. per min
1 Feed water heater, 60 hp. vertical closed type, brass tubes
Steam and exhaust pipe connections
1
45 Tons of salt.
300 Lb. ammonia.
.
Engineer
Usual labor
Union labor
5 J Tons calcium.
1,560
300
15,665
180
550
600
9,000
300
SPECIFICATIONS
682
TABLE
-In.
and
2-In.
Effective
Height
Surface,
Over Top
Pipes,
High,
Inches
165
Square
Pipe,
feet
Inches
Height
Over
Extra
Heavy
All,
Inches
10-Ft. Coils
Full
Weight
of Pipe,
Pipe,
Pounds
Pounds
Ft. Long,
Add
for
Soldered
Joints
BRINE
TABLE
166
Condenser Pans
683
SPECIFICATIONS
684
TABLE
167
Weight,
Pounds
1 10-in. XlO-in., two-cylinder, belt-driven machine
3 Double pipe ammonia condensers, 10 P.H.X20 ft. long, l\
F. W. steel pipe
Gas, liquid and water headers for condensers
1 Ammonia oil separator, 16 in. X4 ft
1 Ammonia receiver, 20 in. X 10 ft
Ammonia connections:
60 ft., 2| in. E. H. steel pipe
5 2J in. ammonia ells, C. F. B. & G
2 Fr. 2^ in. ammonia flanges B. & G
20 ft., 3 in. F. W. steel pipe
3 3-in. ammonia ells, C. F. B. & G
20 ft., 1 in. E. H. pipe
2 Pr. 1 in. ammonia flanges B. & G., gage connections
11,400
in.
and
2-in
5,400
324
370
850
1,250
Total
1
10-in.
X 10-in.,
19,594
engine drive
9,000
synchronous
motor drive. Includes wheel, shaft extension, coupling and outboard bearShaft swell permissible. No exciter pulley included
ing.
Add to above for pulley when belted exciter is used
Deduct wheel at rate of 12 cents per pound list.
1
10-in.
X 10-in.
12-in. Xl2-in.,
4 Double pipe
ammonia
condensers, 12
P.H.X20
long, Ij-in.
and
2-in
W. steel pipe
Gas, liquid and water headers for condensers
1 Ammonia oil separator, 20 in. X5 ft
1 Ammonia receiver, 20 in. X 16 ft
Ammonia connections:
60 ft., 3| in. E. H. steel pipe
5 3^ in. ammonia ells, C. F. B. & G
2 Pr. 3J in. ammonia flanges B. & G
40 ft., 4 in. F. W. steel pipe
3 4 in. ammonia ells, C. F. B. & G
40 ft. 1\ in. E. H. pipe
2 Pr. li in. ammonia flanges, B. & G., gage connections
Total
12-in.
X 12-in.,
two-cvHnder machine arranged for engine type synchronous motor drive. Included wheel, shaft extension, coupling and outNo exciter pulley included.
board bearing. Shaft swell permissible.
Add to above for pulley when belted exciter is used
r2-in.
X 12-in.,
8,400
448
600
1,200
2,200
34,148
engine drive
1
500
21,300
ft.
F.
12,360
15,300
23,050
600
BRINE
<
H
z
o
2
o
685
686
SPECIFICATIONS
TABLE
169
Standard Cans
BRINE
TABLE
169a
687
SPECIFICATIONS
688
TABLE
Distilled
Water
Ice
170
Making Apparatus
BRINE
689
SPECIFICATIONS
690
TABLE 170Continued
Distilled
Size of Cylinder,
Inches
Water Pumps
BRINE
TABLE
171
691
SPECIFICATIONS
692
TABLE
172
1 4-in. X4-in.,
1
1
1
Ammonia
Machine arranged
1
1
1
and
2-in. F.
W.
steel.
connections:
Ij-in.
&
G.
Gage connections.
Ammonia
20
ft.,
Ij-in.
and
2-in. F.
W.
steel.
2-in. F.
W.
steel.
2-in. F.
W.
steel.
connections:
U in. E.
H.
steel pipe.
Ammonia
and
connections:
20
ft.,
25
and
ft.
5 1^-in.
The ammonia condensers listed for all sizes Enclosed Type Machine
S. are based on average conditions.
If the conditions are extreme, determine
proper size condenser from capacity sheets. The gage connections furnished with
in. thru 9 in.
in enclosed.
4 in.
Note.
H.
X9
X4
ft.
J in.
J in.
BRINE
693
TABLE 172Continued
Items
8-in.X8-in.,
2 D. P.
ammonia
condensers, 8 P.H.
X20
ft.
long, U-in.
and
2-in. F.
W.
steel.
Gas and
liquid headers.
oil separator, 12 in.X36 in.
receiver, 16 in.X7 ft.
Ammonia
Ammonia
Ammonia connections:
1
30
1 5-in.
1 Pr. ^-in.
Gage connections.
Machine arranged
9-in.X9-in.,
2 D. P.
&
G.
ammonia
Gas and
B.
condensers, 10
P.H.X20
ft.
long, Ij-in.
and
2-in. F.
W.
steel.
liquid headers.
oil separator, 12 in.X36 in.
receiver, 20 in. X7 ft.
Ammonia
Ammonia
Ammonia connections:
1
Machine without extended base plate or flywheel but with shaft length suitable
for engine type synchronous motor drive.
No swell in shaft permissible. Outboard bearing included. Motor rotor must have sufficient weight to furnish
necessary flywheel effect.
Motor rotor must be supplied with split hub or spht
rotor.
No
The gage connections furnished with 10 in. XlO in. and 12 in.Xl2
Enclosed Type Machine H. S. consist of the following:
40 ft. i-in. E. H. steel pipe, 2 j-in. ammonia valves screwed.
2 j-in. ammonia ells, screwed, 4 Prs. i-in. ammonia flanges, B. & G.
Note.
694
SPECIFICATIONS
BRINE
TABLE
174
Number
of
Cana
Ton
695
CHAPTER XXII
ELECTRIC
MOTORS
For some time it has been considered essential that the refrigerating
compressor be capable of having a widely varying rotative speed, but
this is
capacity
Fig.
of
of
amount
by the expedient
of
clearance pockets (Fig. 385), and in the smaller sizes by making the
compressor automatic. In Chapter II it was shown that the amount of
697
that the economy of operation, i.e., the horsepower per ton, was not
appreciably affected by clearances from 4 to 8 per cent or more. Rotary
speed control, therefore, is not of primary importance whereas the
requirements of a good electric motor are a good starting torque and high
efficiency during full speed operation. Before going into the details of
the various types of motors a few electrical principles will be considered.
Power.
True power
in
an alternating
average
value of the products of the coincident instantaneous values of the current and the voltage for a complete circuit. Power factor is the ratio of
the true power, KW, to the apparent power, kva. This is expressed as
PF =
The power
an
in
electric circuit
Watts = EI
X PF
where /
1.732
kva
is:
for
two phase
EI X PF
the terminals.
The
effect of
phase
for single
= 2EI X PF
E =
in
If
be the same
The
size of
formula, for single and two phase with unit power factor at the motor:
cm =
21. 6Z)/
where
cm
is
is
is
e is
For three phase use the constant 10.8 where e is the voltage drop
The line voltage at the motor divided by -s/3 is the supply
voltage minus the voltage drop e.
per wire.
ELECTRICAL MOTORS
698
Capacity,
Amperes
Carrying
<
X
Q
p^
;;3
22
'^ 00
O
CM oco
OO-H
-^ CM CO
ooo
CM lO
00 00 H
lO
O
^
o ooo
>0 M CM
OO'-H
CM OO-"-!
CM iC
CO CO >o
O'-H-H
CM CO lO
OC0 05
>0
CM
O
^
O t^
00 CO o
CO lo 00
CM 00
05 CO C^l
CM CM CO
CM
CO lO 00
699
o o
o3
CO
tn
00 OCO
CO 'O CO
CM
-t<
loot^eo
lO
^ OCM
^ 00
CO
62881 79281
Oi CO
iOCM
o
O
OTf* CO
CO oC' "O
Oi CM r-H
ELECTRIC MOTORS
700
accuracy.
wire has half the resistance, twice the weight and twice the area.
which
is
circular mileage.
the
wire
ten sizes larger than another has one-tenth the resistance, ten
number
To
The
of feet per
ohm
of circular mils,
is
specified
is
one-tenth of the
wire.
field
Per
u,
, ,^
cent torque
classified
[^
the
field is
wound motors
excited
by con-
winding with a
field rheostat in series with
the supply line.
As the
necting
its
demand
and a
sults
are desirable.
The
In
general,
chronous.
The
701
is
work.
Low
wound
slip of
wound
rotor
motor
2 and 4 pole motors have 150 per cent of full load torque;
6 pole motors have 135 per cent of full load torque;
8 pole motors have 125 per cent of full load torque;
10 pole motors have 120 per cent of
full
load torque;
It requires
develop
full
full
the case of the squirrel cage, and only Ij times the full load current
with the wound rotor when the proper resistance is inserted between the
collector rings.
is
not
less
somewhat higher
slip,
is
large
is
approximately
ELECTRIC MOTORS
702
The
motor
good
is
110
the
100
load
full
and the
ning torque
more the
to 2 times or
full
load torque.
60
the
40
20
operating characthis
teristics
of
of motor,
and
and
The
power factor
power
is
type
Fig. 387
made
factor
shows
386
Figure
run-
from If
is
80
torque,
maximum
may
be
leading at Ught
loads but at a
seldom called for.
loss
of
is
703
per cent,
minimum,
which will
worked out a number of curves for particular designs of compressors
which reduce the labor in the calculation of the required size of the
flywheel.
may be incorporated
synchronous motor, thereby saving in space
and the cost of material. It is both feasible and desirable also to throw
the motor direct on the line, thus ehminating auto transformers and
necessary flywheel effect for satisfactory operation
final
ELECTRIC MOTORS
704
" pull in "
is
is
applied,
necessary to accelerate.
Direct -current
excitation
Fig. 389.
the weight of the flywheel should be sufficient, but too great a weight
will
unloaded.
705
is
desirable,
and the
efficiency of
motor operating
sizes, is
TABLE
176
Number
At
such a
medium
706
ELECTRIC MOTORS
TABLE
177
178
induction motors.
and
Current Motors
column
for
wound
Use next
rotor motors.
Horse
Power
707
CHAPTER XXIII
STEAM AND OIL ENGINES
Previous to 1915, generally speaking, and 1910 in particular, the
steam engine was almost the only source of power in ice making plants.
At the present time (1927) steam is seldom used except in special cases,
such as the packing plants, some isolated ice-making plants, especially
if the water available at the plant requires distillation in order to make
it fit for can ice making, and in the majority of the larger hotels and
apartment houses.
Whereas in the earlier days, when coal was comparatively cheap, the
Corliss engine was used almost exclusively, now it is usual to use the
more economical forms of prime movers. The exceptions would be in
cases such as hotel refrigeration where a heat balance is attempted and
the exhaust steam is used for heating purposes in the winter and an
electric motor drive is used at times when steam is not required for
heating.
When economy
of
steam
is
required,
These
is
by the absorption
When
of heat
saturated steam
up
by the
is
used
to the
point of cut-off the walls and ports being heated accordingly and
then during the expansion of the steam after the point of cut-off these
same metals begin to heat and re-evaporate the steam as soon as the
709
the usual fourdevelop to the extent that it does in the slide valve or
through ports
exhausted
valve engines. In the uniflow design the steam is
at the end of
piston
in the cylinder barrel which are uncovered by the
sUghtly
less than the
The piston has to be especially long
its stroke.
to operate
designed
length of the stroke. The uniflow engine is usually
Stator support
bracker
g-
of
"Ui-
shims
-t!^
Fig.
may
operate either
manner automatically.
(Figs.
that with saturated steam the water rate is less than 14 lb. per i.hp.hr.,
but this steam consumption rate is much improved with the use of
710
Exhaust
Fig. 391.
0.786
18.
18
16
SI
0.824
0.816
superheated steam.
water rate
full
than 10.5
is less
lb.,
rate
of
the
materials
of
of
the
711
is
it is less
by
heat
engine
is
to a gas than
given
are
from metals
a wet
vapor.
steam engines
Tables 180 and
uniflow
of
Sizes
to
in
183.
The
Oil
Engine. One
of the
economy
oil
The
lb. of
is
ever,
is
who
is
not as numerous as
200
100
400
Kw. load
Fig. 395.
Steam
Consumption Vertical
Steam Engine.
Generally speaking, it
can be said that the oil
Uniflow
engine usually employed
for
direct
connected, although
the
belt
drrve
is
refrigerating
still
plants
found.
The
is
oil
bined
with
various
methods
of
cooling,
and with
details
of
the
712
o
P
02
O
s
a
<
T
Z
O
180
R.p.m.
257.
Piston Speed
6-cylinder Engines
713
714
715
ing the
method
and
details govern-
of ignition.
oil
Cooling water
thermometer
Combustion space
Cooling water
control valve
Compression
relief
Starting air
Exhaust ports
\Water
inlet
and drain
Fig.
engine.
The
oil
397. Fairbanks-Morse
Oil Engine.
auxiliaries, including
oil
engines,
about $17,500
716
This
cost, figured
chronous motors with exciters and
depreciation
and
interest,
on a basis of 15 per cent overhead, to include
economiengine
oil
the
make
taxes would amount to $2625 per year. To
control panels.
]..i.
INDEX
Available energy, 4
blowers, 383
medium
Air, as a refrigerant,
250
dense, 250
for test
room, 531
problem, 528
refrigerating machines used, 527
Uft"
Ammonia, 224
diagram, 234
superheated, properties of, 233
thermal properties of, 225-232
properties of
sodium
chloride,
273
Ammonia
sion,
268-272
717
INDEX
718
Brine cooler, corrosion, 257
double-pipe, 257, 258
for carbon dioxide, 261
horizontal
shell
vs.
vertical,
256
Changes
of state, isothermal, 3, 4
Charging with ammonia, 310, 311
amount, 311
Checking of ice, 402, 403
Chemical industries, refrigeration in, 582
Chemistry of water softening, 396, 398
Clark and Almy, 435
Clearance, 31
of performance, 14
apple, 431
automatic, 391
baskets, 391
fish,
Can
making, 412
accumulator and piping, 405
amount of piping, 416
core sucker, 406
design of plant, 411
freezing diagram, 412
freezing process, 407
heat removed, 414
horse power required, 418
precooling water, 407
piping, 403, 404
processes in, 407-411
selection of the compressor, 417
time of freezing, 416
Carbon dioxide, 222
charging into the system, 322
compressor details, 81
compressors, 41-46
diagram for, 222
operation, 323, 324
thermodynamic properties of, 223
Carburetor testing (problem), 531
Carload shipments, 449
Carnot cycle, 4
ice
Castings, chilling
in,
and
fabrics,
440
piping
for, 452,
problem
in,
405
451
Ingersoll-Rand, 80
Worthington, 78, 79
65
enclosed type, 30
semi-enclosed, 29
speed, 33
efficiency,
principle, 5
Carre, Edmund, 82
Carrier, Willis, 52, 246, 509
problem
434
with brine, 436
548
of,
548
Condensers, 112
atmospheric, 116, 122, 153, 154
for carbon dioxide, 131
bleeder, 122, 123
Changes
constant volume, 3
isobar, 3
shell
of state, adiabatic, 3
and
INDEX
Cylinders,
Conversion constants, 3
Cooling and conditioning of
moisture content, 508
problem in, 509
Baudalot cooler, 516
Cylinder
air,
for,
number
of sprays, 515
construction
tests of,
refrigeration
of,
582
Costs of refrigerating machinery
equipment, 632
absorption machine, 639
ammonia
receivers, 635,
643
and
piping, 500
DoREMtJS, R.
Douglas, W.
56,
58
blowers, 637
Electrical-resistance
330
arrangement
for,
Energy equation, 2
Energy,
654
piping, 646-652
220
C, 390
pipe, 653,
38
516
substances,
of,
307
Daniels, G. W., 46
Deep well pumps, centrifugal, 286, 288
Defrosting, low-pressure piping, 315, 316
Dehumidifier, 386
with brine coils, 386
with brine sprays, 387
Depreciation, cost of ice plants, 673
Dichlorethylene, 51, 246, 249
Direct-current motor, 700
Corrosive
number
oil,
507
formula
719
intrinsic, 1
kinetic, 1, 2
potential, 1
thermometer, 329,
330
INDEX
720
Entropy, 6
Erection, leveling and grouting, 301
properties
bolts,
300
Freezing mixtures, 15
241
of,
707
Foundations, 300
of,
318
Expansion cylinder, 18
Expansion valve, 18
amount of opening, 312
ExplosibiUty of refrigerants, 346
laws
for,
265, 266
problem, 463
Furs and
Fairbanks, F.
L.,
Fans, capacities
fabrics,
440-446
105
of,
Gas
planoidal, 538
selection of, 532
595
Gasoline manufacture, 590
Gelatine emulsion, 595
General Electric compressor, 175
Generator, for absorption machine, 86
w^arfare,
flanges, 133
oil
separator, 118
receivers, 134
Fittings for
ammonia, 105
accumulator, 114
Arctic flanges, 149, 150
and
ells
113
flanges (Frick), 148
crosses
and
ells (Frick),
147
ells,
Haber
process, 595
problem, 596
Hausbrandt's formula, 209
Headers, 108
Heat, removed, by the condenser, 277
condensing water chart, 279
from the absorber, 87
gallons of water per ton, 278
Heat transfer, bkeder condenser, 212
double-pipe condenser, 213
effect of moisture, 190
218
separator, 114
pop safety
valve, 111
218
INDEX
721
HoRNE, Geo.,
58, 343
Horse power, of compressors, 70
per ton of refrigeration, 14, 40
Low
overrun
562
of,
in,
temperature, production
Claude process, 552
Lindc process, 551
automatic, 390
making
plants, 420
Malleable cast-iron
Manufactured
and tanks,
195,
ice,
374
Marine
refrigeration, 489
apple transport, 491
494
489
kinds of cargo, 490
mechanical equipment, 495
temperature control, 493
ventilation, 492
chilled meat,
196
insulation,
buckstays, 198
economic thickness
effect of moisture,
of,
Maximum-pressure switch,
203
194
floors, 197,
216, 585
calculation, 217
199
188
standard construction, 193
steel beams, 199
specific' conductivity,
ammonia,
for
168
190
373
705
fittings,
Manifolds, 108
ammonia, 343
Induction motor,
550
564
Ice
of,
refrigerants, 582
problem
203
windows, 201
Isobutane, properties
of,
248
186,
thermodynamic
Milk, coohng
552
pasteurizing, 553
problem in, 555
specific heat of, 556
specific gravity of, 556
Mines, air conditioning in, 529
Mixtures of refrigerants, 249
of,
MOLLIER, H., 89
INDEX
722
Mullet, G.
B.,
283
Perkins, Jacob, 20
Peterson, J. W., 436
process of fish freezing, 436
58
P-I diagram, 7
Pictet liquid, 21
374
in storage, 375
Nichols, Percy, 329
Non-condensible gases, 313, 314
purge drum, 314
Natural
ice,
301
coils,
365
making, 359
cold storage, 361
brine,
can
of,
ammonia
303
condenser connection, 314
Piping,
ice
compressor, 354
condenser, 355-358
consumption, 716
ratings, 713
Oil refining, 585
filter press, 588
problem, 585
wax chilling machine, 587
Oil separator, 306
Operating costs, ice plants, 675
oil
conventions, 372
defrosting, 365
of, 303
examples of, 354-373
flooded system, 358
detaQs
121
Optimum refrigerant,
Optimum water rate,
19
296, 297
ice
kinds
size of,
suction,
355
364
supports, details
of,
302
371
of standards,
370
vs.
direct expansion,
464
chiUing, 468
problem, 476
open system, 464
refrigeration required, 468
sprays, 470
Peclet's laws, 180
Pendulum-type compressor, 53
Pennington, M. E., 433
changes of
specific
state,
heat
of,
absolute, 2
Propane, 244
Perfect gases, 7
intrinsic energy,
8
8
properties, 245
INDEX
Purging, absorption machines, 104
P-V diagram, 3
723
Morgan
R
Radiation law, 179
Radiation soction, flexibilitjfor
262
Specifications, 676
of,
372
ammonia, 369
fittings,
678
Refrigeration
B., 259,
Specific heat, 3
16
ice
making
piping, 679
sand
icing, 484,
filters,
694
485
ammonia
compression, 58-65
Stage
Steam and
shipment of
fruits,
479
oil
engines, 708
309
blowing out
Rotary compressor, 48
blade type, 49
problem, 583
solubility of, 584
pumping
coils,
air pressure,
308
Tabor,
J.
M., 436
Temperature, absolute, 2
of goods in cold storage, 441
scales of, 2
INDEX
724
Thermocouple,
in series, 336
in parallel,
336
Cash, 165
Monogram, 165
Water cooling formula,
of,
295, 296
384
290
290
temperature of, surface, 282, 284, 285,
well, 280, 281
centrifugal, 289,
Ton
Water, hardness
pumping, 288
Water
laws
for,
328
for,
Water jacket, 35
Water pressure failure switch, 166
Water softeners, 395, 399, 400
for
of refrigeration, 13
can
ice,
of,
280, 281
Zoller, H.
Valves, 109
Vapors, 10
equations
for, 11,
12
latent heat, 11
liquid, 10
superheated, 11
F.,
562
3 9358 00804186 2